General Specifications NHA
General Specifications NHA
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
(DECEMBER – 1998)
We have carried out amendments in the current General Specifications looking to the
causes of disputes and reasons of failure of certain roads constructed in various parts of
the country. Addition of new items has also been made in the existing specifications to
cater for future needs of National Highway Authority.
Our sincere thanks are due to several agencies, which contributed in compilation of this
important document, however special attention of Contracts and Specifications Section of
National Highway Authority under the guidance of Chairman NHA, helped us to complete
the assignment successfully. We hope that this document will contribute effectively in
improving the workmanship and quality of highway construction in Pakistan.
Table of Contents
406 Joints and Bearing Devices for concrete Structures ......... 406-1 - 406-8
407 Piling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407-1 - 407-24
408 Sheet Piling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408-1 - 408-3
409 Well Foundation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409-1 - 409-6
410 Brick Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410-1 - 410-3
411 Random and Dressed Uncoursed Stone Masonry . . . . . . . . . . 411-1 - 411-3
412 Dressed Coursed Stone Masonry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412-1 - 412-6
413 Steel Structures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413-1 - 413-21
DRAINAGE AND EROSION WORKS
Item -500 General .................................. 500-1
509 Rip Rap and Reinforced Concrete Slope Protection . . . . . . . . . 509-1 - 509-5
iii
Item No. Description Page
iv
GENERAL
1. Introduction
1.1 Preamble
1.2 Standards
1.3 Manpower
1.4 Equipment
Number and kind of Equipment required for different items of work shall be
planned by the contractor keeping in view the workmanship required by a
particular item and the quantity of finished item required to be carried out in
eight hours shift. The Engineer shall approve such planning or any changes
shall be proposed for guidance of the Contractor. However this procedure
shall not relieve the Contractor of his contractual obligations pertaining to
performance and maintenance of project.
G-1
1.5 Alternative Equipment
While few of these specifications may provide that equipment of a particular
size and type is to be used to perform portions of the work, it is to be
understood that the deployment and use of new or improved equipment is to
be encouraged.
The Contractor may request, in writing, permission from the Engineer to use
equipment of a different size or type in place of the equipment specified or
recommended in these chapters.
The Engineer, before considering or granting such request, may require the
Contractor to furnish, at his expense, evidence to satisfy the Engineer that
the equipment proposed for use by the Contractor is capable of producing
work equal to or better in quality than, that which can be produced by the
equipment specified.
Neither the Employer nor the Contractor shall have any claim against the
other for either the withholding or the granting of permission to use
alternative equipment, or for the withdrawal of such permission.
Nothing in this clause shall relieve the Contractor of his responsibility for
furnishing materials or producing finished work of the quality specified in
these specifications.
All materials which the Engineer has determined as not conforming to the
requirements of the drawings and specifications will be rejected whether in
place or not. They shall be removed immediately from the site of the work,
unless otherwise permitted by the Engineer. No rejected material, the
defects of which have been subsequently corrected, shall be used in the
G-2
work, unless approval in writing has been given by the Engineer. Upon
failure of the Contractor to comply promptly with any order of the Engineer
made under the provisions in this clause, the Engineer shall have authority
to cause the removal of rejected material and to deduct the cost thereof
from any payments due or to become due to the Contractor.
Quarry material is rock, sand, gravel, earth, or other mineral material, other
than local borrow or selected material, obtained on the project. Quarry
material does not include materials such as cement, lime, marble powder
etc. obtained from established commercial sources.
The Contractor shall, at his expense, make any arrangements necessary for
hauling over local public and private roads from any source.
Full compensation for furnishing all labour, materials, tools, equipment, and
incidentals, and for doing all the work involved in conforming to the
provisions in this clause, for furnishing and producing materials from any
source shall be considered as included in the price paid for the contract item
of work involving such material and no additional compensation will be
allowed therefor.
G-3
Whenever the specifications permit the substitution of a similar or equivalent
material or article, no tests or action relating to the approval of such
substitute material will be made until the request for the substitution is made
in writing by the Contractor accompanied by complete data as to the
equality of the material or article proposed. Such request shall be made
well in time to permit approval without delaying the work.
1.10 Frequency of Tests & Test Designation
When desired by the Engineer, the Contractor shall furnish, without charge,
samples of all materials entering into the work and no material shall be used
prior to approval by the Engineer. Samples of material from local sources
shall be taken by or in the presence of the Engineer, otherwise the samples
will not be considered for testing.
1.12 Construction Stakes, Lines and Grades
The Engineer will furnish design survey data and jointly locate with
contractor, all points of intersection and of tangents and basic benchmarks.
The plans indicate the properties of horizontal and vertical curves, together
with rates of superelevation where required. The contractor shall set
G-4
construction stakes establishing lines, slopes, and continuous profile-grade
in road work, and center line and bench marks for bridge work, culvert work,
protective and accessory structures and appurtenances and will furnish the
Engineer with the original copy of the field notes together with all necessary
information relating to lines, slopes and grades. These stakes and marks
shall constitute the field control by and in accordance with which the
contractor shall establish other necessary controls and perform the work.
The profiles and cross sections on the plans indicate the elevation of the top
of road surface or as otherwise noted on the plans. The contractor shall be
responsible for the preservation of all stakes and marks, and if any of the
construction stakes or marks has been destroyed or disturbed, the
Contractor will replace them at his own expense.
The Contractor shall be responsible for the accuracy of all lines, slopes,
grades, and other survey work.
G-5
1.15 Safety Precautions.
The Contractor shall adequately provide for the safety, health and welfare of
persons and for the prevention of damage to works, materials and
equipment for the purpose of or in connection with the Contract.
1.16 Inspection
The Engineer shall, at all times, have safe access to the work during its
construction, and shall be furnished with every reasonable facility for
ascertaining that the materials and the workmanship are in accordance with
the requirements and intentions of these Specifications, the Special
Provisions, and the plans/drawings. All works done and all materials
furnished shall be subject to inspection by Engineer.
The inspection of the work or materials shall not relieve the Contractor of
any of his obligations to fulfill his contract as prescribed. Work and
materials not meeting such requirements shall be made good and
unsuitable work or materials may be rejected, not withstanding that such
work or materials have been previously inspected by the Engineer or that
payment therefor has been included in a progress estimate.
All works, which have been rejected, shall be remedied, or removed and
replaced by the Contractor in an acceptable manner and no compensation
will be allowed to him for such removal, replacement, or remedial work.
Any work done beyond the lines and grades shown on the plans or
established by the Engineer, or any extra work done without written
authority will be considered as unauthorized work and will not be paid for.
Upon failure of the Contractor to comply promptly with any order of the
Engineer made under this Item, the Employer may cause rejected or
unauthorized work to be remedied, removed, or replaced and to deduct the
costs from any payment due or to become due to the Contractor.
Whenever the plans or specifications provide that more than one specified
methods of construction or more than one specified type of construction
equipment may be used to perform portions of the work and leave the
selection of the method of construction or the type of equipment to be used
up to the Contractor, it is understood that the Employer does not guarantee
G-6
In the event some of the alternatives are not feasible or it is necessary to
use more than one of the alternatives on any project, full compensation for
any additional cost involved shall be considered as included in the contract
price paid for the item of work involved and no additional compensation will
be allowed thereof.
1.19 Conformity with Contract Documents and Allowable Deviations.
Work and materials shall conform to the lines, grades, cross sections,
dimensions and material requirements, including tolerances, shown on the
plans or indicated in the specifications. Although measurement, sampling
and testing may be considered evidence as to such conformity, the
Engineer shall be the sole judge as to whether the work or materials deviate
from the plans and specifications, and his decision relating to any allowable
deviations therefrom shall be final.
i) Equipment to be used.
ii) Layer thickness adopted
iii) Per day production.
iv) Results of tests.
2. Scope
G-7
3.1 Abbreviations
AASHTO - American Association of State Highway and
Transportation Officials.
ASTM - American Society for Testing and Material
AWG - American Wire Gauge
AWPA - American Wood Preservers Association
BS - British Standard Code of Practice
ACI - American Concrete Institute
FHWA - U.S. Federal Highway Administration
PCA - Portland Cement Association
Wt. - Weight
Lb. - Pound
AWS - American Welding Society
Gallon - U.S. Gallon
In. - Inch
Ft. - Foot
Yd. - Yard
Ltr. - Litre
mm - Millimeter
cm. - Centimeter
M - Meter
Km - Kilometer
SM - Square Meter
o - degree
Sq. cm. - Square Centimeter
CM - Cubic Meter
ha - Hectare
Kg - Kilogram
Ton - Metric Ton (1000 Kg)
oC - Degree Centigrade
oF - Degree Fahrenheit
G-8
3.2 Definitions
Wherever in these specifications or in other contract document the following
terms or pronouns in place of them are used, the intent and meaning shall
be interpreted as follows:
Accepted
Addendum
Aggregates
Amenities
Apron
Asphalt Concrete
Auxiliary Lane
– That portion of the roadway adjoining the traveled way for speed change
or other purposes supplementary to through traffic movements.
G-9
Barrage
– A low dam or weir across a river equipped with a series of gates to
regulate the water surface level above the weir.
Base Course
Batten
Beldar
Bid/Tender Price
– The sum of the products of the quantities of work with the quoted prices
in the Tender by the Contractor.
– A list showing work quantities and specifying unit price and/or lump sum
for specific items of work.
Blinding Layer
Boulder
Boundary
Bridge
G-10
Bund
– A continuous embankment, dike or levee (generally associated with
training or containing the flow of rivers).
Catchment
Contractor
Contract Price
– The sum of the products of the quantities with the agreed prices
appearing in the agreement between the Contractor and the
Engineer/Employer.
Construction Limit
– Construction limit of a project is area between left & right side of catch
points of road under construction, where as in case of structures this limit
will extend to area which is required for execution of permanent structure
Cubic Meter
Cuboid
– Crushed stone particles with each face fractured and in roughly cuboid
shape.
Culvert
Cum
Cusec
G-11
Daywork
– Work to be paid for on the basis of actual labour, material, and plant
used - Force account.
Detour (Diversion)
– A temporary roadway, which leaves the main, route and rejoin it later, for
the uninterrupted flow of traffic.
Drawings
Earth
Engineer
Equipment
– All machinery and equipment, together with the necessary supplies for
up keep and maintenance and also tools and apparatus necessary for
the proper construction and acceptable completion of the work.
Fix
Forms or Formwork
G-12
Frustration of a Contract
– Rendered impossible of performance by external cause beyond the
contemplation of the parties.
Gang Header
Gasoline
Godown
Grade
– The trace of a vertical plane intersecting the top surface of the proposed
wearing surface, usually along the longitudinal center-line of the
roadbed. Profile grade means either elevation or gradient of such trace
according to the context.
Gravel
Highway
Install
Kilometer
G-13
Laboratory
Materials
– Any substance specified for use in the construction of the project and its
appurtenances.
Metalled (roadway)
Mile
Monsoon
Motor Spirit
– Petrol, gasoline.
Octroi
Period of Maintenance
Pitching or Rip-Rap
G-14
Prime Cost
– A net sum entered in the Bill of Quantities by the employer as the sum
provided to cover the cost of or to be paid by the Contractor to
merchants or others for specific articles or materials to be supplied after
deducting all trade discounts and any discount for cash.
Provide
Provisional Sum
– Any sum of money fixed by the Employer and included in the Bill of
Quantities to provide for work not otherwise included therein. A
provisional sum is only to be expended, either wholly or in part under the
Employer's Representatives or the Engineer's direction in accordance
with Contract. This sum may or may not be utilised in full or partially
through the contractor.
Regulator
Return
– Report
Revetment (Material)
– Rock.
Right-of-way (ROW)
Roadside
– A general term denoting the area adjoining the outer edge of the
roadway. Extensive areas between the roadways of a divided highway
may also be considered roadside.
Roadway
G-15
Scaffolding
– Laying out or staking out-establishing on the site the lines, levels and
grades to which the construction works are to be carried out.
Shingle
– See Aggregates.
Shoulders
– The portion of the roadway contiguous with the traveled way for
accommodation of stopped vehicles, for emergency use, and for lateral
support of base and surface courses.
Sidewalk
Sleepers
Soil Binder
Special Provisions
Spoil Bank
Structures
Subbase
– The layer of specified material and thickness placed between the base
course and subgrade.
G-16
Subgrade
– The top surface of a roadbed upon which the pavement structures and
shoulders including curbs are constructed.
Subgrade level
– That level of the roadbed (or, embankment) on which other road material
has to be placed.
Subgrade treatment
Substructure
– All of that part of a structure below the bearings of simple and continuous
spans, or rigid frames, including back walls, wing walls.
Super-tax
Surface Course
Surfacing
Supply
Tender
– Bid proposal.
Tenderer
Traffic Lanes
G-17
Unmetalled (Roadway)
Variation Order
– The work shall mean the furnishing of all labour, materials, equipment
and other incidentals necessary or convenient to the successful
completion of the project and carrying out of all the duties and
obligations imposed by the contract.
Wagon (railway)
Wayleave
Well
Working Drawings
– Stress sheets, shop drawings, erection plans, falsework plans, form work
plans, cofferdam plans, bending diagrams for reinforcing steel, or any
other supplementary plans or similar data which the contractor is
required to submit to the Engineer for approval.
Written Undertaking
– A written promise.
G-18
EARTH WORK
AND
ALLIED ACTIVITIES
EARTHWORK
100.1 DESCRIPTION
Earthwork will consist of all necessary work for the excavation and placing in
embankment or backfill or disposal by dumping of earth, rock or other
material from or to the roadway or adjacent thereto or from borrow areas,
including the excavation of side and interception ditches, the removal of
unsuitable subgrade material, the formation of laybyes, the widening of cuts
and the flattening of cut slopes whether to obtain material for embankments
or backfill, or to increase the stability of the slopes, clearing and grubbing,
the selective removal of trees, stripping and the removal of existing
obstructions within the approved cross section for excavation, in accordance
with these specifications and in conformity with the lines, grades, sections,
and dimensions shown on the drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
Any information concerning the properties of the soil or sub soil and other
geotechnical information shown on the drawing or other documents forming
part of the contract is for information only. The contractor is obliged to make
his own assessment of site conditions prevailing. No claim for extra cost or
time extension will be entertained based on the information provided.
The Contractor shall be deemed to have visited the site prior to making his
bid and shall ascertain the nature of the earth and rock, its quantity,
locations and suitability to meet the specified requirements, and he shall
base his bid estimates solely on his own soil investigation. After the award
of the contract no claim for a revision of bid prices depending on the sources
of soil information will be entertained.
100.3 EXPLOSIVES
Where explosives are used the Contractor shall provide suitable buildings or
warehouses in approved positions for the storage of explosives, which shall
be stored in the manner and quantity approved by the Engineer or as per
relative laws of government. Such storage places shall be accessible only to
authorized personnel. They shall be properly marked, all doors or accesses
thereto shall be constructed of materials as directed by the Engineer and
provided with secure locks and all necessary means for preventing access
by unauthorized persons. The Contractor shall be responsible for the
prevention of any unauthorized issue or improper use of any explosives.
The handling of explosives shall be entrusted only to experienced and
responsible men, to the satisfaction of the Engineer, and in conformity with
the statutory regulations.
100-1
All drilling and blasting shall be done in such a manner as to bring the
excavation as close as possible to the required cross sections, and to
disturb as little as possible the material to be left in place. Blasting by
means of drill holes, tunnels, or any other method shall be performed at the
entire risk and responsibility of the Contractor who shall have no claim to
payment for extra work occasioned by breakage outside the approved
cross-sections or dimensions.
The greatest care shall be taken by the Contractor during all blasting
operations to ensure that no injury be done to persons or damage to
property or to the finished work. Shots shall be properly loaded and capped,
and only a moderate charge shall be used in each hole. A record of all
explosives used, showing locations and amounts, shall be kept by the
Contractor for checking by the Engineer.
Where directed by the Engineer, the Contractor shall provide heavy mesh
blasting mat for protection of persons, property and the work. If necessary,
blasting shall be restricted to time prescribed by the Engineer.
The Engineer may prohibit blasting and order the rock to be excavated by
other means, if, in his opinion, it would be dangerous to persons or adjacent
structures, or is being carried out in a reckless manner. If traffic on the road
has to be interrupted, the Contractor shall obtain approval of his schedule
for such interruption from the proper authorities and shall satisfy the
Engineer that he has obtained it. No extra payment shall be admissible for
such arrangements as described here above.
The pay items under Items 101, 103, 105, 106, 107 and 108 shall include
the cost of removal of all material regardless of its nature, encountered
within the limits of the approved cross-section, including the removal and
disposal, as required by the Engineer, of existing brick, stone, concrete or
masonry, rock boulders or fragments, old pavements, culverts, bridges or
parts thereof, retaining walls or any other material encountered during the
excavation, unless a separate item exists for such features.
Except where provided for, no separate payment will be made for control of
or removal of water during or after earthwork operations. The cost of
sheeting, shoring, cofferdams, pumping and draining shall be included in the
bid prices for earthwork. The Contractor shall provide necessary facilities
for dewatering and for draining or diverting watercourses when necessary
for the protection of the contract work or where required by the Engineer.
The Contractor shall provide such drainage outlet ditches or canals as may
be necessary to effect proper drainage before rain is expected. Such
drainage ditches or canals for protection of work during construction and
their maintenance and clearing to make them continuously effective during
the work shall not be paid separately, but shall be deemed to be included in
other items of work.
100-2
The Contractor shall also provide, fix, maintain and operate such engines,
pumps, hoses, chutes and other appliances as are necessary to keep the
accumulated water at a level required for the safety of the structures as
directed by the Engineer.
100.6 DITCHES
The Contractor shall construct side ditches, interception ditches, and inlet
and outlet ditches as shown on the Drawings or where ordered by the
Engineer, whether for temporary or permanent drainage. In order to keep
water away from the embankment, subgrade, and/or pavement during
construction, the Contractor shall at all times ensure adequate drainage by
scheduling ditch and outlet so that the drainage is operative before work is
started on the embankment, subgrade or pavement. He shall clean and trim
all such drainage ditches from time to time, so that there may be a free flow
of water throughout the whole period of the Contract. Ditches shall first be
trimmed according to approved cross-sections, and final trimming, including
the repair of any damage that may have been done during the construction
work, shall be carried out after the completion of the other construction work
and shall be a condition for final approval and acceptance.
Except where otherwise specified excavation and backfill for culvert and
drainage pipes, except granular backfill to under drains, will not be paid for
separately, but shall be considered as a subsidiary obligation of the
Contractor covered under the contract price for the various classes of pipe
culvert as provided in Item 501.
The Engineer may order the removal of material resulting from landslides,
the construction of benches in or above the cut slope or in the embankment
slope or where in his opinion the slope shows signs of instability, the
flattening of the slope. Payment of all such work shall be at contract prices
in Item 106 or 108 as the case may be.
The Contractor shall be responsible for the setting out of the work in
accordance with Clause 17 of the General Conditions of Contract.
Notwithstanding that project drawings have been issued to the Contractor,
100-3
the Contractor shall also be responsible for taking joint cross-sections on the
proposed alignment of the road, submitting three copies of the plotted cross-
sections and longitudinal profile to the Engineer and obtaining the approval
of the Engineer to such cross-section and longitudinal profile before any
work in connection with Earthwork is commenced. These cross-sections
and longitudinal profile shall be in the form and manner as instructed in
writing by the Engineer.
Excavation and filling beyond the lines and level shown on the drawings,
approved profiles and cross-sections will not be paid for. The Engineer will
decide the angle of the slope of cuts and fills as the work proceeds on the
basis of evaluation of the soil characteristics. The actual lines of the cuts
and fills as made will be duly measured and recorded by the Contractor.
The Engineer will check these records and will approve the measurements,
if correct, as a basis of payment. Excess of excavation shall be backfilled,
as directed by the Engineer, with subbase materials without extra payment
to the Contractor; excess of fill may be either left in place or removed as
required by the Engineer. The quantities of excavation, backfill and
earthwork to be paid for in Items 103, 106, 107 and 108 respectively shall
be the number of cubic meters of material measured by the average end-
area method, except where the error may exceed plus or minus five percent
as compared with the prismoidal formula in which case the Engineer will
authorize the use of the more accurate method. However, the Contractor
shall request such authority before he submits his quantities for approval.
Quantities measured on the average end-area basis, once they have been
submitted and approved, shall not be subject to review for the purpose of
applying a more accurate method.
100-4
ITEM 101 CLEARING AND GRUBBING
101.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of removal to the specified depth, grubbing and
disposal of all surface objects, as and where directed in writing by the
Engineer, stumps, roots, bushes and trees with less than 150 mm girth,
vegetation, logs, rubbish and other objectionable material except such
objects as are designated to remain or are to be removed in accordance
with other section of specification.
101.2.1 Clearing/Grubbing
In roadway cut areas, all surface objects or any object to the depth of 30 Cm
below subgrade level such as stumps, roots, vegetation, bushes, logs,
rubbish shall be cleared and/or grubbed as directed by the Engineer. In
roadway fill areas where clearing and grubbing is required, same shall be
carried out to the depth of 30 Cm below natural surface level as described
above.
After clearing and grubbing, the compaction of the area will be restored to its
original value without any extra payment. However Engineer may direct in
writing to the Contractor for stripping (if so required) under item 103 or for
compaction under item 104, Compaction of Natural Ground, if the original
compaction is less than the required for respective zone. Payment of these
items will be made separately under the relative items used for such
purpose.
All trees having girth less than 150 mm measured at (600) mm above
ground and falling within the construction limits shall be felled & removed by
the contractor. The excavation and removal of trees, roots and stumps
including backfilling and compacting of holes and restoring the natural
ground to the original condition shall be responsibility of the contractor for
which no extra payment shall be made to him. The trees, stumps & roots
remains the property of the Employer, which shall be delivered at
designated place as directed by the Engineer.
The Contractor shall prevent damage to all pipes, conduits, wires, cables or
structure above or below ground. No land monuments, property markers, or
official datum points shall be damaged or removed until the
Employer/Engineer has witnessed or otherwise referenced their locations
101-1
and approved their removal. The Contractor shall so control his operations
as to prevent damage to shrubs, which are to be preserved. Protection may
include fences and boards latched to shrubs, to prevent damage from
machine operations. Any damage as a result of contractor’s operation shall
immediately be rectified by him at his own expense.
101.3.1 Measurement
Clearing and grubbing carried out by the Contractor in roadway cut areas
and borrow pits shall not be measured for payment.
101.3.2 Payment
The quantities determined as provided above will be paid for at the contract
unit price for the pay item mentioned below and shown in the Bill of
Quantities, which price and payment shall be full compensation for clearing
and grubbing and restoration of area, to its original condition.
101-2
ITEM 102 REMOVAL OF TREES
102.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of the removal of trees and stumps alongwith their
roots to a depth, to ensure complete removal of roots and stumps and their
disposal as provided in Special Provision or as directed in writing by the
Engineer.
Such individual trees as the Engineer may designate and mark in white
paint shall be left standing uninjured. All other trees to be removed shall be
counted and an inventory prepared showing girth of the tree stem.
Hole or loose earth resulting from the removal of trees shall be filled and
recompacted to a degree of compaction of adjoining area. Any extra
material required for such purpose shall not be measured for payment.
102.4.1 Measurement
Engineer and Contractor shall jointly measure the girth and number of trees
to be removed under this item. Any tree having a girth of less than 150 mm
measured six hundred (600) mm above ground level shall not be measured
under this item, as the same shall be removed under item "Clearing and
Grubbing".
102.4.2 Payment
102-1
ITEM 103 STRIPPING
103.1 DESCRIPTION
The top soil shall be placed separately from other excavated materials and
be completely removed to the required depth from the area prior to the
beginning of regular excavation or embankment work in that area. No
payment will be made for topsoil removed from places other than that
directed by the Engineer. Engineer shall, however identify the soil as
unsuitable through laboratory tests, before such a decision.
103.3.1 Measurement
103.3.2 Payment
The payment under this item shall be made for at the contract unit price per
cubic meter of stripping measured as above, for removal of material to a
depth approved by the Engineer including its disposal at designated place
and in the manner as directed by the Engineer.
103 Stripping. CM
103-1
ITEM 104 COMPACTION OF NATURAL GROUND.
104.1 DESCRIPTION.
The natural ground or surface ready for construction purposes after clearing
and grubbing or stripping, (if required) will be considered as (natural)
Ground for the purpose of this item. The compaction of natural ground shall
be carried out through a written order by the Engineer.
Up to a depth of twenty (20) cm below the natural ground, all sods and
vegetable matters shall be removed and clear surface shall be broken up by
ploughing and scarifying to compact to the degree as defined below:-
0 to 30 cm 95
30 to 75 cm 93
Over 75 cm 90
Below the foundation of structures 95
104.2.1 Compaction of original ground surface in areas of high water levels and
salinity.
Compaction of the natural ground surface in such areas will be difficult if not
impossible. See Items 108, etc. under Formation of Embankment for
construction requirements under these conditions, where compaction of
Natural Ground shall not be carried out.
104.3.1 Measurement.
104.3.2 Payment.
The payment under this item shall be made for at the contract unit price for
Square meter of compaction of (natural) ground measured as above and
shall be deemed to include cost of scarification, watering, mixing, leveling,
rolling, labour, equipment, tools, and incidentals necessary to complete this
item.
104-1
ITEM 105 ROADWAY AND BORROW EXCAVATION FOR
EMBANKMENT
105.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of excavating the roadway and borrowpits, removal
and satisfactory disposal of all materials taken from within the limits of the
work, also such excavation as is necessary for inlet and outlet ditches of
structures and shall include all excavation, shaping and sloping for the
construction, preparation of all embankment, subgrade, shoulders,
intersections and approaches as directed and in conformity to the alignment,
grade, level and cross-sections shown on the plans or established by the
Engineer.
a) Common Excavation
b) Rock Excavation
This includes firm and rigid igneous, metamorphic and sedimentary rocks.
Boulders larger than quarter (1/4) cubic meter in volume will also be
considered as "Rock Excavation", provided these are firm and stable lying in
continuous bed and constitute more than 50% by volume as compared to
other type of materials in the total mass.
105-1
105.2.2 Borrow Excavation
Borrow Excavation shall comprise all excavation taken from borrow pits.
Material from borrow pits shall normally be used for the construction of
embankment or for the backfill when there is no material available from
roadway excavation or structural excavation. Permission to use material
from borrowpit shall first be obtained in writing from the Engineer.
Nevertheless the total quantity of material from roadway excavation and
structural excavation after deduction of the material declared unsuitable by
the Engineer, shall be considered available for use in the work and any
material used from borrow pits for formation of embankment shall not be
measured for payment.
In making his bid, the Contractor shall inspect the site and prepare his
estimate of the haulage cost on the basis of his own survey of the possible
nature and locations of the borrow pits. Their distance from the work sites
shall not be grounds for extra payment or revision of the contract price.
The consent of the landowner or tenant for excavating the borrow material
and hauling along private access roads shall be secured by the Contractor
who shall, if required, pay for such concession. Borrow pits shall be left in a
condition acceptable to the landowner and/or tenant and the Engineer.
The material shall be declared unsuitable if the soaked CBR (96 hours) is
less than five (5) percent or if falls under A-6 or A-7 of AASHTO soil
classification.
All slopes, except in solid rock or other material shall be trimmed precisely
as per cross-sections, and care must be exercised that no material shall be
loosened beyond the required slopes. In blasting rock slopes, a reasonably
uniform face shall be left, regardless of whether or not the excavation is
carried beyond the specified side slope. All breakage and slides shall be
removed by the contractor and disposed of as directed by the Engineer.
105-2
Rock, shale and other unsuitable road bed material encountered in cuts
shall be excavated to required width and depth indicated on the plans or as
otherwise directed. Any overbreakage below the depth shown on the plans
will not be paid for. Backfill of the overcut shall be of approved earth
material and shall have the same density requirements as specified on the
plans and shall be at the expense of contractor.
Borrowpits shall be located so that the nearest edge of the pit is at least
thirty (30) meters from the roadway toe of slope unless otherwise directed
by the Engineer.
Upon abandonment of borrow pit or quarry area, the contractor shall, at his
own expense, clean and trim the borrow pit or quarry area, the right of way,
and adjoining properties which were occupied during execution of work, all
to the satisfaction of the Engineer.
All drilling and blasting shall be done in such a manner as will most nearly
complete the excavation to the required grade line, and produce the least
disturbance of the material to be left in place. Blasting by means of drill
holes or any other methods shall be performed at the entire risk and
responsibility of the contractor. Care shall be taken to ensure that no injury
be done to persons or properties or to the finished work. Blasting shall be
restricted to the hours prescribed by the local authorities or the Engineer.
Rock material above ground level such as stones, boulders, piles of stone,
and dry stones walling whose individual sizes are greater than one quarter
of a cubic meter shall be removed and disposed of if directed in writing by
the Engineer and shall be paid under relevant item of work in the Bill of
Quantities.
105.4.1 Measurement
105-3
a) Common Excavation
The excavated material approved for fill under any item of the Bill of
Quantities shall be used in the manner as described under the relevant item
of work, irrespective of haulage distance.
b) Rock Excavation
c) Borrow Excavation
105.4.2 Payment
105-4
ITEM 106 EXCAVATION OF UNSUITABLE OR SURPLUS
MATERIAL
106.1 DESCRIPTION
All suitable material excavated within the limits and scope of the project
shall be used in the most effective manner for the formation of the
embankment, for widening of roadway, for backfill, or for other work included
in the contract.
When unsuitable materials are ordered to be removed and replaced, the soil
left in place shall be compacted to a depth of twenty (20) cm to the density
prescribed under Item 108.3.1. Payment for such compaction shall be
included in the contract prices for the excavation materials.
a) Hard Rock
Any rock which can not be removed with Ripper of a 200 H.P. Bulldozer and
constitutes a firm and continuous bed of rock only.
b) Medium Rock
Any rock which can not be removed with the blade of 200 H.P. Buldozer but
can be removed by the ripper, will be termed as Medium Rock, irrespective
of the fact that it is removed by blasting.
c) Soft Rock
Any rock which can be removed with the blade of a 200 H.P. Bulldozer. This
item will be termed as Soft Rock, irrespective of the fact that it is removed
by blasting.
106-1
106.3 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
106.3.1 Measurement
The under mentioned Pay Item Nos. 106 a, 106 b, 106 c, and 106 d shall
include the cost of obtaining the consent of the owner or tenant of the land
where the disposal of surplus or unsuitable material is made.
106.3.2 Payment
106-2
ITEM 107 STRUCTURAL EXCAVATION AND BACKFILL
107.1 DESCRIPTION
a) Grading Requirement
Sieve Designation Percent Passing
mm Inch. A B
--------------------- ------- --------
c) The material shall have a Plasticity Index of not more than size (6) as
determined by AASHTO T-89 and T-90.
107-1
107.2.3 Common backfill
Use of excavated material as backfill may be allowed under this item. Use of
borrow material for common backfill shall be allowed subject to approval of
borrow material by the Engineer.
a) General
b) Preservation of channel
c) Depth of Footings
107-2
d) Preparation of Foundations of Footings
i) All rock or other hard foundation material shall be freed from all loose
material, cleaned and cut to a firm surface, either leveled, stepped, or
roughened, as may be directed by the Engineer.
iii) When conditions are encountered which, in the opinion of the Engineer,
render it impracticable to dewater the foundation before placing masonry,
he may require the construction of a concrete foundation seal of such
dimensions as may be necessary. The foundation water shall then be
pumped out and the balance of the masonry placed in the dry. When
weighted cribs are employed and the weight is utilized to partially
overcome the hydrostatic pressure acting against the bottom of the
foundation seal, special anchorage such as dowels or keys shall be
provided to transfer the entire weight of the crib into the foundation seal.
During the placing of a foundation seal, the elevation of the water inside
the cofferdam shall be controlled to prevent any flow through the seal,
and if the cofferdam is to remain in place, it shall be vented or ported at
low water level.
107-3
f) Pumping
i) Pumping from the interior of any foundation enclosure shall be done in
such a manner as to preclude the possibility of the movement of water
through any fresh concrete. No pumping of water will be permitted
during the placing of concrete or for a period of at least twenty four (24)
hours thereafter, unless it is done from a suitable sump pit separated
from the concrete work by a watertight wall or other effective means.
ii) Pumping to unwater a sealed cofferdam shall not commence until the
seal has set sufficiently to with stand the hydrostatic pressure.
g) Inspection
After each excavation is completed the Contractor shall notify the Engineer,
and no concrete or masonry shall be placed until the Engineer has approved
the depth of the excavation and the character of the foundation material.
h) Classification of Excavation
Unless otherwise specified, the Contractor may choose with the approval of
the Engineer to excavate for structures, culverts, and pipe culverts after the
embankment has been placed. Any space remaining after the placing of
such structures or culverts shall be filled with material approved by the
Engineer and compacted as follows :
The excavation in embankment and the placing of backfill for the purposes
described above shall not constitute any claim for payment. also if sand or
granular backfill is used by the contractor for his convenience, no extra
payment will be made.
107-4
107.3.3 Backfill
a) Granular backfill where-ever directed shall be placed in the position and
to the required depth, shown on the drawings or where and as required
in writing by the Engineer and it shall be well compacted in layers not
exceeding twenty (20) cm in thickness to 100 percent of Max. dry density
as per AASHTO T-180 (D). In case of water logged areas the thickness
of the layer shall not exceed fifty (50) centimeters or as directed by the
Engineer. Volume of granular fill around structures shall be calculated
within the vertical limits of approved excavation for such a structure,
where as the horizontal limits shall be those as specified on drawings.
b) Common backfill shall consist of earth free from large lumps, wood and
other organic materials and of a quality acceptable to the Engineer. It
shall be placed in the position and to the required depths shown on the
Drawings and/or as required in writing by the Engineer and it shall be
well compacted in layers not to exceed twenty (20) cms in depth to the
density, 95 percent of maximum dry density, as per AASHTO T-180 (D).
c) The rock backfill material whose individual sizes are not more than 30 cm
shall be placed in the position to the required depth as specified and the
voids shall be filled in layer of fine material approved by the Engineer.
The compacting efforts shall be made so as to achieve the desired
compaction approved visually by the Engineer. The depth of the layer in
any case shall not exceed sixty (60) centimeters. However in water
logged areas, the thickness may be increased as directed by the
Engineer. Rock backfill will not be placed within two meters from
concrete face of any structure.
e) The fill behind abutments and wing walls of all bridge structures shall be
deposited in well-compacted, horizontal layers not to exceed twenty (20)
cm. in thickness. The common backfill in front of such units shall be
placed first to prevent the possibility of forward movement.
107-5
f) Fill placed around culverts and piers shall be deposited on both sides to
approximately the same elevation at the same time. Where the
Contractor does not have proper equipments to ensure compaction in
restricted areas, Engineer may allow backfill with sand saturation
method, at no extra cost to the Client.
g) Adequate provision shall be made for the through drainage of all backfill.
French drains shall be placed as weep holes.
107.4.1 Measurement
a) Structural Excavation
107-6
b) Granular Backfill
c) Common Backfill
107.4.2 Payment
107-7
ITEM 108 FORMATION OF EMBANKMENT
108.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of formation of embankment, including preparation of
area for placing and compaction of embankment material in layers and in
holes, pits and other depressions within the roadway area in accordance
with the specifications and in conformity with the lines, grades, thickness
and typical cross-section shown on the plans or established by the
Engineer.
The material under this item shall conform to the following specification.
a) Contractor shall use AASHTO Class A-1, A-2, A-3, A-4 or A-5
soil as specified in AASHTO M-145 or other material approved
by the Engineer.
b) CBR of the material shall not be less than five (5) percent,
determined in accordance with AASHTO T-193. CBR value shall
be obtained at a density corresponding to the degree of
compaction required for the corresponding layer.
108-1
the lines, grades, sections and dimensions shown on the Drawings or as
required by the Engineer. The layers of loose material other than rock shall
be not more than 20 cm. thick, unless otherwise allowed by the Engineer
after a trial section is prepared and approved.
The material placed in layers and that scarified to the designated depth for
formation of embankment shall be compacted to the density specified
below:
0 to 30 95
30 to 75 93
Over 75 90
Embankment material that does not contain sufficient moisture to obtain the
required compaction shall be given additional moisture by means of
approved sprinklers and mixing. Material containing more than the optimum
moisture may not, without written approval of the Engineer, be incorporated
in the embankment until it has been sufficiently dried out. The drying of wet
material may be expedited by scarification, disking or other approved
methods.
108-2
Side slopes shall be neatly trimmed to the lines and slopes shown on the
drawings or as directed by the Engineer, and the finished work shall be left
in a neat and acceptable condition.
The material shall be carefully placed in layers, so that all larger stones will
be well distributed and voids completely filled with smaller stones, clean
small spells, shale, earth, sand, gravel, to form a solid mass. After placing
rock material, surface shall be covered with a layer of fine material having
thickness less than twenty (20) centimeters. Such fine material shall be
reserved from roadway excavation by the Contractor. Should such material
be available but not reserved, Contractor will supply and place borrow
material for forming smooth grade without extra payment.
Each layer shall be bladed or leveled with motor grader, bulldozer or similar
equipment capable of shifting and forming the layer into a neat and orderly
condition. No rock larger than eight (8) centimeters in any dimension shall
be placed in the top fifteen (15) centimeters of embankment unless
otherwise allowed by the Engineer.
Material for each layer should be consolidated with heavy weight vibratory
roller until settlement as checked between two consecutive passes of roller
is less that one (1) percent of the layer thickness. In evaluation of
settlement, survey points should be established and rolling continued until
difference of levels as checked after two consecutive passes is less than
one (1) percent of the total layer thickness. More over initial rolling of
overlaid fine material shall be done without watering to ensure their intrusion
in voids of rock layer beneath. Watering shall be done when voids are
properly filled.
Embankments, which are formed of material that contain rock but also
contain sufficient compactable material other than rock or other hard
material to make rolling feasible, shall be placed and compacted in the
manner prescribed above and to the point when settlement is within above
mentioned requirement. Compaction test will be made whenever the
Engineer determines they are feasible and necessary. Each layer must be
approved by the Engineer before the next layer is placed.
108-3
When rock to be incorporated in fill is composed largely of weak or friable
material, the rock shall be reduced to a maximum size not exceeding fifty
(50) percent of the thickness of the layer being placed.
Cut material shall be incorporated with the new embankment material and
compacted in horizontal layers. No extra payment will be allowed for such
an operation.
Where embankments are to be placed in water logged areas and which are
inaccessible to heavy construction equipment, a special working platform
shall be first established, consisting of a blanket of fill material placed on top
of the soft layer. The material of the working table shall consist of normal or
processed granular fill, obtained from borrow excavation. This material shall
conform to the following specifications:
The remaining grading shall be such as to avoid intrusion into the working
platform material of subgrade or natural ground surface material. For this
condition to be met it will be required that the ratio.
D85 and D15 mean the particle diameters corresponding to 85% and 15%,
respectively, passing (by weight) in a grain size analysis.
Construction of this working table shall proceed from one edge of the soft
area by using the fill as a ramp for further material transport.
108-4
The thickness of the working table as prescribed above shall be
approximately 0.5 meter unless directed otherwise by the Engineer, and the
width shall be that of the embankment. The placement and compaction of
the working table shall be carried out by use of light equipment, as directed
by the Engineer.
No density requirements are specified for the working platform, however,
subsequent layers above it shall be compacted to the densities specified in
Item 108.3.1.
The Contractor shall be responsible for the stability of all embankments and
shall replace any portions that in the opinion of the Engineer have been
damaged or displaced due to carelessness or neglect on the part of the
Contractor. Embankment material which may be lost or displaced as a result
of natural causes such as storms, cloud-burst or as a result of unavoidable
movement or settlement of the ground or foundation upon which the
embankment is constructed shall be replaced by the Contractor with
acceptable material from excavation or borrow. No additional compensation
will be allowed for the replacement.
During construction, the roadway shall be kept in shape and drained out at
all times. When unsuitable material has been placed in the embankment by
the Contractor, he shall remove it without extra payment.
108.4.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters calculated
on theoretical designed lines and grades and the ground levels as
established under clause 100.9, compacted in place, accepted by the
Engineer formed with material resulting from:
108-5
i) Formation of Embankment from Borrow Excavation
108.4.2 Payment.
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters placed in
embankment, measured as provided above for material from borrow
excavation and such a payment will be deemed to include cost of
excavation, payment of royalty, levies and taxes of Local, Provincial and
Federal Government, cost of hauling including all lead and lift, spreading,
watering, rolling, labour, equipment, tools and incidental necessary to
complete this item.
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters placed in
embankment and measured as provided above for material from structural
excavation and such payment will be deemed to include cost of hauling,
dumping, spreading, watering, rolling, labour, equipment, tools and
incidental necessary to complete this item.
108-6
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters placed in
embankment and measured as provided above for material from roadway
excavation and such payment will be deemed to include cost of excavation,
hauling, dumping, spreading, watering, rolling, labour, equipment, tools and
incidental necessary to complete this item.
i. Hard Rock CM
ii. Medium Rock CM
iii. Soft Rock CM
i. Hard Rock CM
ii. Medium Rock CM
iii. Soft Rock CM
108-7
ITEM 109 SUBGRADE PREPARATION
109.1 DESCRIPTION
The subgrade preparation shall be that part of the work on which, the
subbase is placed or, in the absence of subbase, act as the base of the
pavement structure. It shall extend to the full width of the road bed including
the shoulders and laybyes as indicated on the Drawings or as specified
herein.
Before commencing the work all culverts, drains, ditches including fully
compacted backfill over them outlets for drainage, head walls/wing walls of
culverts and any other minor structure below thirty (30) centimeters of
existing subgrade level or all structures which will be below thirty (30)
centimeters of newly placed subgrade level, shall be in such operative
conditions as to ensure prompt and effective drainage and to avoid damage
to subgrade by surface water. No work of subgrade preparation will be
started before the prior work herein described have been approved by the
Engineer.
All materials down to a depth of 30 cm below the subgrade level in earth cut
or embankment shall be compacted to at least 95 percent of the maximum
dry density as determined according to AASHTO T-180 Method 'B' or 'D'
whichever is applicable, or corresponding Relative Density as per D-
4254-83 (ASTM).
In case, the bottom of subgrade is below the natural ground by more than
Thirty (30) cm, the material above the top of subgrade shall be removed and
subsequent layer of thirty (30) cm shall be scarified, broken up, adjusted to
moisture content and compacted to the same degree of compaction as
described above.
109-1
In case, unsuitable material is encountered at the sub grade level within a
depth of thirty (30) cm, the same shall be removed in total and replaced by
the approved material. The contractor shall be paid for removal of
unsuitable material as per pay Item 106a and for replacement of approved
material, the payment will be made under pay Item 108c.
No rock shall be higher than two (2) centimeters above the under cut section
elevation. The under cut material shall be placed in embankment or
disposed of at the direction of Engineer.
When the subgrade is formed in embankment, its width shall be the full
width of top of embankment and material placed in the upper part of
embankment down to a depth of thirty (30) centimeters below subgrade
level shall meet compaction requirement of 109.2.2. Soils having a minimum
value of C.B.R of seven (7) percent and swell value of not more than 0.3
percent shall be used. C.B.R less than seven (7)% may be used in case, the
design allows for it. Unsuitable material if encountered within the existing
formation layer as per laboratory specified test, shall be removed, disposed
of and replaced by suitable one as per direction of the Engineer of which the
payment will be made under relevant items of work.
Rollers and other equipments of approved size and type, accepted by the
Engineer, shall be used for compaction. Water shall be added to obtain
optimum moisture content ; if necessary. Contractor shall ensure proper
compaction in restricted areas by use of special equipments and rollers. No
compensation shall be made for extra work due to restricted space.
Performance of this item of work shall not be paid for under this section but
shall be deemed to be covered by the contract price for pay item 108a,
through 108e, Formation of Embankment.
109-2
the appropriate Pay Item involved. Excavation shall include disposal of any
surplus material in the adjacent embankment or elsewhere as directed by
the Engineer.
The excavated material shall, if declared suitable for use elsewhere in the
embankment by the Engineer be so used, and payment for its removal shall
be covered under the contract price of Pay Item No. 108a; if declared
unsuitable it shall be disposed of and paid as provided in Item 106a. The
finished compacted surface of the subgrade shall be as specified in Item
109.2.3.
Any part of the subgrade that has been completed shall be protected and
kept well drained. Any damage resulting from carelessness of the
Contractor shall be repaired as directed by the Engineer without additional
payment.
The Contractor shall be responsible for all the consequences of traffic being
admitted to the subgrade. He shall repair any ruts or ridges occasioned by
his own traffic or that of others by reshaping and compacting with rollers of
the size and type necessary for such repair. He shall limit the area of
subgrade preparation to an area easily maintained with the equipment
available. Subgrade preparation and subbase or base placing shall be
arranged to follow each other closely. The subgrade, when prepared too
soon in relation to the placing of the subbase, is liable to deteriorate, and in
such case the Contractor shall, without additional payment, repair, reroll, or
recompact the subgrade as may be necessary to restore it to the state
specified herein.
The Contractor shall provide for the use of the Engineer, satisfactory
templates and straightedges in sufficient numbers to check the accuracy of
the work, as provided in these specifications and no subsequent work shall
be permitted until the subgrade levels have been checked and approved by
the Engineer. For tolerances, referred to the, "Table for Allowable
Tolerances" in these specifications.
109-3
109.3.1 Measurement
109.3.2 Payment
109-4
ITEM 110 IMPROVED SUBGRADE
110.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of the formation of the roadbed, under subbase or
base course as the case may be, with an approved blend of materials,
uniformly mixed, compacted, shaped and finished to the lines, grades and
typical cross-sections shown on the Drawings, or in thickness as directed by
the Engineer.
Improved subgrade as herein referred to may be defined as material
suitable for embankment to which better quality of material is blended in
proper proportion to improve its strength properties or performance.
The blending material shall be any soil that classifies as A-1(a), A-1(b), A-
2-4 or A-3 according to AASHTO M-145 with PI of not more than 6.
The blended mixture when compacted to ninety five (95) percent of the
maximum dry density determined by AASHTO T 180-D Method, shall exhibit
a laboratory soaked CBR (96 hours) of not less than 20, or as specified in
the drawings.
110.3.1 Preparation
The blend proportions thus established shall apply only when each material
to be used is obtained from same source. Should a change in source of
material be made, a new proportion shall be established. When
unsatisfactory results or other conditions make it necessary, the Engineer
may require additional laboratory tests.
110-1
110.3.3 Mixing and Spreading
The soil ingredients and water shall be mixed in an approved mixing plant
(Pug Mill). The plant shall be equipped with feeding and metering devices
that will add the materials to be blended in the specified quantities. Water
shall be added during the mixing operation in the quantity required for
proper compaction, which is approximately optimum moisture content plus
or minus two (2) percent. The mixing time shall be that which is required to
secure a uniform mixture. After mixing, the blended material shall be
transported to the job site while it contains the sufficient moisture and shall
be placed on the roadbed by means of an approved mechanical spreader.
The mixture shall be spread at rate that will produce a uniform compacted
thickness conforming to the required grade and cross-section. Compaction
shall start as soon as possible after spreading and shall continue until the
specified relative compaction is achieved.
The traveling plant shall be either a flat transverse shaft type or a windrow
type pugmill. After the materials have been placed by a mechanical
spreader or windrow sizing device the materials shall be uniformly mixed by
the traveling mixing plant. During the mixing operation, water shall be added
as necessary to bring the moisture content of the mixture to the percentage
suitable for proper compaction.
The materials shall be transported to the site and spread in layers on the
roadbed in the quantities required to produce the specified blend. After the
materials for each lift have been spread, the materials shall be mixed by
motor graders and other approved equipment until the mixture is uniform
throughout.
110.3.4 Compaction
110-2
110.3.5 Trial Sections
The object of these trials is to determine the proper moisture content, the
relationship between the number of passes of compacting equipment,
density obtained for the blended material, and to establish the optimum lift
thickness that can be effectively compacted with the equipment used. No
separate payment will be made for this work, which will be regarded as a
subsidiary obligation of the Contractor under pay Item No. 110.
Any part of the completed improved subgrade shall be protected and well
drained and any damage shall be repaired as directed by the Engineer
without additional payment.
The Contractor shall be responsible for all the consequences of traffic being
admitted to the improved subgrade. He shall repair any ruts or ridges
occasioned by his own traffic or that of others by reshaping and compacting
with rollers of the size and type necessary for such repair. He shall limit the
improved subgrade preparation to an area easily maintained with the
equipment available. Subgrade preparation and placement of succeeding
layer to follow each other closely. The improved subgrade, when prepared
too soon in relation to the placing of the layer above it, is liable to
deteriorate, and in such case the Contractor shall, without additional
payment, repair, reroll, or recompact the improved subgrade as may be
necessary to restore it to the state specified herein.
The Contractor shall provide for the use of the Engineer, satisfactory
templates and straightedges in sufficient numbers to check the accuracy of
the work, as provided in these specifications and no subsequent work shall
be permitted until the improved subgrade level have been checked and
approved by the Engineer.
110.3.8 Tolerance
The allowable tolerances for the finished improved subgrade surface prior to
placing the overlying subbase, base or asphaltic concrete course are given
in the relevant, "Table for Allowable Tolerances" in these specifications.
110-3
110.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
110.4.1 Measurement
110.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at
the contract unit price per cubic meter of improved subgrade for the pay
item listed below and shown in the Bill of Quantities, which price and
payment shall constitute full compensation for furnishing all materials,
hauling, mixing, placing in layers, watering and compacting, labour,
equipment, tools and incidentals necessary to complete the item.
110-4
ITEM 111 SOIL CEMENT STABILIZED SUBGRADE
111.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of performing all operations in connection with the
formation of soil cement stabilized subgrade and all incidentals in
accordance with the specifications and in conformity with the lines and level,
grade and typical cross-sections shown on the plans or directed by the
Engineer.
111.2.1 General
The mix in place method of construction shall only be applied to sites with
naturally occurring sand, gravel or sand and gravel mixture. For the
stationary plant method of construction the materials shall comply with the
specifications or materials from any other source selected by the Contractor
shall be subject to the Engineer's approval.
111.2.2 Soil
Soil used for cement stabilization shall be either "Silty or Clayey Soils" or
sandy and gravely soils with the following characteristics
When this type of soil is used for cement stabilization it shall fulfill the
following requirements.
If the soil at site does not have P.H. value specified above, it shall be
improved by adding calcium chloride upto two (2) percent by weight of
the dry soil.
Sandy and gravely soils used for cement stabilization shall fulfill the
following requirements:
111-1
i) Passing maximum size fifty (50) mm sieve 100%
ii) Passing five (5) mm (No. 4) sieve above 50%
iii) Passing 0.4 mm (No. 36) sieve. above 15%
iv) Passing 0.075 mm (No. 200) sieve below 5%
v) Finer than 0.002 mm (Clay) below 3%
Soil which do not meet above requirements shall be subject to the approval
of Engineer after reviewing the laboratory testing results.
111.2.3 Cement
111.2.4 Water
Before starting the work of stabilization, the proposed mix design showing
exact percentage of cement and water to be used so as to obtain a mixture,
shall be submitted by the contractor for the approval of Engineer. The mix
proportions shall be such so as to satisfy the following requirements.
111-2
iii) Maximum permissible tolerance of cement and water content
during construction shall be as under:-
The field equipments used for pulverizing and mixing the stabilized material
shall be approved by the engineer on the basis of preliminary trials to
ensure that the plant is capable of producing the required degree of mixing
and uniformity of stabilized material to the full thickness of layer being
processed. The mixers shall be equipped with a device for controlling the
depth of processing and the mixing blades shall be maintained so that
correct depth of mixing is obtained at all times. The cement shall be spread
ahead of mixer by means of a cement spreader, fitted with a device to
ensure a uniform and controllable rate of spread of cement both
transversely and longitudinally.
The mixing machine shall be set so that, it slightly cuts edge of adjoining
lane processed previously to ensure proper processing of all material
throughout the depth of layer. The output of the mixing plant shall not be
less than twenty five linear meters per hour measured longitudinally of
completed stabilized layer in order to achieve satisfactory compaction.
The stationary plant shall be of the power driven paddle or pan type and
may be of the batch or continuous type. In case the batch mixes are used,
the appropriate measured quantity of material and cement shall first be
placed in the mixer and then water be added as necessary to bring the
moisture content of the resulting mixture with in the range specified above.
111-3
Care shall be taken with batch type paddle mixers to ensure that the cement
is spread uniformly in the loading skip so that it is fed evenly along the
mixing trough and that with both paddle and pan mixers, the cement is
proportioned accurately by a separate weighing or proportioning device from
that used for the material being stabilized. Mixing shall be continued until
the mixture has the uniformity and mixing time will not be less than one (1)
minute.
111.3.3 Compaction
Compaction shall not be carried out after cement hydration and any soils
material, which has been mixed or deposited after cement hydration, shall
be removed and replaced with fresh mixed material.
111.3.4 Tolerance
111.4.1 Measurement
The unit of measurement for payment shall be cubic meter of completed and
accepted subgrade as measured in place. Measurement shall not include
any areas in excess of that shown on the drawings, except the areas
authorized by the Engineer in writing. Measurement of cement content used
shall be the number of metric Ton used to stabilize subgrade. This quantity
of Cement consumed shall not exceed the theoretical percentage
established in the laboratory.
111-4
111.4.2 Payment
112.1 DESCRIPTION
112.2.1 Soil
112.2.2 Lime
Table 112/2
SPECIFICATION REQUIREMENT FOR LIME
Property LIME
Quick Lime Hydrated Lime
(Ca O) Ca (OH)2
Calcium or Magnesium Oxides Not less than 92% Not less than 95%
112-1
112.2.3 Water
Water used for lime stabilization shall be clean and free from injurious
substances. Potable water is preferred and organic water is not permitted.
It shall neither contain more than 1,000 parts per million of chlorides nor
more than 1,300 parts per million of sulphates (SO4). Water from doubtful
sources shall not be used until tested as specified in AASHTO- T-26 and
approved by the Engineer.
The mix design shall be worked out in the laboratory and it shall state the
following field requirements:
(ii) The field density of lime stabilized mixture to minimum ninety five
(95) percent of laboratory density established with modified
AASHTO T-134 test.
112-2
112.3.3 Precautionary Measures
Keeping in view the caustic nature of calcium oxide (quick lime), special
measures shall be taken in handling, since it will attack equipment
corrosively and precautions shall also be taken against the risk of severe
skin burns to personnel. Suitable handling methods shall be used such as
fully mechanised or bottom dump handling equipment, and protective
clothing worn by the operators. Working operations should take into
account the wind direction to minimise the dust problem and consequent
eye or skin irritation to any personnel involved in the vicinity. Even when
calcium hydroxide (slaked or hydrated lime) is used, care must be taken
against the effects of prolonged exposure to skin.
112.3.5 Tolerance
The laying of lime courses shall be avoided as far as practicable during cold
and wet weather and shall be suspended when free standing water is
present on the surface. The stabilized material shall not be laid on any
surface, which is frozen or covered with ice or snow, and laying shall cease
when the atmospheric temperature reaches five (5) degree C. on a falling
thermometer or as directed by the Engineer. If wet weather threatens to be
prolonged, the manufacture and laying of stabilized mix shall be suspended.
112-3
112.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
112.4.1 Measurement
The unit of measurement for payment shall be the cubic meter of the
compacted and accepted subgrade as measured in place. Measurement
shall not include any area in excess of that shown on the drawings, except
the areas authorized by the Engineer in writing. Measurement of lime
consumed shall be the number of metric Ton used to stabilize subgrade.
This quantity of lime consumed shall not exceed the theoretical percentage
established in the laboratory.
112.4.2 Payment
112-4
ITEM 113 BITUMEN STABILIZED SUBGRADE
113.1 DESCRIPTION
113.2.1 Soil
This method will only apply to sites with naturally occurring non plastic
material such as sand. If the material is brought at site, it shall be non-
plastic having uniform gradation.
113.2.2 Bitumen
Bituminous material used for subgrade stabilization shall comply with the
requirement as per relevant tables specified in item 301, "Asphaltic
Materials" for hot mix asphaltic concrete or can be viscous cut back that
requires heating in areas where moisture content of sand is high,
necessitating heating and drying of sand.
In dry areas, where natural moisture content of sand is low, the bituminous
binder shall be fluid cut back conforming the requirements as given in tables
301-3 and 301-4 respectively of item 301 "Asphaltic Materials".
Bitumen emulsion or foamed penetration grade bitumen can also be used
subject to the approval of Engineer after trial test.
Equipment, tools, and machines used for bitumen stabilized subgrade shall
be subject to the approval of Engineer and shall be maintained in
satisfactory working conditions all the times.
113-1
The stabilized soil shall be left uncompacted after pulverization and mixing
to allow for evaporation of volatile materials thus increasing stability and
decreasing water absorption particularly in fine grained sand when
temperature is low.
113.3.1 Compaction
The results of CBR test for measuring the strength of bitumen stabilized
materials or cone stability test for designing bitumen-sand mixture shall not
supersede those of Marshall Test unless agreed by the Engineer. In-situ
density of compacted layer shall be determined using method as described
by AASHTO - T-191, AASHTO - T-205 or AASHTO - T-238 and shall be
minimum ninety five (95) % modified AASHTO according to the above
mentioned methods.
113.3.2 Tolerance
113-2
113.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
113.4.1 Measurement
113.4.2 Payment
113-3
ITEM 114 DRESSING AND COMPACTION OF BERMS
114.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of scarification of berms, which are undulated, or out
of level. The existing material shall be scarified, watered, mixed and
properly leveled and compacted according to specification described here
under or as directed by the Engineer.
In case the berms show undulation of more than 5 cms in level from the
reconstructed pavement structure, the berms shall be scarified to a depth of
15 cm and material will be watered, mixed and compact with appropriate
equipment approved by the Engineer.
Compaction requirement as
Depth in cm per AASHTO T-180 (D).
114-1
114.3.4 Compaction of slopes
114.4.1 Measurement
The quantity of material thus measured shall be paid under other items of
works of formation of embankment / subbase.
114.4.2 Payment
The payment of this item shall be made for at the contract unit price per
square meter of dressed and compacted berm measured as above, for
scarification watering, mixing, rolling, labour, equipment, tools and
incidentals necessary to complete this item.
114-2
ITEM 115 REINSTATEMENT OF SHOULDERS FROM BRICK KILN
MATERIAL
115.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing and placing in single layer of Brick Kiln
material on shoulders and to mechanically interlock by watering and rolling,
in conformity with lines, grades and cross-sections shown on drawing.
115.2.1 Texture
The Kiln material shall be fully burnt having reddish brown/black colour. No
unburnt or semi burnt material shall be allowed. The material shall behave
like improved sub grade with following properties.
115.2.2 Gradation
Note:- Coarser than 1" (25 mm) size material may be allowed upto five
(5) percent by the Engineer.
115-1
115.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
115.3.1 General
Side slopes shall be neatly trimmed to the lines and slopes shown on the
drawings or as directed by the Engineer, and the finished work shall be kept
in a neat and acceptable condition.
115.3.2 Compaction
All material shall be compacted to a minimum ninety five (95) percent of the
maximum dry density as determined according to AASHTO T-180 method
'B' or 'D' whichever is applicable. In place density determination of the
compacted layer shall be made in accordance with AASHTO T-191 or other
approved method.
115.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
115.4.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number in cubic meter by the
theoretical volume of shoulders constructed according to designed lines and
grades compacted in place and complete in all respect.
115-2
115.4.2 Payment
200.1 DESCRIPTION
The material shall consist of sand, gravel or a sand gravel mixture obtained
from the source approved by the Engineer. Material requirements for this
work are specified under various items of the section.
Preliminary approval of source shall not mean that all the material in the
source is approved.
200-1
200.2.2 Selection of Place for Sampling
The number and size of sample required depends on the intended use of
the material, the quantity of material involved and the variation both in
quality and size of aggregate. A sufficient number of samples shall be
obtained to cover all variations in the material. The quantities must be
sufficient to provide for proper execution of the required tests.
200.2.4 Schedule for Sampling and Testing
The sampling frequency, acceptance limits, and other information for proper
control of each work shall be as given in "Tables for Sampling and Testing
Frequency" which will provide the minimum testing frequency under normal
conditions. Where sampling frequencies are not given in the table they shall
be as directed by the Engineer. Where frequencies are given as per layer or
per strip this will mean the width of strip or layer being laid at any one item.
If the materials or operations are variable and good control is difficult to
maintain, greater sampling frequency may be taken as directed by the
Engineer.
200.2.5 Tolerances
The allowable tolerances for the subgrade prior to placing the overlying
courses, together with the allowable tolerances for the subbase and base
are as specified in "Table for Allowable Tolerances", in these specifications.
All equipment, tools and machines used in the performance of work shall be
maintained in satisfactory conditions at all times and be subject to the
approval of the Engineer. List of recommended type of equipment is only for
guidance of contractor. However contractor will be responsible to give
required quality and workmanship through any type of equipment
irrespective of any approval given by the Engineer.
200-2
200.4 TRIAL STRIPS
Contractor shall prepare trial strip for any item as appearing in this chapter,
to establish the following.
Engineer shall then inspect and test the Trial Strip and approve the
procedure in writing, to carry out the work. However this approval shall not
relieve the contractor from his contractual obligation.
200-3
ITEM 201 GRANULAR SUBBASE
201.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of furnishing, spreading in one or more layers and
compacting granular subbase according to the specifications and drawings
and/or as directed by the Engineer.
The material shall comply to the following grading and quality requirements:
201-1
b) The Material shall have a CBR value of at least 50%, determined
according to AASHTO T-193. The CBR value shall be obtained
at a density corresponding to Ninety eight (98) percent of the
maximum dry density determined according to AASHTO T-180
Method-D.
e) The fraction passing the 0.075 mm (No. 200) sieve shall not be
greater than two third of the fraction passing the 0.425 mm (No.
40) sieve. The fraction passing the 0.425 mm sieve shall have a
liquid limit of not greater than 25 and a plasticity index of 6 or
less.
f) If over-size is encountered, screening of material at source, shall
invariably be done, no hand picking shall be allowed, however
hand picking may be allowed by the Engineer, if over-size
quantity is less than 5% of the total mass.
201.3.1 Spreading
201-2
When the required thickness is fifteen (15) cm or less, the aggregates may
be spread and compacted as one layer, but in no case shall a layer be less
than seven and one half (7.5) centimeters thick. Where the required
thickness is more than 15 cm, the aggregates shall be spread and
compacted in 2 or more layers of approximately equal thickness, but in any
case the maximum compacted thickness of one layer shall not exceed
15 cm. All subsequent layers shall be spread and compacted in a similar
manner.
Granular subbase shall be spread with equipment that will provide a uniform
layer conforming to the specified item both transversely and longitudinally
within the tolerances as specified in "Table for Allowable Tolerances" in
these specifications. No hauling or placement of material will be permitted
when, in the judgment of the Engineer, the weather or road conditions are
such that the hauling operation will cause cutting or rutting of subgrade or
contamination of sub base material.
201.3.3 Compaction
201-3
If the layer of subbase material, or part thereof does not conform to the
required finish, the Contractor shall, at his own expense, rework, water, and
recompact the material before succeeding layer of the pavement structure is
constructed.
Immediately prior to the placing of first layer of base course the subbase
layer (both under the traveled way and the shoulders) shall conform to the
required level and shape. Prior to placing the succeeding layers of
the material, the top surface of each layer shall be made sufficiently moist to
ensure bond between the layers. The edges or edge slopes shall be bladed
or otherwise dressed to conform to the lines and dimensions shown on the
plans.
No material for construction of the base shall be placed until the subbase
has been approved by the Engineer.
The relative compaction of each layer of the compacted subbase shall not
be less than Ninety eight (98) percent of the maximum dry density
determined according to AASHTO T-180 Method-D. The field density shall
be determined according to AASHTO T-191 or other approved method. For
all materials, the field density thus obtained shall be adjusted to account for
oversize particles (retained on 19 mm sieve) as directed by the Engineer.
Also for adjustment of any material retained on 4.75 mm sieve, AASHTO
Method T-224 shall be used
201.3.5 Moisture Content Determination
The subbase shall be compacted to the desired level and cross slopes as
shown on the drawings. The allowable tolerance shall be according to the
"Table for Allowable Tolerances" in these specifications.
201-4
201.4.2 Payment
202.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of furnishing, spreading and compacting one (1) or
more layers of aggregate base on a prepared subgrade, subbase, or
existing road surface, in accordance with the specifications and the
drawings and/or as directed by the Engineer.
Material for aggregate base course shall consist of crushed hard durable
gravel, rock or stone fragments. It shall be clean and free from organic
matters, lumps of clay and other deleterious substances. The material shall
be of such a nature that it can be compacted readily under watering and
rolling to form a firm, stable base for both flexible and rigid pavements.
The aggregate base shall comply to the following grading and quality
requirements.
a) The gradation curve of the material shall be smooth and within the
envelope limits for Grading A or B given below.
The material shall be well graded such that the coefficient of Uniformity
D60/D10 shall be greater than four (4).
202-1
c) The Coarse aggregate shall have a percentage of wear by the Loss
Angeles Abrasion test (AASHTO T-96) of not more than forty (40).
d) The material shall have a loss of less than twelve (12) percent when
subjected to five cycles of the Sodium Sulphate Soundness test
according to AASHTO T-104.
202-2
Spreading shall conform in all respects to the requirements specified under
this heading in Item 201 - Subbase (201.3.1).
202.3.2 Compaction
The relative compaction of each layer of the compacted base shall not be
less than 100 percent to the maximum dry density determined according to
AASHTO T-180, Method D (Modified). The field density shall be determined
according to AASHTO T-191 or other approved method. For all materials,
the field density thus obtained shall be adjusted to account for oversize
particles (retained on 19 mm sieve) as directed by the Engineer. Also for
adjustment of any material retained on 4.75 mm sieve, AASHTO Method T-
224 shall be used
202.3.6 Tolerance
The completed base course shall be tested for required thickness and
smoothness before acceptance. Any area having waves, irregularities in
excess of one (1) cm in three (3) M or two (2) cm in fifteen (15) M shall be
corrected by scarifying the surface, adding approved material, reshaping,
re-compacting and finishing as specified. Skin patching of an area without
scarifying the surface to permit proper bonding of added material shall not
be permitted. The allowable tolerances shall be according to the "Table for
Allowable Tolerances" in these specifications.
202-3
202.4.1 Measurement
202.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantities measured as above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price per cubic meter of aggregate base, for the item listed below and
shown in the Bill of Quantities, which price and payment shall constitute full
compensation for furnishing all materials, hauling, placing, watering, rolling,
labour, equipment, tools and incidentals necessary to complete this item.
Pay Item Description Unit of
No. Measurement
------------------------------------------------------------------------
202-4
ITEM 203 ASPHALTIC BASE COURSE PLANT MIX
203.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing of plant, labour, equipment and material
and performing all operations in connection with the construction of an
asphaltic plant-mix base course on a previously constructed and accepted
subgrade, subbase or base course, subject to terms and conditions of the
Contract, and in strict accordance with this Section of the Specification, the
Drawings and the directions of the Engineer.
The crushing shall be so regulated that at least ninety five (95) percent by
weight of material retained on AASHTO No. 4 sieve shall consist of pieces
with at least two (2) mechanically fractured faces, and when tested for
stability of bituminous mix shall show satisfactory stability.
Fine aggregate which is material passing No. 4 sieve, shall consist of 100%
crushed material from rock or boulder. No natural sand will be allowed in
the mix.
When the combined grading of the coarse and fine aggregates is deficient in
material passing No. 200 sieve, additional filler material shall be added. The
filler material shall consist of finely divided rock dust, hydrated lime,
hydraulic cement or other suitable mineral matter. However, in case the
coarse aggregates are of quartizitic nature, then hydrated lime or a better
material shall be allowed. At the time of use, it shall be sufficiently dry to
flow freely. Filler material shall conform to following gradation:
No. 30 100
No. 50 95-100
No. 200 70-100
203-1
The coarse and fine aggregates shall meet the following applicable
requirements:
d) Fine aggregates shall have a liquid limit not more than twenty
five (25) and a Plasticity Index of not more than six (6) as
determined by AASHTO T 89 and T-90.
The composition of the asphaltic concrete paving mixtures for base course
shall conform to Class A and/or Class B shown in the following table:
203-2
TABLE 203-1
__________________________________________________________
Compacted Thickness 70 - 90 mm 50 - 80 mm
__________________________________________________________
203-3
The asphalt concrete leveling / base course mixture shall meet the
following Marshall Test Criteria.
a) The hammer weighs 10.2 kg (22.5 Ib.) and has a 149.4 mm (5.88
inches) flat tamping face. Only mechanically-operated device is used for
the same 457 mm (18 inches) drop height.
f) The number of blows needed for the larger specimen is 1.5 times (75 or
112 blows) of that required for the smaller specimen (50 or 75 blows) to
obtain equivalent compaction.
g) The design criteria shall be modified as well, the minimum stability shall
be 2.25 times and the range of flow values shall be 1.5 times normal-
sized specimens.
203-4
At least one (1) week prior to production, a Job-Mix Formula (JMF) for the
asphaltic base course to be used for the project, shall be established jointly
by the Engineer and the Contractor in the project laboratory. Job mix
formula shall combine the mineral aggregates and asphalts in such
proportion conforming to specification requirements.
The JMF, with the allowable tolerances shall be within the range specified in
Item 203.2.3. Each JMF shall indicate a single percentage of aggregate
passing each required sieve size and a single percentage of bitumen to be
added to the aggregate.
The ratio of wt. of filler (passing sieve No. 200) to that of asphalt shall range
between 1–1.5 for hot climate areas with temperature more than 40oC.
After the JMF is established, all mixtures furnished for the project
represented by samples taken from the asphalt plant during operation, shall
conform thereto Moreover upon receiving the job-mix, approved by the
Engineer, the Contractor shall adjust his plant to proportion the individual
aggregates, mineral filler and asphalt to produce a final mix that, when
compared to job mix formula shall be within the following limits.
203-5
Asphalt Content
Before being fed to the dryer, aggregates for the asphaltic base courses
shall be separated into three or more sizes and stored separately in cold
bins. One bin shall contain aggregate of such size that eighty (80) percent
will pass sieve No. 4, and the other two bins shall contain aggregate of such
sizes that eighty (80) percent will be retained on sieve No. 4. Should fine
material, be incorporated in the mix, separate bin shall be provided in
addition to the three bins mentioned above. If filler is used as a separate
component it will also be stored and measured separately and accurately
before being fed into the mixer through filler screw mechanism.
203-6
Dried aggregate weighed and drawn to pugmill shall be combined with
proportionate quantity of asphalt cement according to the job mix formula.
Temperature of asphalt, except for temporary fluctuations, shall not be lower
than fifteen (15) degrees centigrade below the temperature of the
aggregate, at the time, the two materials enter into the pugmill.
For placing the materials in bins or in moving them from bins to the dryer,
any method which causes segregation or uncontrolled combination of
materials of different grading, shall be discontinued and the segregated or
degraded materials shall be prescreened for reuse.
Dump truck used for hauling bituminous mixtures shall have tight, clean,
smooth metal beds which have been thinly coated with an approved
material to prevent adhering of material to the beds. Each truck shall have
a cover of canvas or of other suitable material of sufficient size as to protect
the mixture from the weather. The mixture will be delivered on the road at a
temperature not less than hundred and thirty (130) degree C. Drivers of
dump trucks will ensure that while reversing the vehicles, paver is not
pushed back producing a hump.
203-7
The screed or strike-off assembly shall be capable of producing a finished
surface of the required evenness and texture without tearing, shoving or
gouging the mixture.
When laying the mixtures, the paver shall be capable of being operated at
forward speeds consistent with satisfactory laying of the mixture. The paver
shall be operated at speeds which will give the best result for the type of
power being used.
The mixed material shall be delivered to paver in time to permit completion
of spreading, finishing and compaction of mixture during day light hours.
The paver shall be equipped with automatic screed controls with sensors for
either or both sides of the paver, capable of sensing grade from an outside
reference line, sensing the transverse slope of the screed and providing the
automatic signals which operates the screed to maintain the desired grade
and transverse slope. The sensor shall be so constructed that it will operate
from a reference line or a ski-like arrangement.
Reference lines will be required for both outer edges of the traveled way for
each main line roadway for vertical control. Horizontal control utilizing the
reference line will be permitted. The grade and slope for intermediate lanes
shall be controlled automatically from reference lines or by means of a ski
and a slope control device or a dual ski arrangement. When the finish of the
grade prepared for paving is superior to the established tolerance and,
when in the opinion of the Engineer, further improvement to the line, grade,
cross sections and smoothness can best be achieved without the use of the
reference line, a ski-like arrangement may be substituted subject to the
approval of the Engineer. The use of the reference lines shall be reinstated
immediately whenever the Contractor fails to maintain a superior pavement.
The Contractor shall furnish and install all pins, brackets, tensioning
devices, wire and accessories necessary for satisfactory operation of the
automatic control equipment.
203.3.5 Rollers
203-8
203.3.6 Preparation of Base or Existing Pavement Surface
After a prime coat is applied, it shall be left undisturbed not less than twenty
four (24) hours. The Contractor shall maintain the primed surface until the
mix material has been placed. This maintenance shall include the
spreading of sand or other approved material, if necessary to prevent
adherence of the prime coat to the tyres of vehicles using the primed
surface, and patching any breaks in the primed surface with additional
bituminous material. Any area of primed surface that has become damaged
shall be repaired before the mix is placed, to the satisfaction of Engineer. It
shall be ensured that primed surface is not in tacky condition, when premix
is laid.
After a tack coat is applied, it shall be allowed to dry until it is in the proper
condition of tackiness to receive the mix. The tack coat shall be applied
only as far in advance of the placing of mix, as is necessary to obtain the
proper condition of tackiness. Any breaks in the tack coat shall be repaired.
When the surface of the existing pavement or old base is irregular, it shall
be brought to uniform grade and cross-section by leveling course as
directed. The leveling course mixture shall conform to the requirements of
Item 203.2.
The longitudinal joint in one layer shall offset to that in the layer immediately
below, by approximately 15.0 cm; however, the joint in the top layer shall be
at the centerline of the pavement if the roadway comprises two lanes of
width, or at lane lines if the roadway is more than 2 lanes in width.
203-9
All mixtures shall be spread at a temperature of not less than hundred and
thirty (130) degree C and all initial rolling or tamping shall be performed
when the temperature of the mixture is such that the sum of the air
temperature plus the temperature of the mixture is between 165 degree C
and 190 degree C. The mixture shall not be placed on any wet surface or
when weather conditions will otherwise prevent its proper handling or
finishing.
203.3.8 Compaction
After spreading and strike off and as soon as the mix condition permits the
rolling to be performed without excessive shoving or tearing, the mixture
shall be thoroughly and uniformly compacted. Rolling shall not be
prolonged when cracks appear on the surface.
The number and weight of rollers shall be sufficient to obtain the required
compaction while the mixture is still in workable condition. The sequence of
rolling and the selection of roller types shall provide the specified pavement
density. Initial rolling with a tandem steel roller or a three-wheeled steel
roller shall follow the paver as closely as possible.
Unless otherwise directed, rolling shall begin at the lower side and proceed
longitudinally, parallel to the road centerline, each trip overlapping one-half
of the roller width, gradually progressing to the crown of the road. When
paving in echelon or abutting a previously placed lane, the longitudinal joint
should be rolled first followed by the regular rolling procedure. On super
elevated curves the rolling shall begin at the low side and progress to the
high side by overlapping of longitudinal trips parallel to the centerline.
Intermediate rolling with a pneumatic tyred roller shall be done behind the
initial rolling. Final rolling shall eliminate marks from previous rolling. In no
case shall the temperature be less than hundred and twenty (120) degree
C. for initial break down rolling while all other compaction operations shall
be completed before the temperature drops down to hundred and ten (110)
degree C.
Rollers shall move at a slow but uniform speed with the drive roll or wheels
nearest the paver. Rolling shall be continued until all roller marks are
eliminated and a minimum density of Ninety seven (97) percent of a
laboratory compacted specimen made from asphaltic material obtained for
daily Marshall density is achieved.
203-10
Along forms, curbs, headers, walls and other places not accessible to the
roller, the mixture shall be thoroughly compacted with hot hand tampers,
smoothing irons or with mechanical tampers. On depressed areas, tempers
be used or cleated compression strips may be used under the roller to
transmit compression to the depressed area.
Any mixture that becomes loose and broken, mixed with dirt, or is in any
way defective in finish or density shall be removed and replaced with fresh
hot mixture, which shall be compacted to conform with the surrounding
area. Any area showing an excess or deficiency of bituminous material shall
be removed and replaced.
One core shall be taken for each 100 linear meter of each lane of Asphaltic
Base, or fraction thereof, in special cases. If the core so taken is failed
against the specified 97% density, then two (2) additional cores shall be
taken in the longitudinal alignment of the road at an interval of three (3)
meters on either side with respect to the failing core and shall be tested
against field density. If all the three cores give an average of 97%
compaction, and the individual compaction of the core is not less than ninety
five (95) percent, then the compaction is acceptable. If average of the cores
further fails against compaction, then retake the cores at a distance of
fifteen (15) meters on either side and compaction shall be checked for all
the five cores in the same fashion. If average of five cores is 97%, the area
will be accepted. In case average is ninety six 96% or more, then Engineer
may withhold the payment in full or partly and observe behaviour during
maintenance period, for the release of payment or otherwise. In case of
failure of the average of these five cores giving average compaction of less
then 96%, the failed area shall be removed and subsequently be replaced
by specified mix in an approved manner at the expense of contractor.
After completion of final rolling, the finished surface shall be tested for
smoothness with three (3) meters straightedge by Engineer at selected
locations. The variation of surface from testing edge of straight edge
between any two (2) contacts with the surface shall at no point exceed six
(6) millimeters when placed either parallel or perpendicular to centreline of
roadway.
Any irregularities that exceed the specified tolerances or that retain water on
the surface shall be corrected by removing the defective area and replacing
with new asphaltic base course without additional cost to the Employer.
203-11
203.3.11 Base Thickness Tolerances
For determination of thickness, one (1) core for each hundred (100) linear
meter of each lane shall be taken. Unless otherwise permitted, cores
extracted for thickness measurement shall not be used for density
determination and density cores shall not be used for thickness
measurements.
Contractor shall prepare a trial section before the start of work in light of
procedure given in clause 1.20 (General).
203.4.1 Measurement
203-12
203.4.2 Payment
204.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of performing all operations in connection with the
construction of cement stabilized subbase or base and all incidentals in
accordance with the specifications in conformity with the lines, grade,
thickness and typical cross-sections shown on the plans or as directed by
the Engineer.
Fraction Passing 0.075 mm (No. 200) shall not be greater than two-third of
the fraction passing the 0.425 mm (No. 40) sieve. The fraction passing
0.425 mm (No. 40) sieve shall have a liquid limit not greater than 25% and
plasticity index not greater than 6.
Sandy and gravely soils used for cement stabilization shall fulfill the
following grading requirements.
204.2.2 Cement
204.2.3 Water
Water used for cement stabilized base course or subbase shall conform in
all respect to requirements specified under sub-item 112.2.3.
204-1
204.2.4 Mix Design Requirements in Laboratory
iv) Bituminous material for curing seal shall be any one of the
following :
204-2
204.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
If stationary plant is used, it shall be of the power driven paddle or pan type
and may be of batch or continuous type.
If batch mixer is used, measured amount of material and cement shall first
be placed in mixer, water being added to bring moisture content of mixture
within the optimum range. Mixing shall be continued until mixture is
uniformly mixed but in no case less than one minute mixing time.
The plant shall be equipped with feeding and metering devices that add the
materials; cement and water into the mixer in specified quantities; mixed
thoroughly and sufficiently to obtain intimate and uniform mixture with out
cement lumps.
The mixture shall be transported to paving area in trucks or other approved
equipments having clean bed within a maximum hauling time of forty five
(45) minutes.
204-3
Moisture content of the material shall be adjusted to optimum using water
sprayer of such design that water is discharged in uniform and controllable
manner both transversely and longitudinally.
For large area, a series of parallel lanes of convenient length and width
meeting approval of Engineer shall be built with true vertical face free of
loose or shattered material.
204.3.4 Compaction
The thickness of layer shall be as shown on the Drawings but in no case
shall be less than eight (8) centimeters. If thickness of each layer does not
exceed twenty centimeters, it shall be constructed as one layer. If thickness
of layer exceeds twenty (20) centimeters, it shall be constructed in two or
more layers each within the range of eight (8) to twenty (20) centimeters in
compacted thickness.
The mixture shall be spread and finished true to crown and grade by
machine or hand method where machine methods are impracticable as
determined by the Engineer and shall be thoroughly compacted with
approved rollers until entire depth and width of subbase/base is uniformly
compacted to maximum density of 95% as tested according to procedure
outlined in AASHTO T-134.
Compaction shall not take place after cement hydration and any material
that has been mixed or deposited after cement has hydrated shall be
removed and replaced with fresh mix material.
204-4
204.3.5 Preliminary Trial
At least one (1) week before main work of stabilization is started contractor
shall construct a trial section of two hundred (200) meters in length at
location approved by the Engineer with same material, equipment, mix
proportion and construction procedure that he proposes to use for the main
work.
204.3.6 Curing/Maintenance
204.3.7 Tolerance
204-5
204.4.1 Measurement
204.4.2 Payment
204-6
205.1 DESCRIPTION
205.2.1 Aggregates
Material for graded crushed aggregates shall in all respects conform with
the requirements specified under Item 202, with the following exceptions
and supplementary requirements:
a) The portion of the aggregate retained on the 9.5 mm. (3/8 inch)
sieve shall not contain more than 10 percent by weight of flat
and/or elongated particles (ratio of maximum to minimum
dimension = 2.5:1).
205-1
50 2 100
37.5 1.1/2 75-90
19 3/4 50-70
4.75 No. 4 8-20
0.15 No. 100 0-5
Asphalt Cement Content of total Mix 2-3% by weight
Mixing Time 30 seconds (Maximum)
Mix Design Within Master Range Gradation
The exact percentage of asphalt cement content shall be such that at least
Ninety five (95) percent coating of aggregates will be achieved when tested
in accordance with AASHTO T-195.
205-2
c) All traffic shall be kept off this layer until a subsequent layer has
been placed on it. Any damage caused by traffic moving directly
on the crack-relief layer shall be the responsibility of the
Contractor and all necessary repair work thereto shall be at the
Contractor's expense.
205.4.1 Measurement
The quantity of asphaltic open graded crack relief layer shall be measured
in cubic meters by taking out cores as detailed for Base Course Asphalt
under item 203.4.1
The quantity of Asphaltic material is included in the mixture and will not be
measured separately.
205.4.2 Payment
205-3
ITEM 206 WATER BOUND MACADAM BASE
206.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing and placing one or more courses of
clean crushed stone base mechanically interlocked by rolling, and voids
thereof filled with screening and binding material with the assistance of
water, laid on a prepared subgrade, sub base, or existing pavement in
conformity with the lines, grades and cross-sections shown on the drawings.
Unless otherwise directed by the Engineer this item of work may be applied
to road structure or shoulders.
Sieve Designation
mm Inch Percent Passing by weight
The material passing No. 40 sieve shall have a liquid Limit of not more than
twenty five (25) percent and a Plasticity Index of not more than six (6).
206-1
206.2.1 Physical Requirements
206.3.1 Equipment
Preparation of surface for water bound macadam, shall be carried out in the
same manner as for aggregate base course item 202.3.1.
Where the existing road surface is black topped, 50 mm x 50 mm furrows
shall be cut in the existing surface at one (1) meter intervals at forty five (45)
degree to the centre line of the carriage-way before proceeding with the
laying of coarse aggregates.
206-2
206.3.3 Spreading and Compaction
Following the initial rolling, dry screenings shall be applied uniformly over
the surface. Dry rolling shall be continued while screenings are being
applied. The surface shall be swept with mechanical or hand brooms to aid
spreading of the screenings.
When the interstices in the coarse aggregate are filled with screenings, the
surface shall be sprinkled with water until it is saturated. The rolling,
sprinkling and application of additional screenings shall continue until a
grout is formed that fills all the voids and forms a wave of grout in front of
the roller.
When more than one layer is required to complete the Macadam base
course to the thickness shown on the drawings, each layer shall be
constructed as before prescribed.
206.3.5 Maintenance
206-3
206.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
206.4.1 Measurement
206.4.2 Payment
207.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall be carried out in patches of roads where the existing road
base material has moved and is lying in loose condition. Requirement under
this item is to remove the existing road base and to strengthen it to take new
layer of aggregate or water bound macadam base.
Patches of roads in which surface courses have broken and road base has
moved, the material which has lost its compaction shall be removed. Next
layer shall be watered and compacted, thereby the removed material shall
be placed back duly screened to remove plastic contamination, by hand
picking and passing though sieve No. 4. after properly watering and mixing.
Material will be recompacted in layers not exceeding fifteen (15) cms thick
with approved equipments. Additional material will be added, if needed
particularly non-plastic fines passing sieve No. 4.
207.4.1 Measurement
207.4.2 Payment
207-1
ITEM 208 REINSTATEMENT OF ROAD SURFACE
208.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of reinstatement of worn out road surface with a
material approved by the Engineer. Pot holes, ditches and depressions
shall be filled with the approved materials in layers in conformity with lines,
grades, sections and dimensions, as directed by the Engineer.
The material used under this item shall conform to the material requirement
of different B.O.Q. items selected for use by the Engineer.
The contractor shall remove loose material from the pot holes or from road
depressions and shall also reshape the holes and depression by removing
firm material as directed by the Engineer and dispose all material according
to the instruction of the Engineer. The surface thus exposed shall be
compacted in accordance with applicable requirement, for reinstatement of
surface the Engineer shall select item of work as mentioned here under:
1) Granular subbase.
2) Aggregate base course.
3) Water bound macadam.
4) Asphalt base course.
5) Surface treatment.
The Engineer may select one, or more than one of the items mentioned
above to reinstate the pot hole or depressions in the road surface according
to size and depth of the hole or depression.
208.4.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number of square meter of pot
holes or road depressions, reinstated in accordance with the requirement of
this item.
The material used for reinstatement of the pot hole or road depression shall
be measured in cubic meter or tones as applicable under the item used.
208-1
208.4.2 Payment
However the material used such as subbase, aggregate base course, water
bound Macadam or asphaltic base course shall be paid at the rates
applicable to the item.
209.1 DESCRIPTION
After the existing pavement structure has been broken off, the material shall
be removed and disposed off outside the right of way, according to the
satisfaction of the Engineer. The surface obtained after scarification or
breaking the existing pavement shall be compacted to the density
prescribed under item 108.3.1. Payment of such compaction shall be
included in the contract price for item 209.
209.3.1 Measurement
The quantity for road pavement structure broken and removed, to be paid
for shall be measurement in Cu. meter to a depth as shown in the
drawings/cross sections or as specified by the Engineer and in the area
earmarked by the Engineer for such purpose.
The quantity for road pavement structure scarified, to be paid for shall be
measured in Sq. meter as shown in the drawings/cross sections or as
specified by the Engineer and in the area earmarked by the Engineer for
such purpose.
209.3.2 Payment
The quantities as measured above shall be paid for at the contract unit price
per Cu. meter of breaking of road pavement structure and per Sq. meter of
scarification of existing road pavement structure, for carrying out the works
mentioned above including cost of labour, equipment, tools and incidental
necessary to complete these items.
Pay Item Description Unit of
No. Measurement
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
210.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of the widening of the existing pavement and
finishing of the completed work in accordance with the specifications and in
conformity with the lines, grades, thickness of each pavement component
and typical cross-sections shown on the plans or as directed by the
Engineer.
210.2 MATERIALS
210.3 TRENCHING
The contractor shall excavate along the edge of the existing pavement for
the full depth and width as indicated on the Drawings or as directed by the
Engineer. The bottom of the trench shall be compacted with rollers and/or
tampers approved by the Engineer to minimum ninety five (95) % of the
maximum dry density as per AASHTO T-191 method. If the plans do not
call for a specific type of compaction, the subgrade, subbase or base shall
be compacted by rolling with an approved type trench roller until the entire
surface is smooth, firm and at the designated elevation. Adequate
provisions shall be made for drainage of the trench to prevent damage to
the subgrade. Prior to placing any widening material, the trench shall be
cleaned of all loose material. The edge of the existing pavement shall be
thoroughly cleaned. The trench must be approved by the Engineer, before
placing any widening material. All subsequent layers shall be compacted to
the degree as shown under relevant item of these specifications.
Reflectorized barricades shall be placed along open trenches day and night.
Lighting shall be placed at each barricade at night. Barricades and lights
shall be approved by the Engineer. The barricades shall be placed at
intervals not to exceed one hundred (100) meters or as directed by the
Engineer.
210.5.1 Measurement
The removal of edge kerb if exists, will not be paid for separately but will be
considered subsidiary to the item of "Pavement Widening".
Water, ordered by the Engineer or added with the consent of the Engineer,
which is necessary to obtain satisfactory compaction of the foundation
treatment will not be paid for separately, but will be considered subsidiary to
the item of "Pavement Widening". No measurement will be made of
unauthorized areas or for extra width or thickness.
210.5.2 Payment
211.1 DESCRIPTION
Table 211/2
The fraction of material passing 0.075 mm (No. 200 Sieve) shall not be
more than 60% the fraction passing 0.425 mm (No. 40 Sieve).
211-1
The material passing 0.425 mm (No. 40) sieve when prepared in
accordance with AASHTO T 146-49 and tested by appropriate methods
shall conform with the following requirement.
The calcium sulphate content of the fraction retained on sieve No. 4 shall
not exceed ten (10) percent by weight.
211.3.1 Equipment
All equipment, tools and machines used in the performance of the work
shall be in good working condition and maintained all the times.
Blade graders, if used for spreading, the material shall have adjustable
blades for slopes.
All sprinkling equipment shall be suitable for applying water uniformly and at
controlled quantities to variable width of surface.
Transport vehicles carrying plant mix material shall have a capacity suited to
the output of mixing plant and the site condition.
211.3.2 Construction
Grade and alignment control stakes shall be furnished, set and maintained
by the contractor in order that work shall conform to the lines, grade and
cross-section shown on the drawings.
Material shall be placed and spread evenly using mechanical spreader. The
spreader shall be adjustable so that width and thickness of the spreader can
be set to any dimension required by the drawings and for uniform and
complete coverage.
211-2
rolling. The surface of the final layer shall be finished by blading and the
addition of water, until the surface is smooth and free from waves and
irregularities and is true to grade and cross-section. Where the thickness
exceeds twelve and half (12.5) centimeters, it shall be compacted in two
layers of equal thickness except that if vibratory roller is used for
compaction, the layer thickness may be increased to maximum of twenty
five (25) centimeters provided that satisfactory compaction is achieved.
Each layer shall be compacted until the entire depth of course is at least
95% of density at optimum moisture content as determined by AASHTO
T 180-74. Compaction shall be completed as soon as possible after the
material has been spread.
Completed base course shall be tested for the required thickness and
smoothness before acceptance. Any areas of the completed base course
having compacted thickness less than the thickness shown on the drawing,
or waves and irregularities as specified in the relevant, "Table for Allowable
Tolerances", in these specifications shall be corrected by scarifying the
surface, adding approved material, reshaping, recompacting and finishing
as specified and as approved by the Engineer. Skin patching of an area
without scarifying the surface to permit proper bonding of added material will
not be permitted.
211.3.4 Maintenance
211.4.1 Measurement
211-3
211.4.2 Payment
Measured quantities of crushed limestone base course determined as
above shall be paid for at the contract unit price per cubic meter for
particular item listed below and shown on the bill of quantities, which
payment shall be full compensation for furnishing all labour, material, tool,
plant, equipment; handling, mixing, manipulating, placing, shaping,
compacting including necessary water for compaction, rolling, finishing;
correcting unsuitable areas and unsatisfactory material; maintenance
including protection of prepared base course and all incidentals necessary
for completion of work except lime used which shall be paid separately as
measured above.
211-4
ITEM 212 BITUMEN STABILIZED SUB-BASE OR BASE
212.1 DESCRIPTION
If stationary plant is used for blending, all ingredients shall comply with any
of the grading curve given in Table 1 whereas for mix in place method, in
situ sand and gravel shall meet the gradation requirement as per Table 2 for
bitumen stabilized Subbase or Base Course.
Fraction passing 0.075mm (No. 200) sieve shall not be greater than 2/3 rd
of the fraction passing the 0.425mm (No. 40) sieve. The fraction passing
0.425 mm (No. 40) shall have a liquid limit not greater than 25% and
plasticity Index not greater that 6.
212-1
Bitumen-Aggregate mixture for the grade of bitumen selected shall be
ascertained by trial mixes using Marshal Method to determine the amount
by weight of dry material, and using either heated or unheated aggregates
as appropriate.
TABLE - 1
Table - 2
Sieve Designation
mm Inch Percent Passing by Weight
Fine aggregate passing 4.75 mm (No. 4 Sieve) shall consist of sharp natural
sand, free from organic or other objectionable substances.
212-2
212.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
All equipment, tools, machines used in the performance of work shall be in
good working condition and be subject to the approval of the Engineer, and
shall be maintained in satisfactory working condition at all times.
Blade grader if used shall have an adjustable blade for slopes and shall be
self propelled.
Mix in place method of construction may be adopted where the use of low
viscosity binder i.e. Cutback or Bitumen emulsion are found suitable.
Grade and alignment control stakes shall be furnished, set and maintained
by the contractor in order that work shall conform to the line, grade and
cross-section shown on the drawings. The stakes shall be set in rows on
and parallel to the center line of pavement and spaced so that string line
may be stretched between them.
Transport vehicles carrying plant mix material shall have a capacity suited to
the output of mixing plant and the site condition and be capable of
discharging cleanly. Segregation of material shall be avoided.
212-3
212.3.3 Compaction
Immediately after spreading, shaping to required level, crown and grade, the
mixture shall be thoroughly compacted with rubber or pneumatic tyred
rollers. Compaction shall continue until the entire depth and width of
Subbase/Base is uniformly compacted. Rolling shall begin at the low side
and progress towards the higher side overlapping each preceding trip until
entire surface has been rolled. Alternate trip of roller shall be of slightly
different length. Roller shall be in good working condition, capable of
reversing without back lash and shall be operated by skilled operator.
212.3.4 Tolerance
212.4.1 Measurement
The unit of measurement for payment shall be cubic meter for the
compacted and accepted bitumen stabilized subbase/base course as
measured in place. Measurement shall not include any area except the area
authorized in writing by the Engineer. Measurement of bitumen binder used
shall be the number of metric Ton used to stabilize sub base or base
course. The quantity of bitumen used shall not exceed the theoretical
percentage established in the laboratory.
212-4
212.4.2 Payment
Measured quantity of stabilized Subbase/Base determined as above shall
be paid for at the contract unit price per cubic meter for particular items
listed below and shown on the bill of quantities, which payment shall be full
compensation for furnishing of labour, material, tool, plant, equipment,
handling, mixing, manipulating, placing, shaping, compacting, rolling,
finishing, correcting unsuitable areas and unsatisfactory material,
maintenance including protection of stabilized Subbase/Base and all
incidentals necessary for the completion of work except bitumen consumed
which shall be paid separately as measured above.
212-5
ITEM 213 COLD RECYCLING OF ROAD PAVEMENT
STRUCTURE/SOIL STABILIZATION.
213.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of breaking, removal, mixing, relaying and
compaction of layers of surface, base and subbase course in a single
operation. In this operation, addition of water or binder will also be required
to add strength to the mix.
213.3.1 Equipment
Equipment utilized for this item of work shall ensure following activities in a
single operation:
a. Milling Process
213-1
b. Additives
Milled materials and additives shall be mixed in a forced mixer to make the
mass completely homogeneous. Material thus prepared shall be relayed
through paving block having tamping and vibrating paving screeds. Paving
screeds should be designed to provide initial compaction and shaping the
surface to give the required grade and profile.
d. Compaction
e. General
a. Milling Process
In case cement is to be used for improving the strength of relayed mix, the
same shall be calculated and spread over the pavement structure before
milling starts.
213-2
b. Additives
d. Compaction
e. General
213.5.1 Measurement
213-3
213.5.2 Payment
213-4
ITEM 214 ASPHALTIC CONCRETE BINDER COURSE
214.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing and mixing aggregates and asphalt
binder at a central mixing plant, transporting, spreading and compacting the
mixture on a prepared base in accordance with these specifications and to
the lines, grades and typical pavement sections shown on the Drawings or
as directed by the Engineer.
214.2.1 Aggregates.
Coarse and fine aggregates shall be clean, hard, tough, sound particles free
from decomposed material, vegetable matter and other deleterious
substances, and be of uniform quality, geology and petrology. Water borne
material such as river bed gravel, if used, shall also conform to the above
criteria.
Fine aggregate, which is material passing the No. 4 sieve shall consist of
100% crushed material from rock or boulder. No natural sand will be
allowed in the mix.
When the combined grading of the coarse and fine aggregates is deficient in
material passing the No. 200 sieve, additional filler material shall be added.
The filler material shall consist of finely divided rock crust, hydrated lime,
hydraulic cement or other suitable mineral matter and shall conform to the
following gradation:
No. 30 100
No. 50 95-100
No. 200 70-100
The Coarse and fine aggregates shall meet the following requirements:
b) The loss when subject to five cycles of the Sodium Sulphate Soundness
test (AASHTO T 140) shall be less than 12%.
214-1
c) The Sand Equivalent (AASHTO T-176) determined after all processing
except for addition of asphalt cement should not be less than 45.
d) All aggregates shall have a liquid limit of not more than 25% and a
Plasticity Index of not more than 4 as determined by AASHTO T-89 and
T-90.
e) The portion of aggregate retained on the 9.5 mm (3/8 inch) sieve shall
not contain more than 15 percent by weight of flat and/or elongated
particles (ratio of maximum to minimum dimensions = 2.5:1).
The composition of the asphaltic concrete paving mixture for binder course
shall conform to class shown in the following table:
Table No. 1
Combined Aggregate Grading Requirements
25 1 100
19 3/4 90-100
9.5 3/8 56-80
4.75 No. 4 35-65
2.38 No. 8 23-49
0.30 No. 50 5-19
0.075 No. 200 2-8
214-2
214.2.4 Combined Aggregates Gradation.
Asphalt Content.
At least one week prior to production, a Job-Mix Formula (JMF) for the
asphaltic concrete course mixture or mixtures to be used for the project,
shall be established jointly by the Engineer and the Contractor.
The JMF, with the allowable tolerances, shall be within the master range
specified in Table No. 1. Each JMF shall indicate a single percentage of
aggregate passing each required sieve size and a single percentage of
bitumen to be added to the aggregates.
After the JMF is established, all mixtures furnished for the project
represented by samples taken from the asphalt plant during operation, shall
conform thereto with the tolerances as per clause 214.2.4 of these
specifications.
Construction requirements for this item shall conform with the same
construction requirements specified for Asphaltic Concrete Base Course
Plant Mix under Item 203.3, except as modified in the following sub-items.
The asphalt concrete binder course shall be compacted to the desired level
and cross slope as shown on the drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
214-3
The tolerances in compacted thickness of the binder course shall be + 10
percent from the desired thickness shown on the drawings. For
determination of the thickness, one (1) core per hundred meters of each
lane will be taken. If the thickness so determined is deficient by more than +
10 percent, the Engineer shall decide whether to accept the deficit thickness
or to direct reconstruction.
The surface of the binder course shall be tested by the Engineer using at
3-meter straight edge at selected locations. The variation of the surface
from the testing edge of the straightedge between any two contacts,
longitudinal or transverse with the surface shall at no point + 5.0 millimeters.
The cross fall (camber) shall be within + 0.2 percent of that specified, and
the level at any point shall be within drawings. All humps or depressions
exceeding the specified tolerance shall be corrected by removing the
defective works and replacing it with new material, by overlaying, or by other
means satisfactory to the Engineer.
214.4.1 Measurement
214.4.2 Payment
214-4
ITEM 215 GEOTEXTILES
215.1 DESCRIPTION
The work covered by this section shall consist in furnishing all material,
labour, equipment and placing of Geotextiles on prepared surfaces
complete in accordance with the specifications for the work items involved,
in thicknesses and to the dimensions shown on the typical cross-sections of
applicable drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
• One road foundation for the purpose of separation between road fill
material and soft underlying soils in order to eliminate the need for
removal of poor subsoil material and quick and effective drainage of
soil-fill interface.
• As a filter element for all bodies of water where the soil can be eroded
by current, wave action or changing water levels.
215-1
215.3.2 Mechanical and Hydraulic Properties
The Geotextile shall be rolled out directly on top of the prepared surface in a
manner as recommended by the manufacturer. It shall be over lapped at the
edges as shown on the drawings or as recommended by the manufacturer.
The first layer of fill material shall be applied by overhead placement. Traffic
on the geotextile itself shall be avoided. Necessary precautions shall be
observed to ensure that geotextile shall not be damaged during placement.
215.4.4 Spreading
215.4.5 Compaction
i) Overlapping
215-2
ii) Welding
Welding width shall not be less than 10 cm. A wide pattern gas torch shall
be used at a low temperature and about 20 cm from the geotextile. The
welded geotextile section shall be continuously pressed down by walking on
it during placement.
iii) Sewing
The stitching method shall be single thread, double thread or butterfly type
suitable to geotextile thread type and strength. The thread shall be
sufficiently tightened and stitch density shall be three to six stitches per inch.
This section deals with geotextiles placed between old pavement and new
asphalt overlay, alongwith suitable tack coat of bitumen. Where indicated on
drawings or directed by the Engineer, geotextile will be placed to perform
one or more of the following functions.
• To ensure proper adhesion between old pavement and new asphalt
overlay & thus reducing the over all flexural tensile stresses and
increasing life of road surface.
• As a cut off layer for the prevention of propagation of cracks in the
pavement.
• As water barrier, even under high pressure to stop reflective cracking in
the pavements.
• Removal of dirt, dust and vegetation from wearing surface and cracks.
• Filling potholes and larger cracks (>5mm) with hot mix or an adequate
filler.
• Removal of sharp or craggy edges on surface.
• On badly damaged roads, a level course of approx. 1,5 cm shall be laid
to avoid the labour intensive and time consuming operation of crack
filling.
215-3
• When using bitumen emulsion, the coating amount is adjusted to contain
the required average amount of bitumen.
• The coating is only applied to areas where the paving felt is to be laid.
• No additional pre-spray agent is applied on top of the paving felt.
• Where only sections for the road are covered with the paving felts, their
surfaces must be gritted.
215.5.3 Laying Geotextile
• The material mix shall have a temperature between 145 oC and 165oC
• To avoid types of the finisher or truck sticking to the felt (which can
happen in hot climates or where too much tack coat has been applied),
some of the mix can be spread manually in the pathway of the vehicles.
215-4
215.6 GEOTEXTILE TESTING
215.7.1 Measurement
215-5
215.7.2 Payment
215-6
ITEM 216 SOLING STONE
216.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of laying of soling stone, handpacked on a surface
(subgrade) prepared earlier and all interstices filled with sand or similar
approved materials to provide proper bonding of all the stones with each
other.
The material for soling shall be round and durable rock, properly shaped or
boulders of maximum size 15-20 cm. The filler material to fill the interstices
shall be coarse sand or rock dust or any other material approved by the
Engineer. Material shall be cohesionless and clean to allow its free flow
down to the bottom of soling area.
216.3.1 The subgrade to receive the soiling stone shall be prepared under relative
item of the work.
The soling stone shall be placed from outer edges of the road and finishing
at the crown of the road in such a way that all stones are properly
handpacked and keyed with the surrounding stones. It shall be ensured that
the maximum dimension is kept in vertical position ensuring the variation of
the size of the stone does not exceed + 1" of specified thickness of soling
stone:
The filler material shall be dry and in free flow condition when placed over
the soling stone. The filler material shall be kept adding while the soling
stones are rolled under a 6 tons roller. The addition of filler material shall
continue till the area does not absorb more material and it is ensured that all
interstices are fully filled. The area will than be watered and kept under
rolling to achieve a smooth surface.
216.3 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
216.3.1 Measurement
216-1
216.3.2 Payment
The quantities determined as provided above shall be paid for at the
contract unit price for cubic meter which price and payment shall be full
compensation for all cost of materials, manpower and equipments involved
in the proper completion of work.
216-2
ITEM 217 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS
217.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of precast concrete paving blocks intended for the
construction of low speed roads, parking areas, lay byes, industrial and
other paved surfaces subjected to all categories of static and vehicular
loading and pedestrian traffic. Paving blocks covered by these
Specifications are designed to form a structural element and the surfacing
of pavements, having the block to block joints filled, so as to develop
frictional interlock and placed in conformity with the lines, grades,
thicknesses and typical cross-section shown on the drawings or as directed
by the Engineer.
Paving blocks shall be made using one or more of the following binders or
binder constituents complying with the requirements of the relevant
standards:
Where pulverized fuel ash is used, the proportions and properties of the
combination with Portland Cement shall comply with BS 6588.
217.2.2 Aggregates
Paving blocks shall be made using one or more of the following aggregates
complying with the relevant standards:
217-1
217.2.2.1 Acid Soluble Material (Fine Aggregate)
When tested as described in BS 812 : Part 119, the fine aggregate (material
passing a 5 mm sieve complying with BS 410) shall contain not more than
25% by mass of acid soluble material either in the fraction retained on, or in
the fraction passing, a 600 μ m sieve.
217.2.3 Water
217.2.5 FINISHES
The finish should be agreed between the manufacturer and the Engineer.
Concrete described as “natural colour” shall contain no pigment.
In composite paving blocks the surface layer shall be formed as an integral
part of the block and shall be not less than 5 mm thick.
The cement content of the compacted concrete shall be not less than 380
kg/m3. For equivalent durability, paving blocks made with binder
constituents other than ordinary Portland cement shall have a higher binder
content than paving blocks made in a similar way using only Portland
Cement. The Engineer will decide the additional binder content. The
compressive strength test will be the only guide to the amount of additional
binder needed.
217.2.7.1 Sizes
Paving blocks shall have a work size thickness of not less than 60 mm.
Type-R blocks shall be rectangular with a work size length of 200 mm and a
work size width of 100 mm. Type-S blocks shall be of any shape fitting
within a 295 mm square coordinating space and shall have a work size
width not less than 80 mm.
The preferred work size thicknesses are 60 mm, 65 mm, 80 mm & 100 mm.
A chamfer around the wearing surface with a work size not exceeding 7 mm
in width or depth shall be permitted.
217-2
217.2.7.2 Tolerances
The maximum dimensional deviations from the stated work sizes for paving
blocks shall be as follows:
length + 2 mm
width + 2 mm
thickness + 3 mm
Where a paving block includes profiled sides, the profile shall not deviate
from the manufacturer’s specification by more than 2 mm.
The compressive strength of paving blocks shall be not less than 49 N/mm2
and the crushing strength of any individual block shall be not less than 40
N/mm2.
217.2.9 SAMPLING
c) Protect the paving blocks from damage and contamination until they
have been tested. Carry out any tests as soon as possible after the
sample has been taken.
217.2.10 MARKING
b) The number and date of this British Standard, i.e. BS 6717 : Part 1 :
1986*; or latest revision.
217-3
217.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
217.3.1 Laying the Concrete Blocks
The total area to be covered with paving block shall be prepared by:
a) Compaction of subgrade
b) Laying of subbase in a thickness specified
c) Laying of crushed aggregate base or lean concrete in thickness as per
typical section
217.3.2 Tolerance
Payment for each of the above item shall be made under the relative item of
work.
The total area will thereby be divide with nylon strings into sectors of not
more than 1.5 square meters. This shall be done to control the alignment of
paving blocks and to avoid multiplication of deviation in sizes of paving
blocks.
217.4.1 Measurement
217.4.2 Payment
The quality determined as provided above shall be paid for the unit price of
contract for each square meter of paving block installed including sand
cushion and sand filling in joints and all other work related for installing
paving blocks. Cost shall include all labour, materials and equipment for
proper completion of work.
217-4
SURFACE COURSES
PAVEMENT
AND
SURFACE COURSES AND PAVEMENT
300-1
ITEM 301 ASPHALTIC MATERIALS
301.1 ASPHALT CEMENT
In areas where highly frost susceptible soils and severe low temperature
conditions are encountered, it may be necessary to remove and replace
soils susceptible to frost heave or take other precautions prior to pavement
construction. In extremely hot climates, asphalt mixes should be designed to
resist rutting and maintain stiffness at high temperatures.
* Both medium setting (MS) and slow setting (SS) emulsified asphalts are
used in emulsified asphalt base mixes. They can be either of two types:
cationic (ASTM D 2397 or AASHTO M 208) or anionic (ASTM D977 or
AASHTO M 140). Selecting one of the two shall depends on the type of
aggregate used for better affinity.
301-1
The grade of emulsified asphalt is selected primarily on the basis of its
ability to satisfactorily coat the aggregate. This is determined by coating and
stability test (ASTM D 244, AASHTO T 59). Other factors important in the
selection are the water availability at the job site, anticipated weather at the
time of construction, the mixing process to be used, and the curing rate.
Rapid curing products designated by the letters RC, shall consist of asphalt
cement with a penetration of grade 80-100, fluxed or blended with a
naphtha solvent.
301-2
APPLICATION TEMPERATURES
TABLE 301-1
Application Temperature Range, oC
301-3
TABLE 301-2
301-a
TABLE 301-3
Distillation test:
Distillate, percentage by volume of total distillate
at 360oC (680oF)
at 225oC (437oF) ................................................ 0 20 0 10 - -
at 260oC (500 oF) ............................................... 20 60 15 55 0 35
at 315 oC (600 oF)............................................... 65 90 60 87 45 80
2. If penetration of residue is more than 200 and its ductility at 25oC (77 oF)
is less than 100 cm., the material will be acceptable if its ductility at 15.5
o
C (60 oF) is more than 100 cm.
301-b
TABLE 301-4
Distillation test:
Distillate, percentage by volume of total distillate
at 360oC (680oF)
at 190oC (374oF) ................................................ 10 - - - - -
o o
at 225 C (437 F) ................................................ 50 - 35 - 15 -
o o
at 260 C (500 F)................................................ 70 - 60 - 45 -
o o
at 315 C (600 F) ............................................... 85 - 80 - 75 -
o o
Residue from distillation at 360 C (680 F)
Volume percentage of sample by difference ..... 55 - 65 - 75 -
301-c
TABLE 301-5
Test on Emulsions:
Viscosity, Saybolt Furol at 77oF (25oF). Sec................ 20 100 - - 20 100 20 100
o o
Viscosity, Saybolt Furol at 122 F (50 C) Sec. ............ - - 75 400 - - - -
Settlement 5 days, percent (a)..................................... - 5 - 5 - 5 - 5
Storage stability test 1 day (b) ..................................... - 1 - 1 - 1 - 1
Demulsibility, 35 m1. 0.02 NCaCl2 percent ................. 60 - 60 - - - - -
Cement mixing test, percent ....................................... - - - - - 2.0 - 2.0
Sieve test, percent ....................................................... - 0.10 - 0.10 - 0.10 - 0.10
Residue by distillation, percent .................................... 55 - 63 - 57 - 57 -
Test on Residue from Distillation Test Penetration, 77
o
F (25 oC) 100g. 5 Sec. ................................................
100 200 100 200 100 200 40 90
o o
Ductility, 77 F (25 C), 5 cm/min. cm ........................... 40 - 40 - 40 - 40 -
Solubility in trichloroethylene, percent ......................... 97.5 - 97.5 - 97.5 - 97.5 -
Surface treatment, Surface treatment & Plant or road mixture with graded and fine
penetration penetration aggregates, a substantial quantity of which
Suggested uses
macadam and tack macadam passes a No. 8 (2.3mm) sieve and a
coat portion of which may pass a No. 200
(0.075 mm) sieve; slurry seal treatments.
a) The test requirement for settlement may be waived when the emulsified asphalt is used in less than 5 days time; or the Engineer may
require that the settlement test be run from the time the sample is received until it is used, if the elapsed time is less than 5 days.
b) The 24-hr. (1 day) storage stability test may be used instead of the 5 days settlement test.
c) The demulsibility test shall be made within 30 days from date of shipment.
301-d
ITEM 302 BITUMINOUS PRIME COAT
302.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing all plant, labour, equipment, material
and performing all operations in applying a liquid asphalt prime coat on a
previously prepared and untreated; earth sub grade, waterbound base
course, crushed aggregate base course, tops of roadway shoulders, and as
otherwise shown on the plans in strict accordance with the specification and
in conformity with the lines shown on the drawings.
Prime coat shall be applied when the surface to be treated is dry; except
that when emulsified asphalt is used, the surface may be reasonably moist.
The application is prohibited when the weather is foggy or rainy, or when the
atmospheric temperature is below fifteen (15) degree C unless otherwise
directed by the Engineer. Prior to the application of the prime coat, all loose
materials shall be removed from the surface and the same shall be cleaned
by means of approved mechanical sweepers or blowers and/or hand
brooms, until it is as free from dust as is deemed practicable. No traffic
shall be permitted on the surface after it has been prepared to receive the
bituminous material. Prior to the application of prime coat on bridge decks
and concrete pavements, the surfaces shall be cleaned of all loose material
as described in Section 302.3. All expansion joints shall be cleaned and
filled with bituminous material as directed by the Engineer. Areas to be
primed will be classified as under:
(i) The top of earth surface or water bound base courses from a
point twenty (20) centimeters outside the edge of the pavement
line to 20 cms outside the line on the opposite side of the
roadway.
(iii) The bridge wearing surface from curb to curb and end to end of
bridge wearing surface.
302-1
302.3.1 Equipment
The tank shall have a heating device able to heat a complete charge of
asphaltic liquid up to one hundred eighty (180) degree C. The heating
device shall be so that overheating will not occur. Consequently, the flames
must not touch directly on the casting of the tank containing the asphaltic
liquid or gases therefrom. The Contractor will be responsible for any fire or
accident resulting from heating of bituminous materials. The liquid shall be
circulated or stirred during the heating. The tank shall be insulated in such
a way that the drop in temperature when the tank is filled and not heated,
will be less than two (2) degree C per hour. A thermometer shall be fixed to
the tank in order to be able to control continuously the temperature of the
liquid. The thermometer shall be placed in such a way that the highest
temperature in the tank is measured. The tank shall be furnished with a
device that indicates the contents. The pipes for filling the tank shall be
furnished with an easily interchangeable filter.
The distributor shall be able to vary the spray width of the asphaltic liquid in
steps of maximum 10 cm, to a total width of four (4) M. The spraying bar
shall have nozzles from which the liquid is sprayed fan-shaped on the road
surface equally distributed over the total spraying width.
The distributor shall have a pump for spraying the liquid driven by a
separate motor, or the speed of the pump shall be synchronized with the
speed of the distributor. The pump shall be furnished with an indicator
showing the performance in litres per minute. At the suction side the pump
shall have a filter easily exchangeable. A thermometer shall be fixed, which
indicates the temperature of the liquid immediately before it leaves the
spraying bar.
Immediately before applying prime coat, the full area of surface to be treated
shall be swept with a power broom to remove all dirt and other objectionable
material. If required by the Engineer, the surface shall be made moist but
not saturated. Asphaltic Materials shall be applied at
302-2
temperature stated in Item 301 by approved pressure distributors operated
by skilled workmen. The spray nozzles and spray bars shall be adjusted and
frequently checked so as to ensure uniform distribution. Spraying shall be
ceased immediately upon any clogging or interference of any nozzle and
remedial measures be taken before spraying is resumed.
Minimum Maximum
1. Subgrade, Subbase,
Water bound base courses, 0.65 1.75
and Crushed stone base course.
However, the exact rate shall be specified by the Engineer determined from
field trials.
The prime coat shall be left undisturbed for a period of at least 24 hours,
and shall not be opened to traffic until it has penetrated and cured
sufficiently so that it will not be picked up by the wheels of passing vehicles.
The Contractor shall maintain the prime coat until the next course is applied.
Care shall be taken that the application of bituminous material is not in
excess of the specified amounts; any excess shall be blotted with sand or
similar treatment. All areas inaccessible to the distributor shall be sprayed
manually using the device for hand spraying from the distributor.
The surface of structures and trees adjacent to the area being treated shall
be protected in such manner so as to prevent them being spattered or
marred.
302.4.1 Measurement
Blotting material will not be measured for payment and shall be considered
subsidiary to the prime coat..
302.4.2 Payment
The payment for area primed measured as stated above, shall be made for
the contract unit price per SM, which payment shall be full compensation for
furnishing all labour, material, tools, equipment and incidentals and for
performing all the work involved in applying prime coat, complete in place in
accordance with these specifications:
302-4
ITEM 303 BITUMINOUS TACK COAT
303.1 DESCRIPTION
The work covered by this section shall consist in furnishing all plant, labour,
equipment and applying asphaltic material on a previously prepared
asphaltic layer, in addition to performing all operations in connection with
the application of a Bituminous tack coat, complete in accordance with
these specifications and to the width shown on the typical cross- sections of
applicable drawings.
Immediately before applying the tack coat, all loose material, dirt or other
objectionable material, shall be removed from the surface to be treated by
power brooms and/or blowers, supplemented with hand brooms, as directed
by the Engineer. The tack coat shall be applied only when the surface is
dry, however for emulsified asphalt, application may be made on a
reasonable moist surface. Application of tack coat shall be avoided in case
of foggy or rainy weather. Prior to the application, an inspection of the
prepared surface will be made by the Engineer to determine its fitness to
receive the Bituminous binder and no tack coat will be applied until the
surface has been approved.
303.3.1 Equipment
Equipment shall conform in all respect to the provision under Item 302.3.1
and shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer in addition to the
maintenance of the same in a satisfactory working condition at all times. A
hand power spray attachment to a bitumen pressure distributor or other
container having an independently operated bitumen pump, pressure
gauge, thermometer for determining the temperature of the asphalt tank
contents and a hose connected to a hand power spray suitable for applying
the Bituminous tack coat in the amounts specified - all to be such as to meet
the approval of the Engineer, shall be furnished .
303-1
Care shall be taken that the application of asphaltic material is not in excess
of the specified quantity; any excess asphalt shall be blotted by sand or
similar treatment. All areas inaccessible to the distributor shall be treated
manually using the device for hand spraying from the distributor. The
surfaces of structures and trees adjacent to the areas being treated shall be
protected in such a manner as to prevent them being spattered or marred.
Where no convenient detour is available for traffic, operations shall be
confined to one-half the roadway width at a time. The Contractor shall
provide proper traffic control so that vehicles may proceed without damage
to the treated area. Work shall not be started on the portion of the road not
covered by previous application until the surface previously covered has
dried and is ready for paving.
Traffic shall be kept off the tack coat at all times. The tack coat shall be
sprayed only so far in advance of the surface course as will permit it to dry
to a "tacky" condition. The Contractor shall maintain the tack coat until the
next course has been placed. Any area that has become fouled, by traffic
or otherwise, shall be cleaned by Contractor at his own cost before the next
course is applied.
303.4.1 Measurement
303.4.2 Payment
303-2
ITEM 304 BITUMINOUS SURFACE TREATMENT AND SEAL COAT./
PAD COAT
304.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of one or more applications of asphaltic material and
one or more covers of aggregates or an application of asphaltic material
without aggregates applied in accordance with these specifications and in
conformity with the lines and width shown on the typical cross-sections or as
established by the Engineer.
304.2 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS
304.2.1 Aggregate
Aggregate shall consist of clean, dry, hard, durable, tough, angular, sound
crushed stone or crushed gravel of uniform quality, and free from dirt, clay
and other objectionable matter. Aggregates from the sources of established
adhesion properties would be used. The percentage of wear by the Los
Angeles Abrasion test (AASHTO T-96) shall not be more than forty (40).
Aggregate crushing value (ACV) when tested as per BS-812 (1990) shall
not exceed 25%. When subjected to five (5) cycles of sodium-sulfate
soundness testing as determined by AASHTO T-104, it shall have a weight
loss of not greater than ten (10) percent. The moisture content in the
aggregate applied directly to the surface of the bituminous material shall not
exceed three (3) percent by weight plus one-half (1/2) the water absorption
of the aggregate at the time of delivery to the Project. In no case shall free
moisture be drawing from the truck bed.
The portion of aggregate retained on the 9.5 mm (3/8 inch) sieve shall not
contain more than fifteen (15) percent of particles by weight of flat or
elongated, or both, that the ratio between the maximum and the minimum
dimensions exceeds 2.5:1. Flakiness Index, tested under BS-812 (1990)
part 105, shall be 25 (max) for nominal size 18 mm and 12 mm and 30
(max) for nominal size 9mm.
The nominal sizes of aggregates used for surface treatment; shown against
table 304-1 shall be as under:
304-2
At the time of the application, the weather shall be warm and dry, and the
road surface shall be clean and dry. Spraying shall not be done unless the
road temperature is above twenty (20) degree C for at least one hour prior
to the commencement of spraying operations, and the temperature shall not
be less than twenty (20) degree C during the spraying. Prior to applying the
asphaltic material, dirt and other objectionable materials shall be removed
from the surface and surface shall be primed as per item 302. If so directed
by the Engineer, the surface shall be cleaned by power brooming or wire
brush until all loose and foreign materials are removed.
304.3.1 Equipment
Immediately prior to the application of binder, all dirt, dust or foreign material
shall be removed by thorough brooming and / or the use of compressed air.
Adhering mud or other soiling may be removed using water and brushes,
the general use of water to wash the road shall not be permitted.
304-3
The spread of bituminous materials shall be at least ten (10) cm more than
the width to be covered by the aggregate from the spreading device. The
distributor shall be moving forward at proper application speed at the time
the spray bar is opened. Any skipped areas or deficiencies shall be
corrected in an approved manner. Junctions of spreads shall be carefully
made to assure a smooth riding surface. The length of spread of bituminous
material shall not exceed than that which trucks loaded with cover coat
material can immediately cover. Under no circumstances shall operations
proceed in such manner that bituminous material will be allowed to chill, set
up, dry, or otherwise impair retention of the cover coat.
The distributor when not spreading shall be so designed that the spray bar
or mechanism will not drip bituminous material on the surface of the traveled
way. Distribution of the bituminous material shall be so regulated and
sufficient bituminous material left in the distributor at the end of each
application, so that there will be a uniform distribution of bituminous
material. In no case shall the distributor be allowed to expel air with the
bituminous material thereby causing uneven coverage. The angle of the
spray nozzles and the height of the spray bar shall be so adjusted and
frequently checked that uniform distribution is ensured. The distribution
shall cease immediately upon any clogging or interference of any nozzle
and corrective measures shall be taken before distribution is resumed.
Any place where binder shows undulations on the surface shall be covered
with additional aggregate and further rolled and broomdragged until an even
surface results, and does not adhere to wheels of vehicles. Overlapping the
applications of cover material shall be avoided and all spillage shall be
removed from the surface.
304-4
All work shall be so conducted that the work of applying asphalt and
aggregate and of all rolling shall be completed during the time from sunrise
to sunset and under favorable weather conditions as determined by the
Engineer.
304-5
304.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
304.4.1 Measurement
304.4.2 Payment
304-6
TABLE 304-1
1.19 (a)
Single Single 2 12.5
1.63 (b)
1.90 (a)
First 1 24.0
Double 2.14 (b)
1.19 (a)
Second 3 12.5
1.63 (b)
1.90 (a)
First 1 24.0
2.14 (b)
Tripple 1.19 (a)
Second 2 12.5
1.63 (b)
Third 3 6.5 0.68 (c)
Seal Coat / Pad Coat with 4 4 0.5 (c)
Aggregate
Notes:-
i) Bituminous material types are (a) asphalt cement, (b) cut-back or emulsified
and (c) asphalt cement, cut-back and emulsified.
iii) Prime coat shall be applied prior to the surface treatment for the newly
constructed pavement at the rate as specified in the item 302.3.2.
304-7
Fine aggregate which is the material passing from AASHTO No. 4 sieve,
shall consist of 100% crushed material from rock or boulder. Fine
aggregate shall be stored separately, and no natural sand will be allowed in
the mix.
When the combined grading of the coarse and fine aggregates is deficient in
material passing the AASHTO No. 200 sieve, mineral filler material shall be
added as approved by the Engineer. The filler shall consist of finely divided
mineral matter such as rock dust, hydrated lime, hydraulic, calcined dust
cement or other suitable mineral matter free from lumps, balls or other
deleterious material and shall conform to the following gradation:
Sieve Designation
mm Inch Percent Passing by Weight
305-1
The coarse and fine aggregates shall meet the following requirements:
a) The percent of wear by the Los Angeles Abrasion test (AASHTO
T 96) shall not be more than thirty (30).
b) The loss when subjected to five cycles of the Sodium Sulphate
Soundness test (AASHTO T 104) shall be less than twelve (12)
percent.
c) The Sand Equivalent (AASHTO T 176) determined after all
processing except for addition of asphalt cement shall not be
less than 45.
d) All aggregates shall have a liquid limit of not more than twenty
five (25) percent and a Plasticity Index of not more than four (4)
as determined by AASHTO T-89 and T-90.
e) The portion of aggregates retained on the 9.5 mm (3/8 inch)
sieve shall not contain more than 10 percent by weight of flat
and/or elongated particles (ratio of maximum to minimum
dimension = 2.5:1).
f) Stripping test shall be performed on crush aggregates as
described under AASHTO-182 and only that material shall be
allowed which qualifies the test.
g) The coarse aggregates shall be checked if desired by the
Engineer for cationic and anionic behaviour so that their affinity
with the bitumen to be used is verified.
h) Petrographic examination of the coarse aggregate shall be
conducted if so directed by the Engineer.
The percentage of particles having certain proportions between their largest
and smallest dimensions (i.e. between the largest distance the particles can
fill out between two parallel planes that will permit the particle to pass), shall
be determined in the following way:
305-2
305.2.3 Asphalt Concrete Wearing Course Mixture
The composition of the asphaltic concrete paving mixture for wearing course
shall conform to Class A and/or Class B shown in the following table:
Table 305-1
Asphalt Concrete Wearing Course Requirements
The asphalt concrete wearing course mixture shall meet the following
Marshal Test Criteria:
305-3
305.2.4 Job-Mix Formula
At least one week prior to production, a Job-Mix Formula (JMF) for the
asphaltic wearing course mixture or mixtures to be used for the project, shall
be established jointly by the Engineer and the Contractor.
The JMF, with the allowable tolerances, shall be within the master range
specified in Table 305-1. Each JMF shall indicate a single percentage of
aggregate passing each required sieve and a single percentage of bitumen
to be added to the aggregates.
The ratio of weight of filler (Passing No. 200) to that of asphalt shall range
o
between 1 – 1.5 for hot climate areas with temperature more than 40 C.
After the JMF is established, all mixtures furnished for the project
represented by samples taken from the asphalt plant during operation, shall
conform thereto with the following ranges of tolerances:
Asphalt Content.
Construction requirements for this Item shall conform with the same as
specified for Asphaltic Concrete Base Course Plant Mix under Item 203.3,
except as modified in the following sub-items.
305-4
305.3.1 Preparation of Base Course Surface
The surface of the wearing course shall be tested by the Engineer using a
5 meters straightedge at selected locations. The variation of the surface
from the testing edge of the straightedge between any two contacts,
longitudinal or transverse with the surface shall at no point exceed five (5)
millimeters. The cross fall (camber) shall be with + 0.2 percent of that
specified, and the level at any point shall be within + three (3) mm of the
level shown on the Drawings. All humps or depressions exceeding the
specified tolerance shall be corrected by removing the defective work and
replacing it with new material, by overlaying, or by other means satisfactory
to the Engineer.
Acceptance of sampling and testing for this Item with respect to materials
and construction requirements, not specified herein, shall be in accordance
with the relevant, "Tables for Sampling and Testing Frequency" in these
specifications.
305.4.1 Measurement
305-5
Quantities of Bitumen or asphaltic concrete wasted or remaining on hand
after completion of the work shall not be measured or paid for.
305.4.2 Payment
305-6
ITEM 306 SHOULDER TREATMENT
306.1 DESCRIPTION
That portion of the completed road construction which lies above the
elevation of the subgrade or sub-base and which extends from the edge of
the wearing course to the point of inter-section with the embankment slopes
on either side of the road centerline.
The material used for "Earth Shoulders" shall consist of suitable materials
from roadway or structural excavation supplemented by additional suitable
material from borrow excavation or as designated on the plans and shall be
obtained from sources approved by the Engineer.
Material for soil cement shoulders shall conform to all the requirements of
item 204, "Soil Cement Stabilized Subbase or Base".
306-1
306.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
306.3.1 General
All shoulders shall be formed and compacted as soon as practicable after
the asphalt paving on the traffic lanes is completed, however in the case of
cement concrete surfacing, shouldering operation shall not be initiated prior
to Engineer's approval.
On projects that carry traffic through construction, the contractor shall begin
shouldering on the second day of the laying of the final roadway surfacing
layer, unless weather conditions prevent this operation, in which case the
shouldering shall begin as soon as the weather does permit. If the
contractor fails to begin the shouldering within a reasonable time after the
last layer has been laid, whether the project has a flow of traffic through
construction or not, the Engineer may order the contractor to cease paving
until the shoulder work has begun. The shouldering shall be a continuous
operation from that time until completion, with the weather being the only
delaying factor. The Contractor shall, on roads under traffic or as directed by
the Engineer, delineate the edge of pavement as soon as the surfacing is
begun and maintain the delineation until the shoulders are completed. The
delineators shall be approved prior to use and shall be placed at the edge of
the surfacing at approximately one hundred (100) meter intervals. The cost
of this delineation will be considered subsidiary to other items in the Bill of
Quantities and will not be paid for directly.
306-2
306.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
The quantities for shoulder materials and treatment shall be measured and
paid for as specified under the particular pay items in the work listed below.
The quantities of different items of work as mentioned below shall be added
to relative items of the bill of quantities.
306-3
ITEM 307 BIT - MAC
307.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of furnishing and mixing aggregates with asphalt
binder at site in mobile mixing plant, spreading, compacting on an approved
primed subgrade, subbase or base course, for potholes repair, leveling
course and wearing course in accordance with the specification and in
conformity with the lines, grade, thickness and typical cross-section shown
on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer including sealing of cold
bituminous surface cracks with sand-bitumen slurry.
307-1
307.2.2 Bituminous Binder
Optimum Grading Curves for different types of hot mix asphaltic design
related to quantum of repair work and maximum size of aggregates, given in
Table 307.2-A, must be carefully selected considering average thickness of
patches.
Design sheet under table No. 307.2.A showing Dense Graded Mix used for
leveling courses and potholes should use little asphalt content of such
quantity to prevent bleeding through subsequent wearing course or surface
treatment. Design sheet under table No. 307.2.B. is suitable for open
graded wearing course having rough surface texture with good skid
resistance thus having minimum bleeding tendency.
Both bitumen and aggregates must be heated before they are combined in
the mixer drum. Mixing temperature should be kept within the range of
140-170 degrees centigrade.
307-2
TABLE 307.2-A
DESIGN SHEETS FOR DENSE GRADED HOT MIX. FOR LEVELING AND POTHOLES, RELATED TO THICKNESS WITH
ASPHALT BINDER 60-70 OR 80-100 PENETRATION GRADE.
Specification Range 4-11 32-46 46-60 65-80 75-88 90-100 3.5% by Minimum Layer
Allowed % Passing 8 38 53 73 82 100 Wt. of Thickness:- 50mm
% by Weight 46% 54% Mix. Aggr.size:- 20mm Down
Qty. by Proportion. 3 4 Rate of Aggr.
Appl.: 115 Kg/SM.
Specification Range 4-12 24-37 34-47 49-61 57-70 70-87 88-100 3.5% by Minimum Layer
Allowed % Passing 8 30 40 54 62 76 100 Wt. of Thickness:-50mm
% by Weight 46% 54% Mix. Aggr. size:- 20mm Down
Qty. by Proportion. 3 4 Rate of Aggr.
Appl.: 150 Kg/SM.
307-2 (A)
TABLE 307.2-B
DESIGN SHEETS FOR OPEN GRADED HOT MIX. FOR WEARING COURSE AND RELATED TO THICKNESS WITH
ASPHALT BINDER 60-70 OR 80-100 PENETRATION GRADE.
Specification Range 1-10 14-28 25-40 45-57 58-70 87-100 3.5% by Minimum Layer
Allowed % Passing 6 20 32 50 65 100 Wt. of Thickness:- 50mm
% by Weight 26% 74% Mix. Aggr. size 20mm Down
Qty. by Proportion. 1 3 Rate of Aggr.
Appl.: 110 Kg/SM.
Specification Range 2-10 12-25 20-35 36-51 45-60 65-81 82-100 3.5% by Minimum Layer
Allowed % Passing 6 17 26 41 52 72 100 Wt. of Thickness:- 60mm
% by Weight 23% 77% Mix. Aggr. size - 25mm Down
Qty. by Proportion. 1 3 Rate of Aggr.
Appl.:-135 Kg/SM.
307-2 (B)
307.3.2 Deep Patches/Pot holes
The surfaces of base course thus prepared as mentioned under Item 207,
shall be primed to receive Bit Mac in a thickness as per drawings or as
directed by the Engineer, Bit Mac shall be spread carefully to avoid
segregation. Compaction shall be done with equipment suited to the size of
job. A vibratory plate compactor is recommended for small patches.
Whereas roller may be more practical for larger areas. Straight edge or
stringline shall be used to check riding quality and the alignment of the
patch.
Local made bitumen aggregate mixer equipment used for preparation of Bit-
Mac shall be in good working condition, of sufficient capacity, capable of
being operated to produce a uniform blend with the given ingredients.
Bit-Mac mixed material shall be delivered in tight, clean and smooth metal
bed hand trolleys, or any method as convenient to the Contractor and
approved by the Engineer.
307-3
Priming shall be done in a manner as described in item 302. The rate of
application of prime coat shall be 0.8-1.5 litres per square meter. Tack coat
shall be done in a manner as described in item 303. The rate of application
of tack coat shall be 0.2-0.4 litres per square meter. When surface of
existing pavement or old base is irregular, it shall be brought to uniform
grade and cross-section by leveling course as described above.
Sand bitumen slurry to seal the cracks in clod bituminous surface shall be
injected by pressure pumps with nozzles filled at the end instead of spray
pipe in conventional harris trolley.
307.3.4.6 Compaction
Roller shall be steel wheel or pneumatic tyred. The roller (s) shall be in
good working condition, capable of reversing without backlash, capable to
be operated at speeds slow enough to avoid displacement of Bit-Mac. The
number and weight of rollers shall be sufficient to compact the mixture while
it is still in workable condition to obtain compaction to Engineer's
satisfaction. The use of equipment which results in excessive crushing of
aggregates shall not be permitted.
After spreading and strike off as soon as the mix condition permit the rolling
to be performed without excessive shoving or tearing, the Bit-Mac mixture
shall be thoroughly and uniformly compacted. Rolling will not be prolonged
to avoid appearance of cracks. Rolling will be done longitudinally, beginning
at the lower side of the spread and proceeding towards the higher side,
overlapping successive trips by at least one half (1/2) the width of rear
wheels of roller.
Along forms, curbs, headers, walls and other places not accessible to the
roller, the mixture shall be thoroughly compacted with hot hand tampers or
mechanical tampers.
Any mixture that has become cold enough, mixed with dirt or is defective in
any way shall be replaced with fresh hot mixture and compacted to conform
the requirement.
307-4
307.4.1 Measurement
Unless otherwise shown on the plans or as directed by the Engineer,
quantity of BIT-MAC shall be measured by theoretical volume of compacted
mix, in place, in cubic meters. Measurement will be based on the
dimensions as shown on plans or as directed by the Engineer. No
measurement will be made for unauthorized areas or for extra thickness
than specified. Minimum quantity for pot hole shall be 0.05 cubic meters.
307.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantities measured above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price per cubic meters of BIT-MAC for the Pay Item listed below and
shown in the Bill of Quantities, which price and payment shall constitute full
compensation for slurry seal, priming and tack coat, furnishing all materials,
hauling, placing, rolling, labour, equipment, tools and incidentals necessary
to complete the item.
307-5
ITEM 308 HOT RECYCLING OF ASPHALT CONCRETE
308.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of heating and removal of the existing asphalt
concrete layer to a designated depth, adding a calculated quantity of asphalt
binder, adding of freshly prepared asphalt concrete of specified quality,
mixing, laying and compaction of properly mixed asphalt concrete in
thickness and width as per drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
Material specifications for coarse and fine aggregates and asphalt binder
shall correspond to the specification requirements elaborated under items
203, 300 and 305 respectively.
Rotating shaft scarifiers fitted with carbide bits shall remove asphaltic
course to a depth as specified in drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
Scarifiers shall be controlled by electronic devices to ensure removal of
materials to a specified depth and grade.
Fresh asphalt concrete of specified design prepared as per Item 203 or 305
shall be added in proportion to be established as per requirement of line and
grades or as directed by the Engineer. This shall be done in conventional
way through dumper-hopper arrangement. Fresh material shall be carried
by drag-slat conveyor into a second mixer. Exact mixing ratio will be
achieved by calibrating the speed of the electronically adjustable drag-slat
conveyor to the forward advance speed of the remixer. A second mixer
shall ensure homogeneity of reclaimed and fresh asphalt. Engineer shall
establish the ratio of fresh and existing asphalt premix to be relayed, before
starting this operation. This ratio shall depend upon the quality of existing
asphaltic concrete.
308-1
308.3.5 Laying and Compaction
308.5.1 Measurement
308.5.2 Payment
The quantity measured as provided above shall be paid at the contract unit
price per cubic meter as shown in B.O.Q., acceptably laid and compacted in
place, which payment shall be deemed to include full compensation for
furnishing all materials, Labour, equipments, tools and incidentals
necessary to complete the item.
Payment for asphaltic binder or fresh asphalt wearing course shall be made
separately under relative item of work as given below:
308-2
ITEM 309 COLD MILLING
309.1 DESCRIPTION
iii) Scraper bars and belt conveyor system shall ensure picking and
loading of milled material in a truck.
Area shall be earmarked with respect to depth of milling, which shall be split
in strips looking to the width of milling drum and width of area to be milled.
Milling shall proceed from one edge of the road, strip by strip in a manner
that may ensure resulting surface even and level.
309-1
309.3.1 Measurement
309-2
ITEM 310 CONCRETE PAVEMENTS
310.1 DESCRIPTION
Machine Transverse
Properties Direction Direction.
310-1
310.2.4 Joint Filler
Joint filler shall consist of cane or other suitable long fibres of a cellular
nature uniformly impregnated with asphalt. The asphalt content of the joint
material shall be between thirty and fifty per cent. The joint material will not
deteriorate under any weather conditions and is to be of such a character as
not to be permanently deformed or broken by moderate twisting, bending or
other ordinary handling. Strips of the joint filler which do not conform to the
specified dimensions within the tolerance + two (2) mm for thickness and +
twelve (12) mm for depth are to be rejected. All damaged strips are to be
rejected too.
Dowel bars shall be cut from mild steel bars and will be approved by the
Engineer. The Contractor's attention is directed to the requirement that one
end of each dowel bar in all joints, except bonded construction joints, shall
be sawn and not sheared so that no irregularities likely to interfere with its
sliding action in the concrete shall occur. The minimum length of the dowel
bars spaced at one meter centre to centre or as shown on the drawings,
shall be thirty five (35) times the diameter of the bar used unless otherwise
specified or as directed by the Engineer.
Expansion caps for dowel bars in expansion joints shall consist of pressed
metal sleeves plugged at one end by punching the specified joint filler board
of a wad of cotton waste of similar compressibility and sealed at the end
against entry of mortar. The tube shall have an internal diameter permitting
sliding on the dowel bar but close enough to prevent entry of mortar.
310-2
310.2.8 Darkening Agent
Darkening agent for the top course of concrete pavements if ordered and
specified shall be a carbon black; either as an aqueous dispersion
containing at least 25% of solids, to be added to the mixing water, or as a
self-dispersing powder to be added to aggregate and cement. It shall be
approved by the Engineer as non-deleterious and as giving a grey colour
and shall be added at the rate of 0.1% by weight of the mixed concrete if it is
aqueous dispersion. The minimum quantity of self-dispersing powder shall
be 0.025% by weight of the concrete aggregate.
The darkening agent shall be free from sulphur trioxide and from any other
matter deleterious to concrete.
All materials shall be approved by the Engineer prior to use in the work.
Additional samples will be taken and tested by the Employer during the
progress of the work to check on the quality of the materials being supplied
and/or placed by the Contractor. The results of these tests will be available
for the Contractor's use, however they are not intended for construction
control purpose. The contractor should set up his own test facilities or
arrange the same from a private laboratory, to assure that his materials and
workmanship comply with the specification.
The base upon which the concrete pavement is laid shall be leveled
compacted and true to the grades and cross-sections shown on the plans
and shall be so maintained, as provided under such other items throughout
the period of placing concrete pavement.
To ensure the proper depth and section, a scratch template true to depth
and section and resting on accurately set side forms shall be moved over
the surface immediately before placing concrete, and any irregularities shall
be immediately corrected. High spots shall be planed down and the
Contractor shall have the option of either filling low spots to the proper
elevation with approved material, which shall be watered compacted and
struck off to the required grade or of placing additional concrete. No
measurement or payment will be made for such additional concrete.
310-3
Until the subgrade has been checked and approved, no material shall be
deposited thereon . Storing or stock piling of materials on the subgrade and
placing of surfacing material or laying of pavement on muddy or frozen
subgrade will not be permitted.
310.3.2 Forms
Each section of forms shall be straight and free form bends and warps at all
times.
Side forms for machine placing shall have rolled section steel rails which
shall be of adequate stiffness to carry the laying, compaction and finishing
machines.
These machines shall not run on folded sheet metal form tops. The top
faces of the forms are to be carefully cleaned and maintained. The forms
shall be without horizontal joints and with flange braces extending outward
on the base not less than two-thirds the height of the forms. Each stack
pocket shall be equipped with a positive non-detachable wedge. These
forms shall be placed by using at least three steel pins of the size and
length approved by the Engineer or as shown on the plans. They shall be
equipped with positive locking devices which will permit neat tight joints and
do not deform under impact vibration by thrust. Pins for stacking forms in
place shall be made of steel at least two(2) centimeters in diameter as
directed by the Engineer in case of impractical use.
Wooden forms may be used for curves having a radius of less than fifty (50)
meters. They shall be made of two and half (2.5) centimeters well seasoned
surfaced planks fastened together and shall be attached securely to a
wooden base in width. All wooden forms shall be braced at least every
sixty(60) centimeters with steel pins of the size and length here in specified.
Straight forms shall be set out as chords to convex edges and as tangents
to concave edges, but payment will not be made for concrete outside the
curved edges shown on the Drawings.
310-4
Before placing forms the underlying material shall be excavated to the
required grade, and shall be firm and compact. The forms shall have full
bearings upon the foundation throughout their length and shall be placed
with exactness to the required grade and alignment of the edge of the
finished pavement.
Forms shall be set to the required lines and grades well in advance of
placing concrete, preferably not less than two hundred (200) meters. Forms
shall not be removed for at least twelve (12) hours after the concrete has
been placed. Forms shall be carefully removed in a manner to avoid
damage to the pavement. Under no circumstances will the use of pry bars
between the forms and the pavement be permitted. Pavement which in the
opinion of the Engineer is damaged due to the careless removal of forms
shall be repaved by the Contractor as directed by the Engineer at the
Contractor's own expense.
Forms shall be thoroughly cleaned and oiled each time they are used.
Special forms or other supporting devices meeting the approval of the
Engineer shall be used to support the joint filler at transverse control joints
when concrete is to be placed on only one side of the filler. When pavement
is placed adjoining existing concrete pavement upon which the finishing
machine will travel, any irregularities in the old pavement shall be ground
down to a true uniform surface of sufficient width to accommodate the
wheels of the finishing equipment if necessary to obtain proper smoothness
of the pavement.
1. Composition
(a) All concrete shall be proportioned by weighing and shall conform to the
following strength and mix requirements
(b) At least 35 days prior to the start of paving operations and after approval
of all materials to be used in the concrete, the contractor shall submit for
approval, the mix design he intends to use based on proportioned
weights of cement, air entrainment agent, saturated surface dry
aggregates and water. This mix design will be tested by the Engineer
and approval will not be granted unless the average twenty eight (28)
days compressive strength exceeds the minimum strength requirement
by at least 15 percent. However the Engineer may allow paving
operation on the basis of seven (7) days strength if he is satisfied with
the results of seven (7) days strength.
310-5
c) The cement content given in the foregoing table is minimum. If it is not
sufficient to produce concrete of the compressive strength specified it
shall be increased as necessary with out additional compensation under
the contract.
e) During the course of construction, when the source of any material for
the concrete is to be changed, or if there is any variation in the quality of
the materials furnished, additional tests and necessary adjustments in
the mix shall be made as required to obtain the specified strengths.
2. Consistency
The required consistency of the concrete mixture shall be such that the
mixture will be cohesive, uniform and plastic, permitting proper handling and
finish. When deposited it shall not flow, but shall remain in a conical pile.
There shall be minimum of segregation and surplus water during the
process of handling and finishing. The slump shall be determined by
AASHTO T119-74 except that during the course of construction control of
concrete may be accomplished by the ball penetration as outlined in
AASHTO T183-72. Two and a half (2.5) centimeter ball penetration is
considered equivalent to a slump of five (5) centimeters.
Concrete shall either be batched and mixed at a central batching and mixing
plant or batched at a central batching plant for either mixing in field mixers
adjacent to the forms for slabs, or mixed in a truck mixer. When cement is
supplied in bags, each batch of concrete shall contain a whole number of
bags of cement.
i) Batching Equipment
All aggregates and bulk cement for use in pavement shall be batched by
weight by means of automatic devices of approved type conforming to the
requirements specified below:-
The batching shall consist of dividing the aggregates into three sizes, each
stored in a separate bin, of placing the cement in another bin, and of
recombining these ingredients as herein provided.
310-6
Material discharged from the several bins shall be controlled by gates or by
mechanical conveyors. The means of withdrawal from the several bins and
of discharge from the weigh box shall be so interlocked that not more than
one bin can discharge at a time; that the order of discharge can be changed
as desired by the Engineer.; and that the weigh box cannot be tripped until
the required quantity from each of the several bins has been deposited
therein. Should a separate weigh box be used for each size of aggregate, all
bins may be operated and discharged simultaneously. The discharge shall
be so regulated that the amount of material discharged into the weigh
hopper from any bin, with weighing devices at rest, will be within two (2) kg
of the weight called for by the scale setting for the bin.
When the discharge from the several bins is controlled by gates, each gate
shall automatically lock in an open or partially open position until the
required weight is discharged into the weigh box, after which the gate shall
automatically close and lock.
Scales utilised in the batching device may be of the springless dial type or of
the multiple beam type.
If they are the dial type, the dial shall be of such size and so arranged that it
may be easily read from the ground. The automatic weighing device of the
dial scale shall be so marked that the number of proportions required may
be set on the dial at the same time and that proportions may be changed
without delay.
If they are the multiple beam type, the separate beams shall be
automatically connected to the hopper or weigh box in sequence. Multiple
beam scales shall be provided with an indicator operated by the main beam
which will give positive visible evidence of over or under weight. The
indicator shall be so designed that it will be operated during the addition of
the last seventy kilograms of any weighing. The overtravel of the indicator
hand shall be at least one-third of the loading travel. Indicators shall be
enclosed against moisture and dust.
All receptacles used for weighing materials, together with the scales of any
kind used in batching materials, shall be so insulated against the vibration or
movement of the rest of the plant due to any operating equipment, that the
error in weighing with the entire plant running will not exceed two per cent of
any setting nor exceed one and a half per cent of any batch.
310-7
Should separate supplies of aggregate materials of the same size group,
but of different moisture content, be available at the batching plant,
withdrawals shall be made from one supply exclusively and the material
therein completely exhausted before starting on another.
Except where small quantities of concrete only are to be used, when the
Engineer may permit otherwise, the equipment for batching of concrete
materials shall conform to the following requirements:-
310-8
In lieu of the automatic devices for controlling the weighing of the
aggregates and bulk cement as described in the forgoing specification
for batching equipment, the Contractor may be permitted to substitute
manually controlled devices, provided approval for such devices is
granted by the Engineer.
Aggregate shall be transported from the batching plant to field paver mixers
in batch boxes, vehicle bodies or other containers of adequate capacity and
construction to carry the volume required, properly.
Batches shall be delivered to mixer separate and intact. Each batch shall be
dumped cleanly into the mixer without loss of cement, and when more than
one batch is carried on the truck without spilling of material from one batch
compartment into another.
310-9
Mixers shall have a locking device preventing the mixture from being
discharged before the expiration of the specified mixing time; an automatic
locking device preventing materials being placed in the mixer before
discharge gate is closed; a regulator that will maintain the rate of speed for
which the mixer has been designed; a signal device that will function when
water is added; a vertical water tank with an automatic device that will
measure and discharge the required volume of water; valves to prevent
overflow into the mixing chamber or on to the ground when the discharge
valve is closed and into the tank when open; and valves and piping in
proper order to prevent any leakage. The automatic device for measuring
and discharging the required volume of water shall be arranged to discharge
a predetermined volume, to be easily adjusted to discharge a larger or
smaller volume, and to register the volume discharged accurately on a
gauge or dial which shall be calibrated before the mixer is used and shall be
kept properly calibrated. A by-pass valve shall permit the discharge of all the
water into a measuring cane for the purpose of calibration. The measuring
of the volume of water required shall be done by means of adjustable
discharge device only.
The loading skip of the mixer shall be substantially made and shaped so
that wet sand and other materials will not remain in it when it is being
discharged. The mixer shall not be used when any of the devices above
stated are not functioning properly, or when the blades of the mixer have
worn down to ninety (90) per cent of their original width. The Contractor
shall furnish a certified statement from the manufacturer as to their original
width. The mixer shall be kept clean and free from hardened mortar.
v) Truck Mixers
Truck mixers shall be used only when permitted by the Engineer in writing.
Each transit mixer shall have a watertight drum, suitable mounted and fitted
with adequate blades capable of properly combing the mixture. A batch
meter and locking device to prevent discharge prior to completion of mixing
shall be provided on each unit. Measuring tanks, equipped with outside taps
and valves to facilitate checking their calibration, shall be provided for the
mixing water. All water added to the mixer shall be passed through an
approved water meter, located between the water tank and mixer drum,
equipped with indicating dials and totaliser, and capable of measuring and
discharging a specified amount of water within an accuracy of one per cent.
The device shall provide means of readily verifying the amount of water
added to mixing shall be provided on each mixer. An inspection opening
shall be provided on each mixer, to permit ready determination of the
consistency of the concrete being placed in the forms. When pick-up and
throw over blades are worn down two (2) centimeter or more in depth, they
shall be replaced with new blades. The Contractor shall furnish a certified
statement from the manufacturer as to the original depth of the blades.
a) General
The mixer shall be operated outside of the forms at all times except at
locations where the Engineer deems it not feasible to do so.
310-10
Concrete mixed in central plant shall be transported without delay from the
mixing plant to the position for laying and any concrete which in the opinion
of Engineer has been mixed too long before reaching, the work will be
rejected and shall be removed from the site. The concrete shall be
deposited on the subgrade in successive batches for the full width between
forms and in a manner which will require as little rehandling as possible.
Spreading shall be done by an approved mechanical spreader in a manner
that will prevent segregation and separation of the materials. Necessary
hand spreading shall be done with shovels, not rakes. Workmen shall not be
allowed to walk in the freshly mixed concrete with boots or shoes coated
with earth or foreign substances. the amount of material deposited shall be
sufficiently in excess of that required to form the pavement to the required
cross-section after consolidation in order to provide a roll of concrete ahead
of the front screed of the finishing machine for the full length of the screed.
Concrete shall be thoroughly consolidated against and along the faces of all
forms and along the full length and on both sides of all expansion joint
assemblies by means of vibrators inserted in the concrete. Vibrators shall
not be permitted to come in contact with a joint assembly, the grade or a
side form. In no case shall the vibrator be operated longer than fifteen (15)
seconds. Concrete shall be deposited as near to expansion and contraction
joints as possible without disturbing them but shall not be dumped from the
discharge bucket or hopper on to a joint assembly. The hopper is well
centered on the joint assembly. Damage to joint assemblies caused by
dumped concrete shall be repaired immediately as directed by the Engineer
at Contractor's expense. Trucks delivering concrete shall not run on
polythene sheeting nor shall they run on completed slabs until at least
fourteen (14) days after placing the concrete.
Placement of concrete ahead of the initial spreader strike off shall not be
more than fifteen(15) minutes ahead of final spreader strike-off. If concrete
is placed in one(1) layer only, the placement of concrete shall not be more
than twenty(20) minutes ahead of the spreader strike off.
The total time taken from the addition of the water to the mix until the
completion of the surface finishing operations shall not exceed thirty (30)
minutes when the shade or mix temperature exceeds twenty seven (27)
degree C or forty (40) minutes when less than twenty seven (27) degree C.
The mixing and placing of the concrete shall progress only at such a rate
as to permit proper finishing, protecting and curing of the pavement.
310-11
The additives shall be added to the concrete mix so as to ensure more
setting time. The top of the forms shall be kept free from accumulation of
concrete or foreign material. The Contractor shall not permit the
accumulation of laitance along the edge of a slab poured adjacent to one
previously placed. Any accumulation of laitance shall be removed and
replaced with fresh concrete. As soon as the side forms are removed, the
edges of the slab shall first be inspected by the Engineer and any minor
honey combed areas shall then be filled in with mortar composed of one
part of cement to two parts of fine aggregate under the supervision of the
Engineer.
b) Weather Conditions
Following the placing of the concrete, it shall be struck off to conform to the
cross section shown on the plans and to an elevation such that when the
concrete is properly consolidated and finished, the surface of the pavement
will be at the elevation shown on the plans. When reinforced concrete
pavement is placed in two (2) layers, the entire width of the bottom layer
shall be struck-off to such length and depth that the sheet of fabric or bar
mat may be laid full length on the concrete in its final position without further
manipulation. The reinforcement shall then be placed directly upon the
concrete after which the top layer of the concrete shall be placed, struck off
and screeded. Any position of the bottom layer of the concrete which has
been placed more than thirty (30) minutes with out being covered with the
top layer shall be removed and replaced with freshly mixed concrete at the
contractor’s expense. Plain concrete and bar reinforced bridge approach
pavement may be placed in one (1) layer.
Where two (2) layers of wire mesh reinforcement are required, as at bridge
approaches, the bottom layer shall be supported in the required position
with bar chairs. Separators shall be used for the top layer if the strike off
cannot be properly used for the operation. Laps in adjustment sheets or
mats of reinforcement shall be as shown on the plans. Laps parallel to the
310-12
centerline of the pavement will not be permitted except for unusual widths of
pavement lanes or for irregular areas. If the plans do not show dimensions
for laps, the minimum lap either perpendicular or parallel of the centerline of
the pavement shall be fifteen (15) centimeters. The adjacent sheets shall be
fastened or tied together to hold all parts of the sheets in the same plane.
Reinforcing steel shall be free from detrimental amounts of dirt, oil, paint,
grease, loose mill scale, and loose or thick rust which could impair bond of
the steel with the concrete.
310.3.7 Joints
a) Expansion joints
A string line shall be stretched between the pavement forms along the
centerline of the joint. One half of the length of each dowel bar shall be
painted in accordance with the directions shown on the plans and then
thoroughly coated with hard grease, or lubricant as approved by the
Engineer, to prevent the concrete from bonding to that portion of the
dowel.
The entire joint assembly shall be of a type designated on the plans and
shall be installed in such a position that the centerline of the joint
assembly is perpendicular to the centerline of the pavement slab and the
dowels lie parallel to the centerline of the slab. Finished joints shall not
deviate more than six (6) millimeters in the horizontal alignment from a
straight line. No plugs of concrete shall be permitted any where within
the expansion space.
The joint shall be securely staked or fastened in place prior to placing the
concrete and in a manner to ensure the joint and the dowel bars will
remain in their proper position after the concreting and finishing
operations are completed.
310-13
Joints for pavement designed for two (2) or less lanes of traffic shall be
assembled and installed in one (1) continuous piece or the connections
between sections shall be made rigid and tight to prevent offsets in
sections of the joints. The length of individual pieces of the expansion
joint filler shall be not less than the width of one (1) traffic lane of the
pavement.
As the finishing machine approaches the joint on the first trip, the excess
concrete shall be shoveled ahead and the tamper and each screed, in
turn, shall be lifted over the joint. On the second trip of the finishing
machine, the screed may be operated over the joint.
b) Contraction Joints
Contraction joints shall be of the type and dimensions and at the spacing
shown on the plans. Sawed contraction joints shall be cut by means of
an approved concrete saw. The joints shall not be sawed until the
concrete has hardened to the extent that tearing and reveling is
precluded. All joints shall be sawed during the initial curing period and
the sawing shall begin before the pavement starts shrinking and before
uncontrolled cracking takes place. Any procedure which results in
premature and uncontrolled cracking shall be revised immediately by
adjusting the sequence of cutting the joints or the time interval involved
between the placing of the concrete or the removal of the curing media
and the cutting of the joints. In no case shall the pavement be left
overnight without having the joints sawed. The joints shall be sawed at
the depth, spacing , and lines shown on the plans. Guidelines or devices
approved by the Engineer shall be provided to ensure cutting the joint in
a straight line and perpendicular to the centerline of the pavement. The
dust resulting from sawing shall be completely removed from the joint
and adjacent areas by means of an air jet or a combination of air and
water applied under pressure immediately after the joint has been cut,
and before filling with joint compound. When the plans specify that
dowels be installed through contraction joints, the subgrade at the
contraction joints shall be accurately trimmed to the required cross
section and to the proper depth of the pavement. A string line shall be
stretched between the pavement forms along the center line of the joint.
Each dowel shall be painted and thoroughly coated with hard grease or
lubricant, in accordance with the direction shown on the plans or as
approved by the Engineer, to prevent the concrete from bonding to that
portion of the dowel. The entire joint assembly shall be of the type
designated on the plans and shall be installed in such a position that the
centerline of the joint assembly is perpendicular to the center line of the
slab and the dowels lie parallel to the slab surface and parallel to the
centerline of the slab. The greased ends of the dowels shall be placed
310-14
in the direction as indicated on the plans and shall be free to slide in the
dowel holder. Any excess hard grease on the dowel holder shall be
removed.
c) Longitudinal Joints
d) Construction Joints
The top surface of the header shall be protected with steel as approved
by the Engineer. On the face along with the center of the header there
shall be fastened a trapezoidal piece of metal or wood the full length of
the header, five (5) centimeters wide and at least twenty five (25)
millimeters in depth to form a grooved joint. The header shall have drilled
holes to accommodate the dowel or tie bars hereinafter specified. Upon
resumption of Work any surplus concrete remaining upon the subgrade
shall be removed. The header shall then be carefully removed and fresh
concrete deposited against the old in such a manner as to avoid injury to
the edge of the old concrete. The fresh concrete shall be vibrated into
the groove in a manner to ensure an interlocking joint.
310-15
Dowel bars or load transfer devices shall be used in all construction
joints in accordance with the details shown on the plans. If no such
details are shown on the plans, tie bars as provided for the longitudinal
joint, and spaced at forty-five (45) centimeter centers, shall be placed
across the joint in a plane parallel to the surface of the pavement
approximately midway between the top and bottom surfaces of the
pavement. The edges of the joint shall be grooved, edged, and sealed
with the material used for sealing expansion and contraction joints.
e) Sealing Joints
310-16
f) Permanent Header Board
Immediately after the forms are removed from the ends of concrete
pavement that will be exposed to other than permanent type surfacing
and temporary and permanent traffic, a header board having dimensions
of not less than eight (8) centimeters (nominal) by twenty (20)
centimeters shall be bolted securely to the end of the pavement in a
manner to protect the edge of the pavement from damage. The header
board shall extend the full roadway width, but may be in two (2) sections.
At the time of placing the concrete , six (6) (three for each lane), thirteen
(13) millimeters by twenty (20) centimeters bolts shall be embedded in
the end of the pavement in a manner that will hold the header board
securely. The header board shall be shaped to conform to the crown of
the pavement and shall be installed flush with the concrete pavement
surface. The finishing and installing of the header board shall be
considered subsidiary Work pertaining to the other items in the Bill of
Quantities and will not be paid for directly.
The header will not be required on concrete base course Work.
310-17
As an alternative to the longitudinal finisher, the contractor may use a
machine composed of a cutting and smoothing float, or floats, suspended
from and guided by a rigid frame. The frame shall be carried by four (4) or
more visible wheels riding on, and constantly in contact with, the side forms.
When the longitudinal finishing has been completed, the entire surface shall
be tested with straightedges not less than three (3) meters in length. The
straightedges shall be operated parallel to the pavement centerline starting
at the center and progressing toward the forms. Advance along the
pavement shall be in successive stages of not more than one half (1/2) the
length of the straightedges. All laitance, surplus water, and inert material
shall be removed from the surface. All high places shall be worked down
and all low places filled by combined operations of floats and straight edges
until no irregularities exist. The proper crown of the pavement shall be
maintained throughout the operations.
After floating and straightening has been completed, the concrete shall be
finished by using a belt made of canvas, rubber, or other approved belting
not less than fifteen (15) centimeters in width, nor less than sixty (60)
centimeters longer than the width of the pavement. This belt shall be worked
with a longitudinal and crosswise motion. Care shall be exercised in the use
of the belt to ensure that the edges of the belt do not dig into the surface of
the concrete or work the crown out of the pavement. Either machine belting
or hand belting will be permitted.
As soon as all excess moisture has disappeared, and while the concrete is
still plastic enough to make a granular surface possible, a drag shall be
used which shall consist of a seamless strip of damp burlap or cotton fabric,
which shall produce a uniform surface of gritty texture after dragging it
longitudinally along the full width of pavement. For pavement (5) meters or
more in width, the drag shall be such that a strip or burlap or fabric at least
one and one half (1.5) meters wide is in contact with the full width of
pavement surface while the drag is used. The drag shall be maintained in
such condition that the resulting surface is of uniform appearance and
reasonably free from grooves over two (2) millimeters in depth, as
determined by the Engineer. Drags shall be maintained clean and free from
encrusted mortar. Drags that cannot be cleaned shall be discarded and new
drags substituted.
After dragging the surface with burlap, the concrete over the expansion joint
filler shall be completely removed and the joint finished. The edges of
the concrete at expansion joints shall be finished with an edger to the
310-18
radius shown on the plans. The exposed edge of the pavement shall be
finished with an edger to a radius of six (6) millimeters. Any tool marks
appearing on the slab adjacent to the joints or edge of slab shall be
eliminated by dragging the surface. In doing this, the rounding of the corner
of the slab shall not be disturbed.
The screed for the surface shall be at least one (1) meter longer than the
maximum width of the slab to be struck-off. It shall be of approved
design, sufficiently rigid to retain its shape, and be constructed either of
metal or other suitable material shod with metal.
310-19
concrete, shall be worked with a sawing motion, while held in a floating
position parallel to the road centerline, and passing gradually from one
side of the pavement to the other, Movement ahead along the centerline
of the pavement shall be in successive advances of not more than one
half (1/2) the length of the float. Any excess water or soupy material shall
be wasted over the side forms on each pass.
At the option of the Engineer, the long-handled floats having blades not
less than one and one half (1.5) meters in length and fifteen (15)
centimeters in width may be substituted for the hand operated
longitudinal float.
All other operations after this substitution for the mechanical equipment
shall be performed in the manner previously described.
Unless otherwise provided, forms shall not be removed from freshly placed
concrete until it has set for at least twelve (12) hours, except auxiliary forms
used temporarily in widened areas. Forms shall be removed carefully so as
to avoid damage to the pavement. After the forms have been removed, the
sides of the slab shall be cured as specified for the surface. Major
honeycombed areas will be considered as defective work and shall be
removed and replaced at the Contractor's expense, as directed by the
Engineer. Any area or section so removed shall not be less than three (3)
meters in length nor less than the full width of the lane involved. When it is
necessary to remove and replace a section of pavement, any remaining
portion of the slab adjacent to the joints that is less than three (3) meters in
length, shall also be removed and replaced.
a) Initial Curing
Upon completion the finishing operation and while the surface of concrete is
still moist, but no free water remains, a liquid curing membrane approved by
the Engineer shall be applied to the exposed surface of the pavement at the
rate not less than one (1) litre per three and two-thirds (3-2/3) square meters
of surface area when mechanical pressure distributors are used. The curing
membrane, except on irregular areas, shall be applied by means of
approved self-propelled mechanical pressure distributors or approved hand
sprays. Satisfactory means shall be provided for thoroughly mixing the
310-20
curing membrane compound before and during its use. The mechanical
spraying equipment may be either a full width spray bar equipped with
multiple nozzles or a traversing spray which travels from one edge of the
pavement to the other. In either case the path of adjacent nozzles or passes
of the traversing spray shall overlap a minimum of one-half (1/2) the width of
the spray pattern so that all portions of the surface shall receive double
applications from adjacent nozzles or passes. The pumping, pressure and
distribution arrangement shall be correlated with the forward speed to
provide adequate and uniform coverage of the pavement at not less than
the minimum rate required. Irregular areas to which the mechanical
distributor cannot be adapted may be covered with hand sprays.
When hand sprays are used, the curing membrane shall be applied in two
(2) applications, each at a rate of not less than one (1) litre per five (5)
square meters of surface area so as to provide a total rate of application of
one (1) litre per two and one half (2-1/2) square meters of surface area. The
path of the spray on the second application shall be at right angles to the
path of the spray on the first application. When hand operated sprays are
permitted, the equipment supplying the pressure to the spray nozzle shall
be capable of supplying a constant and uniform pressure to provide uniform
and adequate distribution of the curing membrane compound at the rate
required. If from any cause, such as rain-fall soon after its application, the
curing membrane is damaged, the Contractor shall immediately apply
another application of curing membrane to the surface of the pavement. The
rate of application for the replacement membrane shall be the same as for
the original membrane.
When forms are removed, whether during the initial or the final curing
period, the edges of the pavement shall receive curing membrane at the
rate of coverage specified for the pavement surface.
The curing membrane may be applied to the vertical edges of the pavement
by means of hand sprays or by nozzles attached to the mechanical
distributor, but the edges of the pavement shall be covered with curing
membrane at the rate specified within thirty (30) minutes after removal of the
forms.
When cold-poured joint compound is used, all joints shall be sawed during
the initial curing period. The shade-canvas may be moved at joint locations
for short periods of time to permit the sawing. Before being sealed, the joints
shall be thoroughly cleaned of all loose saw dust, laitance, dirt, other foreign
matter, and free of water. As the method of final curing is different
310-21
from that of the initial curing, the cleaning and sealing of joints shall be
performed immediately following the removal of the shade-canvas at the
end of the initial curing period and prior to the application of the
polyethylene sheeting.
When hot poured joint compound is used, the joints shall be sawed,
cleaned, and filled with jute or other acceptable protective material in the
same time sequence as for cold-poured joints.
b) Final Curing
Upon completion of the initial curing period and after the shade-canvas has
been removed and jointing operation has been completed, the pavement
shall be completely covered with White Opaque Polyethylene Film as
specified in AASHTO M 171. Adjoining sheets shall be lapped a minimum of
forty five (45) centimeters. The sheeting shall be held in place in a manner
approved by the Engineer.
Final curing shall be continued until the concrete reaches an age of fourteen
(14) days. During this period, the curing membrane and polyethylene film
shall be protected from damage from any cause. Any damage from one
cause shall be immediately repaired by the Contractor at his expense. No
traffic, including workmen and pedestrians, shall be allowed on the surface
of the pavement until the expiration of the fourteen (14) day curing period.
When concrete is being placed during the time that the air temperature may
be expected to drop below fifteen (15) degrees C, a sufficient supply of
burlap, straw, hay, or other suitable blanketing material shall be provided
along the work to protect the concrete and maintain a minimum temperature
of fifteen (15) degrees C in the concrete as measured on the surface of the
pavement. An approved moisture barrier such as wet burlap or plastic
sheeting shall be placed on the concrete prior to placing the blanketing
material. This type of cure shall be maintained for a period of seventy two
(72) hours as the initial cure. After the initial cure as specified above, a final
cure as specified above may be used. The final cure shall be maintained for
a period of fourteen (14) days, thus making a seventeen (17) day curing
period for cold weather concreting.
310-22
any two contact points, shall be marked and immediately ground down with
an approved grinding tool to a tolerance of less than three (3) mm as
described above. Where the departure from correct cross section exceeds
twelve (12) millimeters, the pavement shall be removed and replaced by
and at the expense of the Contractor.
Any area or section so removed shall be not less than three (3) meters in
length nor less than the full width of the lane involved. When it is necessary
to remove and replace a section of pavement, any remaining portion of the
slab adjacent to the joints that is less than three (3) meters in length, shall
also be removed and replaced at the Contractor's expense.
i) Thickness of Pavement
The Employer will not be liable for payment of any excess in thickness of
depth of pavement. During the progress of the work, the thickness or depth
of pavement will be determined by the Engineer from cores cut from the
concrete pavement by the Contractor. The cost of cutting and recovering all
the cores described in this clause and the following paragraph shall be
deemed to be included in the rates and prices for Portland Cement
Concrete Pavement entered by the Contractor in the Bill of Quantities.
310-23
d) The removal and replacements of pavements shall extend
transversely the full width each lane in which such deficiency is
found.
e) All pavements within two (2) meters of the deficiency spot shall
be removed, except that when any joint is more than two (2)
meters, all pavements shall then be removed to the next joint.
3.00 mm to 6.5 mm 95 %
6.5 mm to 13 mm 75 %
The cores that have been cut from the concrete pavement according to the
requirements of (i) above shall be examined by the Engineer's
Representative to check the degree of compaction achieved through the
slab and to check the effectiveness of the bond between the top and bottom
course concrete.
Should any core reveal that any part of the slab has not been adequately
compacted by revealing honeycombed or segregated concrete and should
the bond between the top and bottom layers of concrete be such that a
plane of weakness is present, then additional cores shall be taken to check
the areas of defective concrete pavement according to the procedure laid
down in (i) above for determining the areas of concrete pavement deficient
in compaction.
The Engineer reserves the right to carry out crushing tests on any or all of
the concrete cores taken in accordance with this clause, and should these
tests show that any area of pavement concrete has failed to meet the
strength requirements of the specification, then such areas of concrete shall
be removed and replaced with new concrete, mixed, laid, compacted and
finished to the requirements of this section at contractor's own expense.
310-24
iii) Refilling of Holes
Any concrete not complying with the specification shall be cut out and
replaced in accordance with the specification over the full width of the slab
between longitudinal construction joints and over a length extending
between two transverse joints each of a type other than a warping joint.
310.4.1 Measurement
The unit of measurement for payment shall be the cubic meters of the
completed and accepted Portland Cement Concrete Pavement, as
measured in place. The number of cubic meters of the completed Portland
Cement Concrete Pavement shall be determined by the length measured
along the centre line and upon the surface of the road, times the width as
shown on the Drawings plus the areas of any widening on curves, turnouts
and intersection, authorized and measured separately. Measurement of
pavement thickness will be ensured by erecting shutters for screeding
concrete at required level.
The unit of measurement for bridge Approach Slabs shall be the cubic
meters of the area actually constructed in accordance with the Drawings or
as directed in writing by the Engineer.
Concrete Lug Anchors shall be measured by the linear meters in place, the
measuring being made along the centerline of the concrete lug anchor
transverse to the pavement centerline. No measurement will be made of
unauthorized areas or for extra thickness.
310-25
310.4.2 Payment
The number of cubic meters of Bridge Approach Slabs, will be paid for at
the price tendered per cubic meter in the Bill of Quantities, which price shall
include the cost of constructing, finishing, curing, protecting and cleaning
the slab as above described; the surface preparation of the sub-base to
receive the slab; the construction of all joints of whatever type; all materials,
including joint filler and other joint material, equipment, labour and all else
necessary therefor, and all other work in connection therewith and incidental
thereto in accordance with the Specification and Drawings.
310-26
ITEM 311 ASPHALT CONCRETE WEARING COURSE (PLANT MIX)
WITH CELLULOSE FIBRE.
311.1 DESCRIPTION
a) Coarse Aggregates
Coarse Aggregates shall be crushed, non-absorptive stones and unless
otherwise stipulated, shall conform to the following quality requirements of
AASHTO M 283 for class A aggregates:
2.5 : 1 15 % max.
b) Fine Aggregates
311-1
c) Combined Aggregates
The several aggregate fractions of course and fine for the mixture shall be
sized, graded, and combined in such proportions that the resulting
composite blend conforms to Table-A below.
Table A
a. Mineral filler should consist of finely divided mineral mater such as rock
or limestone dust or other suitable material. At the time of use it should
be sufficiently dry to flow freely and essentially free from agglomerations.
Filler should be free from organic impurities and have a plasticity index
not greater than 4. Filler material for the mix shall meet the requirements
of AASHTO M 17.
311-2
Table B
1) Sieve Analysis
This test shall be performed using as Alpine Air Jet Sieve (Type 200 LS). A
representative five gram sample of fibre shall be sieved for 14 minutes at a
controlled vacuum of 22 inches (+/- 3) of water. The portion remaining of the
screen shall be weighted.
This test shall be performed using standard No. 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 and 140
sieves, nylon brushes and a shaker. A representative 10 gram sample of
fibre shall be sieved, using a shaker and two nylon brushes on each screen.
The amount retained on each sieve shall be weighed and the percentage
passing calculated. Repeatability of this method is suspect and needs to be
verified.
2) Ash Content
3) pH Test
Five grams of fibre shall be added to 100 ml of distilled water, stirred and let
set for 30 minutes. The pH shall be determined with a probe calibrated with
pH 7.0 buffer.
311-3
4) Oil Absorption Test
5) Moisture Content
Ten grams of fibre shall be weighed and placed in a 250o forced air oven for
two hours. The sample will then be reweighed immediately upon removal
from the oven.
The mix design test property values and cores used to develop the job mix
in accordance with the Asphalt Institutes Manual Series No. 2 (MS-2).
Acceptable deviations from various values of JMF shall be as under:
a. Aggregates
b. Asphalt Cement
c. Cellulose Fibre
311-4
311.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
Plants used for the preparation of the mixture shall conform to AASHTO M
156 and the following.
a. Handling Filler
Adequate dry storage shall be provided for the mineral filler, and provisions
shall be made for proportioning the filler into the mixture uniformly and in the
desired quantities. Mineral filler in a batch plant will be added directly into
the weigh hopper. In a drum plant mineral filler will be added directly into the
drum mixer. Special attention is directed to providing appropriate equipment
for accurately proportioning the relative large amounts of mineral filler
required for mixture.
b. Fibre Addition
Adequate dry storage shall be provided for the fibre additive, and provisions
shall be made for proportioning fibre into the mixture uniformly and in the
desired quantities.
c. Batch Plant
When the hot mixture is not to be hauled immediately to the project and
placed, suitable bins shall be provided. Such bins shall be either surge bins
to balance production capacity with hauling and placing capacity or storage
bins which are heated and insulated and which have a controlled
atmosphere around the mixture. The holding time shall be within limitations
imposed by the Engineer, based on laboratory tests of the stored mixture. In
no case will mixture be kept in storage overnight.
Hauling equipment and paver shall be of a type normally used for the
transport and placement of dense grade asphalt hot mix. Truck beds shall
be covered and insulated if necessary, so that he mixture may be delivered
on the road at a temperature of not less than 130 oC.
311-5
311.3.3 Pavers
Pavers shall be a type normally used for the placement of dense graded
asphalt hot mix. They shall be self-contained, power-propelled units
provided with an adjustable activated screed, heated and capable of
spreading and finishing coursed of asphalt plant mix material in lane widths
applicable to the specified typical section and thickness shown on the
plants.
The mixture shall be placed at a temperature not less than 290 oF. The
mixture temperature shall be measured in the truck just prior to dumping
into the spreader.
The mixture shall be spread and struck off to the established grade and
elevation with asphalt pavers.
311.3.6 Compaction
Immediately after the mixture has been spread and struck off, it shall be
thoroughly and uniformly compacted by rolling.
311-6
b. To prevent adhesion of the mixture to the rollers, it shall be necessary to
keep the wheels properly moistured with water mixed with very small
quantities of detergent or other approved material.
The mixture shall be placed only when the air temperature is four (4)
degrees centigrade or above and no asphalt shall be laid under foggy or
rainy weather or over moist surface.
311.7.1 Measurement
311-7
The quantity of cellulose fibre shall be measured in Kg. and paid separately.
311.7.2 Payment
The quantity determined as provided above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price respectively for each of the particular pay items listed below and
shown in the Bill of Quantities, which prices and payment shall constitute full
compensation for all the costs necessary for the proper completion of the
work prescribed in this item.
311-8
ITEM 312 PROOF ROLLING
312.1 DESCRIPTION
312.3.1 Measurement
Proof rolling shall be measured by the unit of square meter in the areas as
designated on the drawings or directed by the Engineer.
312.3.2 Payment
312-1
STRUCTURES
STRUCTURES
400.1 DESCRIPTION
This item contains a general description of the specific items of work, the
materials, construction requirements, and methods of measurement and
payment for all concrete structures including bridges, culverts, piles,
composite structures of concrete such as barriers and steel, prestressed
and post tensioned girder and all brick and stone masonry structures built as
indicated on the drawings and in conformity with the lines, grade, dimension
in conjunction with any instructions issued by the Engineer. Materials,
equipment, workmanship and construction methods applied in the work shall
conform to the requirements laid down herein and shall also follow the best
modern construction practices with the approval of Engineer. This item shall
also include construction of certain structural features and incidental items
which are either common to all types of structures or which may apply to
any of them.
The contractor shall clear the sites for proposed structures of trees, bushes,
stumps and debris, in the manner outlined in section 101 "Clearing and
Grubbing" cost of which shall be deemed to be included in the price bid for
the various items. Special clearing of site such as removal of existing
bridges, buildings, concrete pavement etc., will be paid for at the prices
tendered for these items, but where no such prices are provided for, all
costs in connection with the special clearing shall be deemed to be included
in the price tendered for various items of the structures in the Bill of
Quantities.
400-1
400.4 FOUNDATION DATA
Refer to clause 400(A).3 (b)
Upon completion of structure, the contractor shall clean up the site, remove
all temporary buildings, false work, lumber, equipment and all other debris.
The contractor shall level off all excavated material not used for back fill
around piers, bents, abutment, culvert, headwalls and on embankment
slopes. Bridge decks and side walks shall be left in clean and workman like
condition. No specific payment for clearing up shall be made but the cost
shall be included in other items shown on the bill of quantities.
400.7.1 Measurement
The quantities of various pay items which constitute the completed and
accepted structures shall be measured for payment according to the plans
and specification for the several pay items appearing in the Bill of Quantities
and in term of the prescribed units provided for the several pay items. Only
accepted work shall be included for payment and the measured quantity
shall be based on the dimension of component as shown on the plans or as
directed in writing by the Engineer.
400.7.2 Payment
The quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at the unit
prices bid for the several pay items appearing in the Bill of Quantities which
payment and prices shall be full compensation for furnishing, preparing,
fabricating, transporting, placing and erecting all material for the complete
structure; for all labour, equipment , tool and all other items necessary for
the completion of work. Such payment shall constitute full payment for
completed structure and no allowance will be made for cofferdam
construction, form lumber, false work and other incidental expenses.
400-2
ITEM 400 (A) BRIDGES AND CULVERTS
400.A.1 DESCRIPTION
All steel and concrete bridges and concrete culverts shall be constructed as
indicated on the plans, in conformity with the lines, grades, dimensions and
design shown on the plans and in accordance with the provision of item 107
"Structural Excavation and Backfill", item 401 "Concrete", item 402 "False
Work and Centering for Bridges", item 403 "Form Work", item 404 "Steel
Reinforcement", and item 405 "Pre Cast Concrete Structures", and all other
pay items which are to constitute the complete construction of the structure,
as directed by the Engineer.
400.A.2 MATERIALS
The materials used shall be those prescribed for several contract items
which are to constitute the complete structure.
The contractor shall clear the site of the proposed structure of trees, bushes,
stumps, and debris in accordance with section 101 "Clearing and Grubbing".
Special clearing of site such as removal of existing buildings, concrete
pavement shall be paid for at the prices tendered for these items, but where
no such prices are provided for, all costs in connection with this special
clearing shall be deemed to be included in the price tendered for the various
items of structures in the tendered Bill of Quantities.
b. Foundation Data
Foundation data including the location of all boreholes together with the
records of ground conditions encountered have been obtained from soil
investigation by test boring, test pits or other sources. It is the Engineer's
responsibility to ensure by additional investigations through the contractor at
the very beginning of construction work that the foundation levels given in
the Drawings coincide with the local requirements.
400(A)-1
c. Alignment and Grades
All structural members such as prefabricated girders, cast in situ deck slab,
cast in situ superstructures, bridge rails including kerbs, wheel guards,
safety fencing shall be so constructed and placed that finished vertical
alignment and grade shall be as shown on the Drawings.
d. Erection Method
Before moving any construction equipment to the site, the contractor shall
submit for approval an outline of the method he proposes to follow in the
erection of structure.
e. Navigable Streams
The channel of navigable streams shall be kept clear for safe passage of
water. The contractor shall provide and maintain all necessary light and
signals in accordance with the navigation authority's requirements. The
contractor shall pay due regard to the hazard of the river flow during period
of intense rainfall. All material deposited in the channel shall be removed to
the required depth and clearance lines at the contractor's expense.
f. Concreting
The concrete of Bridges or culverts shall be poured and surface finished and
cured as per requirements conforming to item 401.3
g. Final Clearing
400(A)-2
400.A.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
400.A.4.1 Measurement
The quantities of various pay items of Bridges and culverts which constitute
the completed and accepted structures shall be measured for payment
according to the plans and specification for the several pay items appearing
in the Bill of Quantities and in term of the prescribed units provided for the
several pay items. Only accepted work shall be included for payment and
the measured quantity shall be based on the dimension of component as
shown on the plans or as directed in writing by the Engineer.
400.A.4.2 Payment
The quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at the unit
prices bid for the several pay items appearing in the Bill of Quantities which
payment and prices shall be full compensation for furnishing, preparing,
fabricating, transporting, placing and erecting all material for the complete
structure; for all labour, equipment , tool and all other items necessary for
the completion of work. Such payment shall constitute full payment for
completed structure and no allowance will be made for cofferdam
construction, form lumber, false work and other incidental expenses.
400(A)-3
ITEM 401 CONCRETE
401.1 DESCRIPTION
Concrete poured below Natural Surface Level with or without shuttering and
shoring.
On Ground Concrete
Concrete poured by erecting formwork with necessary bracings on ground.
Elevated Concrete
Cement remaining in bulk storage at the mill, prior to shipment, for more
than six (6) months or cement stored in local storage by contractor for more
than three (3) months after shipment from the factory may be retested
before use and shall be rejected if it fails to meet any of the specification
requirements.
401-2
For exposed work, the fine aggregate shall be free from any substance that
will discolour the concrete surface.
401-3
The coarse aggregate shall be of uniform grading with maximum sizes as
required for the various classes of concrete as shown in Table 401-2 and
when tested in accordance with AASHTO Designation T-11 & T-27 shall
meet the following grading requirements.
TABLE 401.2
GRADING OF COARSE AGGREGATES
Percentage by Weight Passing Laboratory Sieves
Designated Having Square Openings, in Inches
1
1 1 /2 3 1 3
Sizes 2 /2 2 1 /4 /2 /8 No. 4
1
/2-in. to No. 4 – – – – 100 90-100 40-70 0-15*
3
/4-in. to No. 4 – – – 100 90-100 – 20-55 0-10*
1 -in. to No. 4 – – 100 95-100 – 25-60 -- 0-10*
1
1 /2 -in. to No. 4 – 100 95-100 – 35-70 – 10-30 0-5
2 -in. to No. 4 100 95-100 – 35-70 – 10-30 – 0-5
1 3
1 /2-in. /4 -in. – 100 90-100 20-55 0-15 – 0-5 –
2 -in. to 1-in. 100 90-100 35-70 0-15 – 0-5 – –
Coarse aggregate shall contain not more than one (1) percent by weight of
material passing the No.200 sieve by washing and not more than five (5)
percent of soft fragments.
It shall have an abrasion loss of not more than forty (40) percent at five
hundred (500) revolutions, when tested in accordance with AASHTO T-96.
When tested in accordance with AASHTO T-104, for five cycle, the loss with
the sodium sulphate soundness test shall be not more than 12 percent.
401-4
401.2.5 Rubble or Cyclopean Concrete
a) All cement shall be stored, immediately upon arrival on the site of the
work, in weather-proof building, which will protect the cement from
dampness. The floor shall be raised from the ground. The buildings shall
be placed in locations approved by the Engineer. Provisions for storage
shall be ample, and the shipments of cement as received shall be
separately stored in such a manner as to provide easy access for
identification and inspection of each shipment. Storage buildings shall have
capacity of a sufficient quantity of cement for at least thirty (30) days use.
Bulk cement, if used, shall be transferred to elevated air tight and weather-
proof bins. However, if approved, sacked cement on small jobs may be
stored in the open, upon a raised platform provided that ample waterproof
covering is ensured. Stored cement shall meet the test requirements at any
time after storage when retest is ordered by the Engineer. At the time of use
all cement shall be free flowing and free of lumps. Cement bags shall be
weighed at random to check for variation.
In order to secure greater uniformity of the concrete mix, the Engineer may
require that the coarse aggregate be separated into two or more sizes.
Different sizes of aggregate shall be stored in separate bins or in separate
stock piles to prevent the material at the edges of the piles from becoming
intermixed.
If aggregates are stored on the ground the bottom layer of aggregate shall
not be disturbed or used without recleaning and as approved by the
Engineer.
401-5
401.2.7 Water
The water for curing, for washing aggregates and for mixing shall be subject
to the approval of the Engineer. It shall be free from oil and shall contain not
more than one thousand (1,000) parts per million of chlorides nor more than
one thousand three hundreds (1,300) parts per million of sulfates (SO4). In
no case shall the water contain an amount of impurities that will cause a
change in the setting time of Portland cement of more than twenty five (25)
percent nor a reduction in the compressive strength of mortar at fourteen
(14) days of more than five (5) percent when compared to the result
obtained with distilled water.
In non-reinforced concrete work, the water for curing, for washing
aggregates, and for mixing shall be free from oil and shall not contain more
than two thousands (2,000) parts per million of chlorides nor more than one
thousand five hundreds (1,500) parts per million of sulfates as SO4.
In addition to the above requirements, water for curing concrete shall not
contain any impurities in a sufficient amount to cause discolouration of the
concrete or produce etching of the surface.
When required by the Engineer, the quality of the mixing water shall be
determined by the Standard Method of Test for Quality of Water to be used
in concrete, AASHTO Methods of Sampling and Testing, Designation: T 26.
401.2.8 Admixtures
Admixtures shall only be allowed to be used with written permission from the
Engineer. If air-entraining agents, water reducing agents, set retarders or
strength accelerators are permitted to be used, they shall not be used in
greater dosages than those recommended by the manufacturer, or
permitted by the Engineer, and shall conform to the requirements for each
of the agents specified by the manufacturer.
Unless otherwise specified, ordinary Portland cement shall be used for all
types of concrete. When sulphate resisting cement or other type of cement
is required, it will be specified on the Drawings/or in BOQ or ordered by the
Engineer.
401-6
Based on the approved mix proportions, the Contractor shall prepare lists
showing the number of kilograms of the various material to be used in the
batch size adopted. The required consistency shall also be shown. Such
lists are subject to approval by the Engineer, and shall be posted at the
mixer. The amount of water in the mix is the total amount of free water,
including the free water held by the aggregates.
No concrete shall be placed in the works until the results of the twenty eight
(28) days test indicate that the design proportions are satisfactory as per
requirements under Item 401.3.10 "Testing of Compressive Strength".
Adjustment of the proportions shall be subject to the following provisions:
a) Adjustment for variation in workability - If it is found impossible to obtain
concrete of the desired workability with the proportions originally
approved, the Engineer shall make such changes as are necessary.
The Contractor's attention is drawn to the time required to prepare and test
trial batches and the Contractor shall be responsible for production of trial
batches at a sufficiently early date so that the progress of the work is not
delayed.
401.3.2 Consistency
a) Mixing General
The concrete shall be mixed only in the quantity required for immediate use.
Concrete that has developed an initial set shall be rejected.
401-7
All concrete shall be mixed in mechanically operated mixers. Mixing plant
and equipment for transporting and placing concrete should be arranged
with an ample auxiliary installation to provide a minimum supply of concrete
in case of breakdown of machinery or in case the normal supply of concrete
should be disrupted. The auxiliary supply of concrete shall be sufficient to
complete the casting of a section up to a construction joint .
The accuracy of all weighing devices except that for water shall be such that
successive quantities can be measured to within one (1) percent of the
desired value. Cement in standard packages (bags) approved by the
Engineer need not be weighed. The water measuring device shall be
accurate to plus or minus half percent + 0.50%. All measuring devices shall
be subject to the approval of the Engineer. Scales and measuring devices
shall be tested at the expense of the Contractor as frequently as the
Engineer may deem necessary to ensure their accuracy.
b) Mixing at Site
Concrete mixers may be of the revolving drum or the revolving blade type
and the mixing drum or blades shall be operated uniformly at the mixing
speed recommended by the manufacturer. The pick-up and throw-over
blades of mixer shall be restored or replaced when any part or sections is
worn two and half (2.5) cms. or below than the original height of the
manufacturer's design. Mixers and agitators, which have an accumulation
of hard concrete or mortar, shall not be used.
401-8
When bulk cement is used and volume of the batch is one cubic meter or
more, the scale and weigh hopper for Portland cement shall be separate
and distinct from the aggregate hopper or hoppers. The discharge
mechanism of bulk cement weigh hopper shall be interlocked against
opening before the full amount of cement is in the hopper. The discharging
mechanism shall also be interlocked against opening when the amount of
cement in the hopper is underweight by more than one percent or
overweight by more than three (3) percent of the amount specified.
When the aggregates contain more water than the quantity necessary to
produce a saturated surface-dry condition, representative samples shall be
taken and the moisture content determined for each kind of aggregate.
The batch shall be so charged into the mixer that some water will enter in
advance of cement and aggregates. All water shall be in the drum by the
end of the first quarter of the specified mixing time.
Cement shall be batched and charged into the mixer by means that will not
result in loss due to the effect of wind, or in accumulation of cement on
surfaces of conveyors or hoppers, or in other conditions which reduce or
vary the required quantity of cement in the concrete mixture.
The entire contents of a batch mixer shall be removed from the drum before
materials for a succeeding batch are placed therein. The materials
composing a batch except water shall be deposited simultaneously into the
mixer.
All concrete shall be mixed for a period of not less than one and half (1.1/2)
minutes after all materials, including water, are in the mixer. During the
period of mixing, the mixer shall operate at the speed for which it has been
designed.
Mixers shall be operated with an automatic timing device that can be locked
by the Engineer. The time device and discharge mechanism shall be so
interlocked that during normal operation no part of the batch will be
discharged until the specified mixing time has elapsed. In case of failure of
the timing device, the Contractor will be permitted to operate while it is being
repaired, provided he furnishes an approved timepiece equipped with
minute and second hands. If the timing device is not repaired within twenty
four (24) hours, further use of the mixer will be prohibited until repairs are
made.
The first batch of concrete material placed in the mixer shall contain
cement, sand, and water in excess to the requirement of mix, to ensure that
the drum does not extract mortar from the mix changing its design
characteristics. When mixing is to stop for a period of one hour or more, the
mixer shall be thoroughly cleaned.
401-9
c) Plant Mixing
d) Transit Mixing
The maximum size of batch in truck mixers shall not exceed the maximum
rated capacity of the mixer as stated by the manufacturer, and stamped in
metal on the mixer. Truck mixing shall be continued for not less than fifty
(50) revolutions after all ingredients, including water, are in the drum. The
mixing speed shall not be less than six (6) rpm, nor more than ten (10) rpm.
Mixing shall begin within thirty (30) minutes after the cement has been
added either to the water or aggregate, but when cement is charged into a
mixer drum containing water or surface-wet aggregate and when the
temperature is above thirty two (32) degree C, this limit shall be reduced to
fifteen (15) minutes. The limitation in time between the introduction of the
cement to the aggregate and the beginning of the mixing may be waived
when, in the judgment of the Engineer, the aggregate is sufficiently free
from moisture, so that there will be no harmful effects on the cement.
For mixing concrete of zero slump to be laid by pavers, gravity mixer shall
not be used. Only force mixer of moving blades shall be allowed to ensure
homogenous mix.
401-10
g) Hand Mixing
a) Hauling
The rate of discharge of mixed concrete from truck mixer agitators shall be
controlled by the speed of rotation of the drum in the discharge direction
with the discharge gate fully open.
401-11
b) Delivery
The organization supplying concrete shall have sufficient plant capacity and
transportation vehicles to ensure continuous delivery at the rate required.
The rate of the delivery of concrete during concreting operations shall be
such as to provide for the proper handling, placing, and finishing of the
concrete. The rate shall be such that the interval between batches shall not
exceed twenty (20) minutes. The methods of delivering and handling the
concrete shall be such as will facilitate placing with the minimum rehandling
and without damage to the structure of the concrete.
c) Retempering
The concrete shall be mixed only in such quantities as are required for
immediate use and any concrete that has developed initial set shall not be
used. Concrete that has partially hardened shall not be retempered or
remixed.
a) General
In preparation for the placing of concrete all sawdust, chips and other
construction debris and extraneous matter shall be removed from inside the
formwork, and struts, stays and braces serving temporarily to hold the forms
in correct shape and alignment, pending the placing of concrete at their
locations, shall be removed when the concrete placing has reached an
elevation rendering their services unnecessary. These temporary members
shall be entirely removed from the forms and not buried in the concrete.
No concrete shall be used that does not reach its final position in the forms
within the time stipulated above under Item 401.3.4 "Hauling and Delivery of
Mixed Concrete".
Open troughs and chutes shall be of metal or metal lined; where steep
slopes are required, the chutes shall be equipped with baffles or be in short
lengths that reverse the direction of movement.
All chutes, troughs and pipes shall be kept clean and free from coatings of
hardened concrete by thoroughly flushing with water after each run; water
used for flushing shall be discharged clear off the structure.
401-12
When placing operations would involve dropping the concrete more than
one and half (1.1/2) meters, it shall be conveyed through sheet metal or
other approved pipes. As far as practicable, the pipe shall be kept buried in
the newly placed concrete. After initial set of the concrete the forms shall
not be jarred and no loading of any kind shall be placed on the ends of
projecting reinforcement bars.
The concrete shall be placed as nearly as possible to its final position and
the use of vibrators for extensive shifting of the mass of fresh concrete will
not be permitted.
b) Pneumatic Placing
Pneumatic placing of concrete will be permitted only if authorized by the
Engineer. The equipment shall be so arranged that no vibration will occur
that might damage freshly placed concrete.
c) Pumping
Concrete shall not be placed under water except where inevitable in which
case approval must be sought from the Engineer and the work carried out
under his immediate supervision. In this case the method of placing shall
be as hereinafter specified.
401-13
The slump of concrete shall be maintained between ten (10) and fifteen (15)
cm. To prevent segregation, it shall be carefully placed in a compact mass,
in its final position, by means of a tremie, a bottom-dump bucket, or other
approved means, and it shall not be disturbed after being placed. Water
must not be allowed to flow past the fresh concrete surface.
When the concrete is placed with a bottom-dump bucket, the top of the
bucket shall be open. The bottom doors shall open freely downward and
outward when tripped. The bucket shall be completely filled and slowly
lowered to avoid backwash. It shall not be dumped until it rests on the
surface upon which the concrete is to be deposited and when discharged
shall be withdrawn slowly until well above the concrete.
Dewatering may proceed when the concrete seal is sufficiently hard and
strong. All laitance or other unsatisfactory material shall be removed from
the exposed surface by scraping, chipping or other means, which will not
injure the surface of the concrete.
e) Compaction
401-14
work the concrete around the reinforcement and embedded fixtures and into
the corners and angles of the forms and shall be applied at the point of
placing and in the area of freshly placed concrete. The vibrators shall be
inserted into and withdrawn from the concrete slowly. The vibration shall be
of sufficient duration and intensity to compact the concrete thoroughly but
shall not be continued at any one point to the extent that localized areas of
grout are formed. Application of vibrators shall be at points uniformly
spaced and not farther apart than twice the radius over which the vibration
is visibly effective. Vibration shall not be applied directly to the
reinforcement or to sections or layers of concrete that have hardened to the
degree that the concrete ceases to be plastic under vibration. It shall not be
used to make concrete flow in the forms over distances so great as to cause
segregation and vibrators shall not be used to transport concrete neither in
the forms nor in troughs or chutes.
Vibration shall be supplemented by such external vibrator as is necessary to
ensure smooth surfaces and dense concrete along form surfaces and in
corners and locations impossible to reach with the normal vibrators.
a) General
401-15
Immediately following the discontinuance of placing concrete all
accumulations of mortar splashed upon the reinforcing steel and the
surfaces of forms shall be removed. Dried mortar chips and dust shall not
be puddled into the unset concrete. Care shall be exercised, during the
cleaning of the reinforcing steel, not to injure or break the concrete steel
bond near the surface of the concrete.
b) Slab Culverts
In general, the lean concrete below the foundation shall be placed and
allowed to set before the reinforced concrete is started.
c) Box Culverts
Vertical construction joints shall be at right angles to the axis of the culvert.
In general, the base slab or footings of box culverts shall be placed and
allowed to set before the remainder of the culvert is constructed. In this
case, suitable provision shall be made for bonding the sidewalls to the
culvert base, preferably by means of raised longitudinal keys so constructed
as to prevent, as far as possible, the percolation of water through the
construction joint.
In the construction of box culverts one and quarter (1.1/4) meters or less in
height, the sidewalls and top slab may be constructed as a monolithic unit.
When this method of construction is used, necessary construction joints
shall be vertical and at right angles to the axis of the culvert.
In the construction of box culverts more than one and quarter (1.1/4) meters
in height the concrete in the walls shall be placed and allowed to set before
the top slab is placed. In this case, appropriate keys shall be left in the
sidewalls for anchoring the cover slab.
401-16
Concrete in girder haunches less than one (1) meter in height shall be
placed at the same time as that in the girder stem, and the column or
abutment tops shall be cut back to form seats for the haunches. Whenever
any haunch or fillet has a vertical height of one (1) meter or more, the
abutment or columns, the haunch, and the girder shall be placed in three
successive stages; first, to lower side of haunch; second, to the lower side
of the girder; and third to completion.
For haunched continuous girders, the girder stem (including haunch) shall
be placed to the top of stem. Where the size of the pour is such that it
cannot be made in one continuous operation, vertical construction joints
shall preferably be located within the area of contraflexure.
Concrete in slab spans shall be placed in one continuous operation for each
span unless otherwise provided. The floors and girders of through girder
superstructures shall be placed in one continuous operation unless
otherwise specified, in which case a special shear anchorage shall be
provided to ensure monolithic action between girder and floor.
When friction collars are used to support cap forms, the concrete of columns
shall have been poured at least seven (7) days earlier.
401-17
e) Construction Joints
The placing of concrete shall be carried out continuously from joint to joint.
The face edges of all joints, which are exposed, to view shall be carefully
finished true to line and elevation.
The total volume of the stone shall not be greater than one third of the total
volume of the portion of the work in which it is placed. For walls of piers
greater than sixty (60) cms in thickness, stone of such size that one man
can handle it, shall be used. Each stone shall be surrounded by at least
fifteen (15) cms of concrete and no stone shall be closer than thirty (30) cms
to any top surface nor any closer than fifteen (15) cms to any coping. For
walls or piers greater than one (1) meter in thickness, larger stone (50 Kg or
more) may be used. Each stone shall be surrounded by at least thirty (30)
cms of concrete, and no stone shall be closer than sixty (60) cms to any top
surface nor closer than twenty (20) cms to any coping.
401-18
regulated so as to produce concrete of maximum impermeability. The
concrete shall be thoroughly compacted and air pockets shall be avoided.
No construction joints shall be formed between levels of extreme low water
and extreme high water as determined by the Engineer. Between these
levels sea water shall not come in contact with the concrete for a period of
not less than thirty (30) days. The original surface, as the concrete comes
from the forms, shall be left undisturbed.
1. General
Any concrete placed during hot weather or during cold weather shall be
at the Contractor’s risk and any damaged concrete shall be removed and
replaced at the Contractor’s expense.
Under conditions of rain, the placing of concrete shall not commerce or shall
be stopped unless adequate protection is provided to prevent damage to the
surface mortar or damaging flow or wash of the concrete surface.
The temperature of concrete shall not exceed thirty two (32) degree C at the
time of laying, unless the Contractor incorporates in the mix a plasticiser, of
a make and in proportion which he has shown by laboratory tests and full
scale trial to be satisfactory, to eliminate detrimental effects of high
temperature without introducing any other detrimental effect on quality.
The following may be used to keep the temperature of concrete below the
above limitations:
ii) Cooling of coarse aggregate by watering, provided that the water content
of the aggregate so cooled shall be uniform.
401-19
iii) Reclaiming of aggregate from stock piles by the tunnel method to avoid
using the surface layer of the stockpile with shade and wind protection of
conveyor elevating to batching plant.
iv) Night work provided that (i), (ii) and (iii) are proved inadequate or
unsatisfactory in their results and providing also that the Engineer has no
other reason for refusing permission for night work.
a) General
The bridge deck surface finish shall be given to the surface of the bottom
slabs of all box type underpass structures.
The requirements for sidewalk surface finish apply to the surface of the
bottom slabs in box culverts, except that the acceptable variation from a
three-meter straightedge shall be 10 mm, and brooming shall be omitted.
The ordinary surface form finish shall be the final finish applied to all
surfaces after removal of forms, unless otherwise specified or called for on
the drawings.
The Class 1 surface form finish shall be applied only where specified, or as
required by the Engineer when the ordinary surface finish did not produce
the required smooth, even surface of uniform texture and appearances.
401-20
b) Bridge Deck Surface Finish
A smooth riding surface of uniform texture, true to the required grade and
cross-section, shall be obtained on all bridge roadway decks. The
Contractor may use hand tools, or finishing machines or a combination of
both, conforming to the requirements specified herein for finishing bridge
roadway deck concrete.
The placing of concrete in bridge roadway decks will not be permitted until
the Engineer is satisfied that the rate of producing concrete will be sufficient
to complete the proposed placing and finishing operations within the
schedule time, that experienced finishing machine operators and concrete
finishers are employed to finish the deck, that fogging equipment and all
necessary finishing tools and equipment are on hand at the site of the work
and in satisfactory condition for use. Finishing machines shall be set up
sufficiently in advance of use to permit inspection by the Engineer during the
daylight hours before each pour.
Rails for the support and operation of finishing machines and headers for
hand-operated strick-off devices shall be completely in place and firmly
secured for the scheduled length for concrete placement before placing of
concrete. Rails for finishing machines shall extend beyond both ends of the
scheduled length for concrete placement to a sufficient distance that will
permit the float of the finishing machine to fully clear the concrete to be
placed. Rails or headers shall be adjustable for elevation and shall be set to
elevations, with allowance for anticipated settlement, camber, and deflection
of false work, as required to obtain a bridge roadway deck true to the
required grade and cross-section. Rails or headers shall be of a type and
shall be so installed that no springing or deflection will occur under the
weight of the finishing equipment and shall be so located that finishing
equipment may operate without interruption over the entire bridge roadway
deck to be finished.
401-21
After the concrete has been placed, compacted, and consolidated, the
surface of the concrete shall be carefully struck off by means of a hand-
operated strick board operating on headers, or by a finishing machine
operating on rails. A uniform deck surface true to the required grade and
cross-section shall be obtained.
In the event the strike off is performed with a finishing machine, longitudinal
floating of the concrete shall be performed by means of a hand-operated
float board or a finishing machine equipped with a longitudinal wooden float.
The longitudinal wooden float on the finishing machine shall have a length
of not less than two and half (2.5) meters nor more than three and half (3.5)
meters. When both strike off and longitudinal floating are to be performed
by finishing machines, one machine, with operator, shall be used for strike
off and a second machine, with a second operator, shall be used for
longitudinal floating. Longitudinal floating may be performed with the same
finishing machine that is used for strike off provided that the length of deck
unit being placed is not more than 10 meters and the strike off operation is
completed for said deck unit before the condition of the concrete requires
that longitudinal floating be started.
Finishing machines used for strike off having a wheel base 1.8 meters or
less shall be followed by 2 separate hand-operated float boards for
longitudinal floating. All the provisions in this Item pertaining to hand-
operated float boards shall apply to the 2 separate float boards for
longitudinal floating.
401-22
Hand-operated float boards shall be from three and half (3.5) to five (5)
meters long, ribbed and trussed as necessary to provide a rigid float and
shall be equipped with an adjustable handle at each end. The float shall be
wood, not less than two and half (2.5) cms thick and from ten (10) cm to
twenty (20) cm wide. Adjusting screws spaced as not to exceed 60 cms on
centers shall be provided between the float and the rib. The float board
shall be maintained free of twist and true at all times.
401-23
Bridge deck surfaces under the curbs, railings and sidewalk shall be struck
off to the same plane as the roadway and left undisturbed when future
widening is shown on the plans.
After the concrete has been placed it shall be compacted and the concrete
shall be struck off by means of a strike board, floated with a wooden or cork
floating and finished with a broom. An approved edging tool shall be used
on all edges and at all expansion joints. Brooming shall be transverse to the
line of traffic and if water is necessary, it shall be applied to the surface
immediately in advance of brooming. The surface shall not vary more than
six (6) mm under a three-meter straightedge, and the finished surface shall
be free of blemishes.
Except as provided herein, all form bolts and any metal placed for the
convenience of the Contractor shall be removed to a depth of at least two
and half (2.5) cms below the surface of the concrete. All rock pockets and
other unsound concrete shall be removed. The resulting holes or
depression shall be cleaned and filled with mortar. Form bolts projecting
into the cells of box girders need not be removed unless permanent access
is provided into the cells, in which case such bolts shall be removed flush
with the surface of the concrete. Mortar used to fill bolt holes shall consist
of one part cement and two parts sand. Other depressions and pockets
shall be filled with either packed mortar or air blown mortar as directed by
the Engineer. Mortar shall be cured in conformance with the requirements
in Item 401.3.8 (c) "Curing Structures".
If rock pockets or holes in the opinion of the Engineer, are of such an extent
or character as to affect the strength of the structure materially or to
endanger the life of the steel reinforcement, he may declare the concrete
defective and require the removal and replacement of the portions of the
structure affected.
Class 1 surface finish shall consist of finishing the surfaces of the structure
as necessary to produce even surfaces of uniform texture and appearance,
free of unsightly bulges, depressions and other imperfections. The degree
of care in building forms and character of materials used in form work will be
a contributing factor in the amount of additional finishing required to produce
even surfaces of uniform texture and appearance, free of unsightly bulges,
depressions and other imperfections, and the Engineer shall be the sole
judge in this respect.
401-24
After completion of the ordinary surface finish, areas which do not exhibit
the required smooth, even surface of uniform texture and appearance shall
be sanded with power sanders or other approved abrasive means until
smooth, even surfaces of uniform texture and appearance are obtained. The
use of power carborundum stones or disks will be required to remove
bulges and other imperfections.
Class 1 surface finish shall not be applied until a uniform appearance can
be obtained.
Class 1 surface finish may be required to be applied as the final finish for
the following surfaces, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer:
iii) All surfaces of open spandrel arch rings, spandrel columns and abutment
walls.
vi) Surface inside of culvert barrels having a height of one and half (1.5)
meters or more for a distance inside the barrel at least equal to the
height of the culvert.
f) Surface Rendering
All faces of concrete which are to come in contact with back fill or pavement
materials, shall be applied two coats of hot bitumen of approved quality,
before placing any material around concrete.
a) General
b) Method of Curing
401-25
Water Method
Curing compound Method
Reinforced Waterproof Paper Method if required by
the Engineer.
Forms-in-Place Method
Steam Method
Polyethylene Sheeting Method
Water Method
The concrete shall be kept continuously wet by the application of water for a
minimum period of seven (7) days after the concrete has been placed.
Cotton mats, burlaps, rugs, carpets, or earth or sand blankets, may be used
as a curing medium to retain the moisture, the entire surface of the concrete
shall be kept damp by applying water with a nozzle that so atomizes the
flow that a mist and not a spray is formed, until the surface of the concrete is
covered with the curing medium. The moisture from the nozzle shall not be
applied under pressure directly upon the concrete in a quantity sufficient to
cause a flow or wash the surface. At the expiration of the curing period the
concrete surface shall be cleared of all curing mediums.
When concrete bridge decks and flat slabs are to be cured without the use
of a moisture retaining medium, the entire surface of the bridge deck or slab
shall be kept damp by the application of water with an atomizing nozzle as
specified in the preceding paragraph until the concrete has set, after which
the entire surface of the concrete shall be sprinkled continuously with water
for a period of not less than seven (7) days.
The curing compound shall be applied to the concrete following the surface
finishing operation immediately after the moisture sheen begins to
disappear from the surface, but before any drying shrinkage or craze cracks
begin to appear. In the event of any delay in the application of curing
401-26
Curing compounds shall not hard settle in storage. They shall not be diluted
or altered in any manner after manufacture. At the time of use, the
compound shall be in a thoroughly mixed condition. If the compound has not
been used within one hundred twenty (120) days after the date of
manufacture, the Engineer may require additional testing before use to
determine compliance to requirements.
401-27
All joints in the sheets shall be securely cemented together in such a
manner as to provide a waterproof joint. The joint seams shall have
minimum lap of ten (10) cm.
Should any portion of the sheets be broken or damaged within seventy two
(72) hours after being placed, the broken or damaged portions shall be
immediately repaired with new sheets properly cemented into place.
Sections of sheets, which have lost their waterproof qualities or have been
damaged to such an extent as to render them unfit for curing the concrete
shall not be used.
Forms-in-Place Method
Steam Method
After placing and vibrating, the concrete shall be allowed to attain its initial
set before steam is applied. During the placing of concrete and application
of steam, provision shall be made to prevent surface drying by means of a
coating of approved material. The optimum curing temperature shall not
exceed sixty five (65) degree C.
The wet surface of fresh concrete shall be covered with white polyethylene
sheeting as soon as possible without marring the surface and should cover
all exposed surfaces of the concrete. The edges of the sheeting shall be
weighted securely with a continuous windrow of earth or any other means
satisfactory to the Engineer to provide an air-tight cover. Adjoining sheets
shall overlap not less than thirty (30) cms. and the laps shall be securely
weighted with earth, or any other means satisfactory to the Engineer to
provide an air-tight cover.
c) Curing Structures
All newly placed concrete for cast-in-place structures, other than highway
bridge decks, shall be cured by the water method, the forms-in-place
method, or, as permitted herein, by the curing compound method, all in
accordance with the requirements in Item 401.3.8 (b), "Methods of Curing".
401-28
The curing compound method may be used on concrete surfaces which are
to be buried underground, and surfaces where only Ordinary Surface Finish
is to be applied and on which a uniform colour is not required and which will
not be visible from any public traveled way.
The top surface of highway bridge decks shall be cured by both the curing
compound method, and by the water method. The curing compound shall
be applied progressively during the deck finishing operation immediately
after finishing operations are completed on each individual portion of the
deck. The water cure shall be applied not later than four (4) hours after
completion of the deck finishing or, for portions of the decks on which
finishing is completed after normal working hours, the water cure be applied
not later than 8.00 a.m. the following morning.
After placement of the concrete, members shall be held for a minimum four
(4) hours precasting period.
Enclosures for steam curing shall allow free circulation of steam about the
member and shall be constructed to contain the live steam with a minimum
moisture loss. The use of the tarpaulins or similar flexible covers will be
permitted, provided they are kept in good repair and secured in such a
manner to prevent the loss of steam and moisture.
401-29
All newly placed concrete precast piles, both conventionally reinforced and
prestressed shall be cured by the "Water Method" as described in Item
401.3.8(b) except that the concrete shall be kept under moisture for at least
fourteen (14) days. At the option of the Contractor steam curing may be
used in which case the steam curing provisions in Item 401.3.8(b) "Curing
Precast Concrete Members" shall apply except that the concrete shall be
kept wet for at least seven (7) days including the holding and steaming
period.
401-30
No aggregate for testing during the production of concrete shall be sampled
at the discharge gates of the bins feeding the weight hopper. The
Contractor, at his expense, shall provide safe and suitable facilities for
obtaining the samples. No concreting work on the project will be permitted
until the Engineer signifies in writing his approval, following the performance
of the necessary tests, on all the materials involved in making concrete.
A set of six (6) cylinders shall be taken from each fifty (50) cubic meters of
each class of concrete or fraction thereof placed each day, three (3) of the
six (6) cylinders to be tested after seven (7) days and three (3) after twenty
eight (28) days.
a) The minimum average 28 days test result of all samples tested at any
time shall be the specified twenty eight (28) days strength.
b) No individual samples tested after 28 days shall show a test result lower
than eighty five (85) percent of the required twenty eight (28) days.
Concrete represented by any single test cylinders that fails to comply with
the requirement under (b) above will be rejected unless the Contractor at his
expense, provides evidence that the strength and quality of the concrete
placed in the work are acceptable. If such evidence consists of tests made
on cores taken from the work, the cores shall be obtained and tested in
accordance with the specifications of AASHTO T-24.
a) Average test result of the cores shall be less than the minimum required
twenty eight (28) days strength.
b) No individual core shall show a strength less than Ninety five (95)
percent of the required twenty eight (28) days strength.
Should the above test results fail to comply with the requirements, concrete
of that particular pour shall be rejected and removed as directed by the
Engineer. Further more contractor shall redesign the concrete mix for
approval of the Engineer.
In case, seven (7) days strength shows less than seventy (70) percent of
the twenty eight (28) days strength (in case of type-I cement), Engineer may
stop further work on that particular portion of concrete, unless twenty eight
(28) days strength gives satisfactory results.
401-31
Trial Batches for Mix Productions
The placing of concrete shall not begin until trial batches of the mix design
to be used have been produced by the Contractor and tested and approved
by the Engineer. The trial mix proportions shall be such that the average
strength of five (5) consecutive test cylinders shall be 20% higher than the
specified twenty eight (28) days strength and no individual test cylinder shall
be below the specified strength.
401.4.1 Measurement
The quantity of concrete to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters
of concrete of the various classes complete in place and accepted.
In measuring the volume of concrete to be paid for, the dimension to be
applied shall be those shown on the Drawings except where others ordered
by the Engineer in writing.
Deductions from the theoretical volume of concrete shall be made for the
volumes of draining holes, weep holes, pipes and conduits, etc., in case
where their cross-sectional areas exceed 500 square centimeters.
The measurement shall not include any concrete used in the construction of
cofferdams or falsework.
Concrete for railings, pipe culverts, etc., is not to be measured under this
item, but under separate items.
401.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantity measured as provided above shall be paid for at the
contract unit price respectively for the pay items listed below that as per
shown in the Bill of Quantities which prices and payment shall be full
compensation also for such works as curing, surface finishing and/or
rendering as required, formation of construction joints and any such work
and incidentals necessary to complete the item except works that are paid
for under other pay items.
401-32
401-33
ITEM 402 FALSEWORK AND CENTERING FOR BRIDGES.
402.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of the design, supply and construction of falsework
which will provide the necessary rigidity to support the loads imposed, and
produce a structure, finished to the lines and grades indicated on the plans
or as required by the Engineer.
Timber and lumber to be used for falsework shall be of sound lumber and
comply with the requirement in AASHTO M 168.
Structural steel to be used for falsework shall comply with the requirements
of Standard Specifications for Structural Steel AASHTO M 183. Reinforcing
steel if it is to be used for falsework shall comply with the requirements of
AASHTO M 31 - 82. Concrete when used shall conform to Item 401 of these
specifications.
The Contractor may revise the falsework drawings at any time provided
sufficient time is allowed for the Engineer's review before construction is
started on the revised portions.
Assumptions used in design of the falsework shall include but not be limited
to the following:-
i) For designing falsework and centering, a weight of 2,400 kg. per cubic
meter shall be assumed for green concrete. All falsework shall be
designed and constructed to provide the necessary rigidity and to
support the loads without appreciable settlement or deformation. The
Engineer may require the Contractor to employ screw jacks or approved
wedges to take up any settlement in the formwork either before or during
the placing of concrete.
402-1
iii) Falsework, which cannot be founded on a satisfactory footing, shall be
supported on piling, which shall be spaced, driven, and removed in an
approved manner. The loading used on timber piles shall not exceed the
bearing value for the piles and in no case exceed ten (10) tons per pile.
iv) Soil bearing values and soil conditions (wet and dry) shall be designated
by the Contractor on the falsework drawings. Falsework footings shall be
designed to carry the loads imposed upon them without exceeding
estimated soil bearing values or allowable settlements.
vii) The maximum loading and deflections used on jacks, brackets, columns,
and other manufactured devices shall not exceed the manufacturer's
recommendations. If requested by the Engineer, the Contractor shall
furnish catalogues or other data verifying these recommendations.
viii)If the concrete is to be prestressed, the falsework shall be designed to
support any increased or readjusted loads caused by the prestressing
forces.
For the construction of falsework over and adjacent to road ways where
falsework openings are required for maintaining traffic, the Contractor shall
provide any additional features for the work needed to ensure that the
falsework will be stable if subjected to impact by vehicles.
The falsework design at the locations where said openings are required
shall include but not be limited to the following minimum provisions:
iii) Falsework members shall be at least thirty (30) cms clear of temporary
protective railing members.
402-2
The falsework drawings shall show any pedestrian openings, which are
required through the falsework.
The Contractor shall provide tell-tales attached to the soffit forms easily
readable and in enough systematically-placed location to determine the total
settlement of the entire portion of the structure where concrete is being
placed.
Should events occur, including settlements that deviate more than + 2 cms
from those indicated on the falsework drawings, which in the opinion of the
Engineer would prevent obtaining a structure conforming to the
requirements of these specifications, the placing of concrete shall be
discontinued until corrective measures are provided to entire satisfaction of
the Engineer. In the event, satisfactory measures are not taken to
correctness of excessive settlements, the Contractor shall not be relieved of
responsibility for conforming to the requirements of these specifications.
402-3
402.3.3 Removing Falsework
Falsework supporting deck overhangs and deck slab between girders shall
not be released until seven (7) days after the deck concrete has been
placed.
All debris and refuse resulting from work shall be removed and the premises
left in a neat and presentable condition.
402-4
ITEM 403 FORMWORK
403.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of providing, erecting and removing concrete forms of
sufficient strength with all necessary bracings, fasteners, etc. and in
conformity with the requirements hereinafter specified.
Forms shall be of wood, metal or other approved materials and shall be built
mortar tight and of sufficient rigidity to prevent distortion due to the pressure
of the concrete and other loads incident to the construction operations.
The requirements for design of formwork are the same as described under
Item 402.3.1 - Falsework Design and Drawings.
Forms for exposed surfaces shall preferably be lined with metal, plywood, or
other approved material, or may with the Engineer's permission, be made of
dressed lumber of uniform thickness. Forms shall be filled at all sharp
corners(Minimum two (2) cms triangular fillets) and shall be given a level or
draft in the case of all projections, such as girders and copings, to ensure
easy removal.
403-1
Fitting for metal ties shall be of such design that, upon their removal, the
cavities that are left will be of the smallest possible size. The cavities shall
be filled with cement mortar and the surface left sound, smooth, even, and
uniform in colour. Anchor devices may be cast into the concrete for later use
in supporting forms or for lifting precast members. The use of driven types of
anchorages for fastening forms or form supports to concrete will not be
permitted.
The inside surfaces of forms shall be cleaned of all dirt, mortar and foreign
material. Forms, which will later be removed, shall be thoroughly coated with
form oil prior to use. The form oil shall be a commercial quality form oil or
other approved coating which will permit the ready release of the forms and
will not discolour the concrete. All exposed surfaces of similar portions of a
concrete structure shall be formed with the same forming material or with
materials which produce similar concrete surface textures, colour and
appearance.
Concrete shall not be deposited in the forms until all work in connection with
constructing the forms has been completed, all materials required to be
embedded in the concrete have been placed for the unit to be poured, and
the Engineer has inspected and approved said forms and materials.
The rate of depositing concrete in forms shall be such as to prevent
deflections of the forms or form panels in excess of the deflections permitted
by these specifications. Maximum deflection allowed due to prop settlement
is 5 mm and due to bending of shutters is 3 mm, when measured with 3
meter straight edge.
Forms for all concrete surfaces, which will not be completely enclosed or
hidden below the permanent ground surface, shall conform to the
requirements herein for forms for exposed surfaces. Interior surfaces of
underground drainage structures shall be considered to be completely
enclosed surfaces.
Formwork for concrete placed under water shall be watertight. When lumber
is used, this shall be planed and tongued and grooved.
403-2
Forms shall be set and maintained true to the line designated until the
concrete is sufficiently hardened. Forms shall remain in place for periods,
which shall be determined, as herein specified. When forms appear to be
unsatisfactory in any way, either before or during the placing of concrete,
the Engineer will order the work stopped until the defects have been
corrected.
For narrow walls and columns, where the bottom of the form is inaccessible,
the lower form boards shall be adjustable so that they may be removed for
cleaning out extraneous material immediately before placing the concrete.
In the determination of the time for the removal of falsework and forms,
consideration shall be given to the location and character of the structure,
the weather, and other conditions influencing the setting of the concrete,
and the materials used in the mix.
If field operations are not controlled by beam or cylinder tests, the following
periods, exclusive of days when the temperature is below five (5) degree C,
for removal of forms and supports shall be used as a minimum subject to
the approval of the Engineer and to the requirements of Item 402.3.3.
Removing Falsework.
When field operations are controlled by cylinder tests, the removal of forms,
supports and housing, and the discontinuance of heating and curing (where
applicable) may begin when the concrete is found to have the required
compressive strength, provided in no case shall supports be removed in
less than seven (7) days after placing the concrete.
403-3
All forms shall be removed, except when no permanent access is available
to the cells, the forms supporting the deck of box girders and the forms in
hollow abutments or piers may remain in place. Prior to completion of
forming for the deck forms, the inside of box girders shall be cleared of all
loose material and swept clean.
In general, arch centering or falsework shall be struck and the arch made
self-supporting before the railing or coping is placed. This precaution is
essential in order to avoid jamming of the expansion joints and variations in
alignment. For filled spandrel arches, such portions of the spandrel walls
shall be left for construction subsequent to the striking of centers, as may be
necessary to avoid jamming of the expansion joints.
403-4
ITEM 404 STEEL REINFORCEMENT
404.1 DESCRIPTION
a) Order Lists
Before materials are ordered all order lists and bending diagrams shall be
furnished by the Contractor, for the approval of the Engineer. The approval
of order lists and bending diagrams by the Engineer shall in no way relieve
the Contractor of responsibility for the correctness of such lists and
diagrams. Any expenses incident to the revisions of material furnished in
accordance with such lists and diagrams to make it comply with the
drawings shall be borne by the Contractor.
404-1
b) Storing and Surface Condition of Reinforcement
c) Fabrication
Bent bar reinforcement shall be cold bent to the shapes shown on the
drawings or required by the Engineer. Bars shall be bent around a pin
having the following diameters(D) in relation to the diameter of the bar (d):
a) Protection of Material
Steel reinforcement shall be protected at all times from injury. When steel,
placed in position as shown on the Drawings, has easily removable and
detrimental rust, loose scale, or dust, it shall be cleaned by a satisfactory
method, approved by the Engineer.
404-2
Stirrups and ties shall always pass around the outside of main bars and be
securely attached thereto. All reinforcing steel shall be securely held at the
proper distance from steel forms, which remain in place by means of
galvanized steel bars or chairs placed on the forms. All reinforcing steel,
except as mentioned above, shall be securely held at the proper distance
from the forms by means of templates, concrete blocks or galvanized steel
chairs. Metal chairs shall not be used against formed surfaces, which will be
exposed in the finished structure after the forms are stripped. Blocks for
holding reinforcement away from contact with the forms shall be precast
concrete blocks of approved shape, and dimensions and shall have 16-
gauge black annealed tie wires embedded in them. The precast concrete
block shall have a compressive strength equal to that specified for the class
of concrete to be placed in the work. Layers of bars shall be separated by
approved metal chairs or bolsters.
c) Splicing
404-3
e) Covering
The minimum covering, measured from the surface of the concrete to the
face of any reinforcement bar shall, unless otherwise shown on the
Drawings or directed by the Engineer, be not less than 5 cms except as
follows:
In the footings of abutments and retaining walls the minimum covering shall
be 7.5 cm. In work exposed to the action of sea water the minimum covering
shall be 10 cm.
404.4.1 Measurement
The weight of plain or deformed bars or bar mat will be computed from the
theoretical weight of plain round bars of the same nominal size as shown in
the following tabulation:
6 0.222 20 2.466
8 0.395 22 2.984
10 0.616 25 3.853
12 0.888 32 6.313
13 1.042 35 7.553
16 1.578 40 9.865
Clips, ties separators, and other material used for positioning and fastening
the reinforcement in place and structural steel shall not be included in the
weight calculated for payment under this item. If bars are substituted upon
the Contractor's request and as a result more steel is used than specified,
only the amount specified shall be measured for payment.
404-4
When laps are made for splices, other than those shown on the Drawings or
required by the Engineer and for convenience of the Contractor, the extra
steel shall not be measured nor paid for.
When continuous bars are shown on the Drawings, without the splices being
shown the necessary steel in the splices will be paid for on the basis of the
individual bars not being shorter than twelve(12)meters.
For bent bars, the length along centre-line of bar will be paid.
404.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantity measured as provided above shall be paid for at the
contract unit prices respectively for the pay items listed below and shown in
the Bill of Quantities which price and payment shall be full compensation for
furnishing materials, labour, equipment and incidentals necessary to
complete the item.
404-5
ITEM 405 PRESTRESSED CONCRETE STRUCTURES
405.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall also include the furnishing and installation of any
appurtenant item necessary for the particular prestressing system to be
used, including but not limited to ducts, anchorage assemblies and grout
used for pressure grouting ducts.
405.2 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS
405.2.1 Prestressing Reinforcement Steel
The steel shall be free from injurious defects and shall have a smooth
surface. Material, which shows injuries defects during or prior to its
installation in the work, shall be rejected.
The Engineer may call for a relaxation test on prestressing steel in case, he
is not satisfied with the source of manufacture. Relaxation for prestressing
steel shall be measured over a period of thousand (1000) hours stressed at
seventy (70) percent of its ultimate tensile strength giving less than six (6)
percent elongation.
a) Testing
All wires, strands, or bars to be shipped to the site shall be assigned a lot
number and tagged for identification purposes. Anchorage assemblies to be
shipped shall be likewise identified.
405-1
All samples submitted shall be representative of the lot to be furnished.
All of the materials specified for testing shall be furnished free of cost and
shall be delivered in time for tests to be made well in advance of anticipated
time of use.
The contractor shall furnish for testing the following samples selected from
each lot as ordered by the Engineer. The selection of samples shall be
made at the manufacturer's plant by the Engineer or his representative.
For wires, sufficient length to make up one parallel-lay cable one and half
(1.5) M long consisting of the same number of wires as the cable to be
furnished. For strands, one and half (1.5) M length shall be furnished.
For bars to be furnished with threaded ends and nuts, one and half (1.5) M
between threads at ends.
405.2.2 Concrete
The materials for concrete shall conform to the requirements of item 401.
The concrete shall be Class D as shown in table 401-1 unless otherwise
shown on the plans.
405.2.3 Reinforcement Steel
General
Unless otherwise ordered by the Engineer, the Contractor shall certify for
the Engineer's approval that a technician skilled in the approved
prestressing method will be available to the Contractor to give aid and
instruction in the use of the prestressing equipment to obtain the required
results.
During the prestressing operations, standing behind or under jack will not be
allowed in order to ensure that no one is injured by the flying spindle, tendon
or the jack in the event of a break occurring.
405-2
405.3.1 Prestressing Method
(ii) That the actual losses due to friction coincide with the calculated
ones for the prestressing.
(iii) The suitability of the proposed steel for the chosen prestressing
system.
(iv) The length of transmission of the force to the concrete and the
minimum strength of the latter necessary for prestressing in
systems, where the prestressing elements are fully or partially
anchored to the concrete through bond and friction.
The Contractor shall submit well in advance to the Engineer for approval
complete details of the methods, materials, and equipment he proposes to
use in the prestressing operations. Such detail shall outline the method and
sequence of stressing, complete specifications and details of the
prestressing steel and anchoring devices proposed for use, anchoring
stresses, type of enclosures, and all other data pertaining to the
prestressing operation, including the proposed arrangement of the
prestressing units in the members.
405-3
connection with the jacks. All devices, whether hydraulic jack gauges or
other wise, shall be calibrated so as to permit the stress in the prestressing
steel to be computed at all times. A certified calibration curve shall
accompany each device. Safety measures shall be taken by the contractor
to prevent accidents due to possible breaking of the prestressing steel or the
slipping of the grips during the prestressing process. All equipments shall be
thoroughly washed with clean water at least once every three (3) hours
during the grouting operations and at the end of use for each day.
405.3.3 Enclosures
All steel units shall be accurately placed in the position shown on the
Drawings or required by the Engineer and firmly held during the placing and
setting of the concrete.
Concrete shall not be poured in the forms until the Engineer has inspected
the placing of the reinforcement, conduits, anchorages, and prestressing
steel and has given his approval thereof.
405-4
405.3.6 Pretensioning
405.3.7 Post-Tensioning
Tensioning shall be carried out only in the presence of the Engineer or his
representative unless permission has been obtained to contrary.
Immediately before tensioning, the contractor shall prove that all tendons
are free to move between jacking points and that members are free to
accommodate the horizontal and vertical movements due to the applications
of prestress.
After the concrete has attained the required strength, the prestressing
reinforcement shall be stressed by means of jacks to the required tension
and stress transferred to the end anchorage(s). Stressing shall be from both
ends unless otherwise required in the Contract or agreed by the Engineer.
The tensioning process shall be so conducted that the tension being applied
and the elongation of the prestressing elements may be measured at all
times. The friction loss in the elements, i.e., the difference between the
tension at the jack and the minimum tension in the prestressing steel shall
be determined by the formula:
Ft = 2(F1 - a c E)
d
Where
405-5
E = secant modules of elasticity of the element for the
stress F1 as determined from the stress-strain
diagram of the element.
Any surplus length of tendon shall be cut off by an approved method which
will not affect the strength of the stressed tendon, with particular care if the
use of spark erosion or oxyacetylene burning methods of cutting are
approved by the Engineer.
A record shall be kept of gauge pressures and elongation at all times and
submitted to the Engineer for his approval with in twenty four (24) hours of
each tensioning operation. The tendons shall be maintained in such a
condition that they can be re-stressed until the Engineer has given final
approval after inspecting the tensioning log.
The grout shall be fluid (consistency of thick paint) but proportioned so that
free water will not separate out of the mix. Unpolished aluminum powder
may be added in an amount per sack of cement as approved by the
Engineer. Commercial plasticisers used in accordance with the
manufacturer's recommendation may be used provided they contain no
ingredients that are corrosive to steel. Sufficient pressure shall be used in
grouting to force the grout completely through the duct, care being taken
that rupturing of the ducts does not occur.
405-6
405.3.9 Handling
Care shall be taken during storage, hoisting, and handling of the precasting
units to prevent cracking or damage. Units damaged by improper storing or
handling shall be replaced by the Contractor at his expense.
ii) The Contractor shall inform the Engineer in advance of the date of
commencement of manufacture and the dates when tensioning of
tendons, casting of members and transfer of stress will be undertaken for
the first time for each type of beam.
iii) The Contractor shall send to the Engineer not more than seven (7) days
after the transfer of stress, a certificate showing the force and strain in
the tendons immediately after they were anchored, the strength and age
of the test cubes cast in accordance with specified procedure and the
minimum age in hours of the concrete at the time the stress was applied
to the member. A copy of all twenty eight (28) days cube test results
relating to the work shall be sent to the Engineer as these become
available. Records shall be kept so that the identity of those who stress
the tendons, cast the concrete and transfer the stress on any member or
line of members can be traced.
(i) The difference in soffit level between adjacent units before the in
situ concrete is placed shall no-where exceed five (5) mm for
units up to five (5) meters nor ten (10) mm for longer units.
405-7
(ii) The width of the deck soffit shall be within plus twenty five (+25)
mm of that described in the Contract.
(iii) In adjacent spans, the continuity of line of the outside beams
shall be maintained.
(iv) The width of the gap between individual beams shall not exceed
twice the nominal gap described in the contract.
(v) The alignment of transverse holes shall permit the reinforcement
or prestressing tendons to be placed without distortion.
c) Beams shall be prevented from moving laterally during the placing of the
in-situ concrete.
(ii) The beam shall be supported at its design points of bearing. The
specified test loads shall be applied equally at the third points of
the span in not less than ten (10) approximately equal stages.
The maximum load shall be sustained for five (5) minutes and
then removed in not less than five (5) approximately equal
stages. The mid-span deflection relative to a straight reference
line joining the points of support shall be measured for each
value of the load and five (5) minutes after removal of the load.
(iii) Loads shall be measured with an accuracy of + two (2) per cent
or 50kg and deflections with an accuracy of + decimal five (0.5)
millimeter.
(iv) The load-deflection graph shall be plotted from these values and
shall show no appreciable variation from a straight line. If after
five (5) minutes of removal of the load the beam does not show a
recovery of at least ninety (90) per cent of the maximum
deflection recorded during the test, the test loading shall be
repeated. The beam shall be considered to have failed the test if
the recovery five (5) minutes after removal of the test load for the
second time is not at least ninety (90) per cent of the maximum
deflection recorded during the second test.
405-8
(v) The result of the test shall be deemed to apply to the other
beams cast in the same production line but in the event of failure
any additional beam may be separately tested at the contractor's
option.
(vi) The contractor shall supply to the Engineer record sheets of the
test showing the age of the beam at the time of the test, loads,
deflections, load-deflection curves and calculated value of
Young's Modules of Elasticity (E).
(vii) In addition, the record sheets supplied by the contractor to the
Engineer shall show the temperatures of the top and bottom
surfaces of the beam measured at the time of the test.
a) General
For all prestressed concrete operations the curing procedures shall be well
established and properly controlled. Curing shall be commenced
immediately following initial set or completion of surface finishing. Members
shall be kept wet during the entire period of curing.
b) Method of Curing
The curing methods shall conform to those detailed under item 401.3.8.
405.4.1 Measurement
Measurement and payments for the various items in prestress concrete
work shall be made in accordance with appropriate items of relevant
sections, as depicted in the drawings.
405.4.2 Payment
405-9
405.4.2.2 Cast-in-Place Prestressed Concrete
The work to be paid for under this item will be only the prestressing work as
specified here and shown on the Drawings or required by the Engineer and
shall include supply and installation of prestressing steel, spacers,
enclosures, anchorages plates, nuts and other such material deemed
necessary to complete the work. Steel reinforcement, concrete, falsework,
and formwork will, unless otherwise prescribed, be measured and paid for
according to item No. 401and 404 respectively.
Pay item No. Description and Unit of Measurement for Precast Prestressed
Concrete Members and Cast-in-Place Prestressed Concrete will be
covered, under specified BOQ item number provided in special provisions,
as per drawings and other related documents for following item separately.
406.1 DESCRIPTION
The work covered in this item shall consist of furnishing all plant, equipment,
materials and labour in performing all operations in connection with
furnishing and placing (in concrete structures) all deck expansion joints and
seals, metal bearing pads and elastomeric bearing pads complete and in
accordance with the specifications, the Drawings, and or as required by the
Engineer.
Plates, angles or other structural shapes including anchor bolts required for
the expansion joint seals shall conform, unless otherwise directed by the
Engineer, to the requirements of AASHTO M-160 and shall be hot zinc
sprayed (galvanized) with the exception of the nuts and washers which shall
be in stainless steel.
406-1
Hardness, Durometer A, 45 + 5 points
ASTM D 2240.
Tensile Strength,
ASTM D 412 127 Kgs/square centimeter
min.
The reinforcing steel plates laminations for bearing pads shall conform to
the requirements of AASHTO M 183.
406-2
Pads twelve (12) mm and less in thickness may be either laminated or all
elastomer.
The outside laminations shall be metal or fabric. The outside edges of metal
laminations shall be coated over with elastomer not more than three (3) mm
in thickness.
The edges of the steel reinforcing plates of the bearing pads shall be
carefully treated to prevent notch effects.
The total overall thickness of a pad shall not be less than the thickness
shown on the plan nor more than six (6) mm greater than that thickness.
Variation of total thickness within an individual pad shall not exceed three
(3) mm.
The length and width of a pad shall not vary more than three (3) mm from
the dimensions shown on the Drawings.
Where elastomeric bearing pads over twelve (12) mm, in thickness are
shown on the Drawings or required by the Engineers, such pads may be
manufactured as a molded laminated pad, or at the option of the Contractor,
may be made up by stacking individual laminated pads.
When laminated pads are stacked, their contact surfaces shall be cleaned
prior to stacking and an approved method shall be used to hold the
individual pads in the stack in proper alignment. Pads of all elastomer or
with fabric laminations may be cut from large sheets. Cutting shall be
performed in such a manner as to avoid heating of the material and to
produce a smooth edge with no tears or other jagged areas and to cause as
little damage to the material as possible.
Corners and edges of molded pads may be rounded at the option of the
Contractor. Radius at corners shall not exceed ten (10) mm and radius of
edges shall not exceed three (3) mm.
406-3
The bond between elastomer and metal or fabric shall be such that, when a
sample is tested for separation, failure shall occur within the elastomer and
not between the elastomer and metal or fabric.
Metal laminations shall be rolled mild steel sheets not less than twenty (20)
gauge in thickness.
The sole polymer in the elastomeric compound shall be neoprene and shall
be not less than sixty (60) percent by volume of the total compound.
406-4
After accelerated aging in accordance with ASTM Designation D 573 for 70
hours at 100 degree C, the elastomer shall not show deterioration changes
in excess of the following:
Hardness, points + 10
The Engineer will take a sample of not less than 15 x 30 cm in size for
testing from each lot of pads or batch of elastomer to be furnished,
whichever results in the greater number of samples. The samples will be
selected at random at the point of manufacture or, at the option of the
Contractor at the job site. Samples taken at the job site shall consist of
complete pads as detailed on the plans, and the Contractor shall furnish
additional complete pads to replace those taken for testing. Pads shall be
available for sampling three (3) weeks in advance of intended use. All
sample pads for testing shall be furnished by the Contractor at his expense.
406-5
406.3.3 Steel Joints
Water-stops shall be furnished in full length for each straight portion of the
joint, without field splices. Manufacturer's shop splices shall be fully
vulcanized.
406-6
Bronze or copper alloy plates, if specified, shall conform to the requirements
of the Special Provisions.
The bearing plates shall be set level and the rockers or other expansion
devices shall be set to conform to the temperature at the time of erection or
to the setting specified.
When elastomeric bearing pads are shown on the Drawings, the concrete
surfaces on which pads or packing are to be placed shall be wood float
finished to a level plane which shall not vary more than one and a half (1.5)
mm from a straightedge placed in any direction across the area. The
finished plane shall not vary more than three (3) mm from the elevation
shown on the Drawings or that required by the Engineer.
406.4.1 Measurement
b) Steel Joints
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of kilograms of steel for steel
joints fabricated, galvanized and placed in the work completed and
accepted.
c) Water Stops
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of linear meters of water-
stop placed in the work, completed and accepted.
d) Bearing Devices
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number or bearing devices either
steel bearing or elastomeric bearing pads installed in the work completed
and accepted.
406-7
e) Asphaltic Felt
406.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantity measured as provided above shall be paid for at the
contract unit price respectively for the pay items listed below and shown in
the Bill of Quantities which price and payment shall be full compensation for
furnishing all materials, labour, equipment, tools and incidentals and any
work pertaining to joints and bearings and which is not paid for separately,
necessary to complete the item.
407.1 DESCRIPTION
The Contractor shall furnish the precast piles in accordance with an itemized
list, which will be provided by the Engineer, showing the number and lengths
of all piles. When cast-in-place concrete piles are specified on the Drawings,
the Engineer will not furnish the Contractor, an itemized list showing the
number and length of piles. When test piles and load tests are required in
conformance with sub-items 407.3.8 and 407.3.9 respectively, the data
obtained from such test loads will be used in conjunction with other available
subsoil information to determine the number and lengths of piles to be
furnished. The Engineer will not prepare the itemized list of piles for any
portion of the foundation area until all loading tests representative of that
portion have been completed.
Not less than two weeks before the contractor proposes to commence
piling, detailed proposal for the piling shall be delivered to the Engineer.
These proposals shall include full details of materials, equipment and
method to be used in the construction of piles.
Work on piling shall not commence until the contractor’s proposals have
been approved by the Engineer and communicated to the contractor.
The kind and type of piles shall be as shown on the Drawings and/or as
specified. No alternate types or kinds of piling shall be used, except with the
written approval of the Engineer each time.
407-1
407.2 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS
Reinforcing Steel shall conform to the requirements under Item 404 - Steel
Reinforcement.
Concrete shall meet all the requirements for specified Class as provided
under Item 401 and shall be of Class-D unless otherwise specified.
Structural steel piles shall be rolled steel sections of the type, weight and
shape called for on the Drawings. The piles shall be structural steel
conforming to the requirements of ASTM A 7 and ASTM A 36, except that
steel produced by the Acid-Bessemer process shall not be used.
The steel piles shall be coated with red lead paint conforming to AASHTO
M 72 as instructed by the Engineer, unless otherwise specified.
Concrete for piles shall meet all the requirements for the specified class as
provided under Item 401 - Concrete. The concrete shall be of Class-D1
unless otherwise specified.
Reinforcing Steel shall conform to the requirements under Item 404 - Steel
Reinforcement.
407-2
The piles shall be cast separately or, if alternate piles are cast in a tier, the
intermediate piles shall not be cast until four (4) days after the adjacent piles
have been poured. Piles cast in tiers shall be separated by tar paper or
other suitable separating materials. The concrete in each pile shall be
placed continuously. The completed piles shall be free from stone pockets,
porous spots, or other defects, and shall be straight and true to the form
specified. The forms shall be true to line and built of metal, plywood, or
dressed lumber. A two and half (2.5) cm chamfer strip shall be formed on all
edges. Forms shall be watertight and shall not be removed within twenty
four (24) hours after the concrete is placed. Piles shall be given a surface
finish according to Item 401.3.7 - Concrete Surface Finishing.
Piles shall be cured in accordance with the requirements of Item 401.3.8 (e)
- Curing Precast Concrete Piles.
Piles shall not be moved until the tests indicate a compressive strength of
eighty (80) percent of the design twenty eight (28) days compressive
strength and they shall not be transported or driven until the tests indicate a
compressive strength equal to the design twenty eight (28) days
compressive strength.
When concrete piles are lifted or moved, they shall be supported at the
points shown on the Drawings or, if not so shown, as instructed by the
Engineer.
Pile shoes when required shall be of the design as called for on the
Drawings or by the Engineer.
Materials for pile splices, when splicing is allowed, shall be of the same
quality and characteristics as the materials used for the pile itself and shall
follow the requirements given on the Drawings unless otherwise directed by
the Engineer.
407-3
All excavations for the foundation in which the piles are to be driven shall be
completed before the driving is begun, unless otherwise specified or
approved by the Engineer. After driving is completed, all loose and
displaced materials shall be removed from around the piles by hand
excavation, leaving clean solid surfaces to receive the concrete for
foundations.
The criteria for pile length and bearing capacity will be determined by the
Engineer according to the results from test piles and load tests. The piles
shall be driven to such depths, that the bearing loads indicated on the
Drawings are obtained.
The contractor shall be responsible for correct pile lengths and bearing
capacities according to the criteria given by the Engineer.
c. Pile Driving
All piles shall be driven accurately to the vertical or the batter as shown on
the drawings. Each pile shall, after driving, be within fifteen (15) cm from the
theoretical location underneath the pile cap or underneath the
superstructure in the case of pile bents. All piles pushed up by the driving of
adjacent piles or by any other cause shall be driven down again.
Piles shall be used only in places where a minimum penetration of three (3)
meters in firm materials, or five (5) meters in soft materials, can be obtained.
Where a soft stratum overlies a hard stratum, the piles shall penetrate to
hard material upto a sufficient distance to fix the ends rigidly.
407-4
hammers shall have sufficient capacity to maintain, under working
conditions, the pressure at the hammer specified by the manufacturer. The
boiler or pressure tank shall be equipped with an accurate pressure gauge
and another gauge shall be supplied at the hammer intake to determine the
drop in pressure between the gauge and the hammer. When diesel
hammers are used, they shall be calibrated with test piling and/or test loads
in accordance with Item 407.3.9.
Water jets shall be used only when permitted in writing by the Engineer.
When water jets are used, the number of jets and the nozzle volume and
pressure shall be sufficient to erode the material adjacent to the pile freely.
The jets shall be shut off at a depth not less than three (3) M before final tip
elevation is reached, and the piles driven solely by hammer to final
penetration as required by the Engineer.
Piles shall be supported in line and position with leads while being driven.
Pile driving leads shall be constructed in such a manner as to afford
freedom of movement of the hammer, and shall be held in position by guys
or steel braces to ensure rigid lateral support to the pile during driving. The
leads shall be of sufficient length to make the use of a follower unnecessary,
and shall be so designed as to permit proper placing of batter piles. The
driving of piles with followers shall be avoided if practicable and shall be
done only under written permission from the Engineer.
The method used in driving piles shall not subject them to excessive and
undue abuse producing crushing and spalling of the concrete, injurious
splitting and brooming of the wood, or deformation of the steel. Manipulation
of piles to force them into proper position, if considered by the Engineer to
be excessive, will not be permitted.
407-5
For drop hammer
Qall = WH/[6(S+2.5)]
407-6
a) For piles driven to and seated in rock as high capacity end-
bearing piles: Drive to refusal (approximately four (4) to five (5)
blows for the last 0.625 centimeters of driving). Re-drive open
end pipe piles repeatedly until resistance for refusal is reached
within two and half (2.5) centimeters of additional penetration.
Piles, cast-in-place, shall consist of one of the types either shown on the
drawing and/or as specified. The term shaft wherever used in this section,
shall mean either piles or shafts.
a. Working Drawings
407-7
The Contractor shall not start the construction of drilled shafts for which
working drawings are required until such drawings have been approved by
the Engineer. Such approval will not relieve the Contractor of responsibility
for results obtained by use of these drawings or any of his other
responsibilities under the contract.
In the case of steel shells or pipes, after being driven and prior to placing
reinforcing steel and concrete therein, the steel shells or pipes shall be
examined for collapse or reduced diameter at any point. Any shell or pipe,
which is improperly driven or broken or shows partial collapse to such an
extent as to materially decrease its bearing value will be rejected. Rejected
shells or pipes shall be removed and replaced, or a new shell or pipe shall
be driven adjacent to the rejected one. Rejected shells or pipes, which can
not be removed, shall be filled with lean concrete by the Contractor at his
expense.
i) Boring Procedure
The method and equipment of boring generally either the dry method,
wet method, temporary casing method or permanent casing method shall
be one which maintains stability, verticality or batter (as shown on the
Drawing) of the wall and base of borehole by the use of temporary
casing and/or bentonite slurry.
All holes shall be drilled to the tip elevation shown on the Drawings,
unless otherwise specified or approved by the Engineer. Rejected
boreholes shall be filled with lean concrete by contractor at his expense.
407-8
• Reinforcement
The temporary casing of appropriate diameter for locating the pile and
piloting the borehole shall be pitched at the exact locations as given on
the drawings to ensure that the casing when sunk is within the specified
tolerances. The casing shall be sunk to sufficient depth by approved
• Safety of Casing
The contractor shall take all such measures and provide such
strengthening and bracing as is necessary and to the approval of the
engineer to ensure that the temporary casing is not disturbed,
overturned, over-stressed or under-eroded in any condition of
temporary casing shall be such that it will not disturb the freshly cast
concrete and/or permanent lining and/or reinforcement.
After the installation of the casing and the excavation of the shaft is
complete, the casing shall be cutoff at the prescribed elevation and the
reinforcing steel and shaft concrete placed within the portion of the
casing left in place.
407-10
Tests shall be carried out to ensure that the proposed constitution of the
slurry is compatible with the ground water. Proposals for the constitution
and physical properties of the slurry shall include average, minimum and
maximum values. The specific gravity of the slurry shall not be less than
one and three hundredth (1.03) in any case at any time. The contractor
shall use additives where necessary to ensure the satisfactory
functioning of the slurry.
Manufacturers Certificate
A manufacturer's certificate showing the properties of the bentonite
powder shall be delivered to the Engineer for each consignment
delivered to site. Independent tests shall be carried out at laboratory
approved by the Engineer on samples of bentonite frequently.
Tests on Bentonite Slurry
The Contractor shall carry out tests during the course of the piling to
check the physical properties of the bentonite slurry in the works. These
tests shall include, inter-alia, density, viscosity, shear strength and PH
tests. The test apparatus and test methods shall be those given in
"Recommended Practice" Standard by American Petroleum Institute,
New York City, 1957, reference API RP29, Section- I, II and VI.
Should the physical properties of any bentonite slurry deviate outside the
agreed limits, such slurry shall be replaced, irrespective of the number of
time it has been used by new bentonite slurry of correct physical
properties.
The level of the slurry in the bentonite shall be maintained so that the
internal fluid pressure always exceeds the external water pressure.
407-11
Should the excavation reveal any soil stratum below the bottom of a pile
which is, in the opinion of the Engineer, unsuitable for supporting the
loads that will be imposed on it, the Contractor shall remove all such sub
soil stratum to the satisfaction of the Engineer and shall lengthen the pile
if necessary and cost of any such lengthening shall be paid as per this
contract.
The materials from pile excavation shall be disposed so that the same
does not interfere with any part of the permanent works of this project, in
neat and workmanlike manner.
The apparatus and procedure for the Standard Penetration Test shall be
in accordance with the provisions of ASTM D 1586 Penetration Test and
split-barrel sampling of soils and/or ASTM D 1587 thin-walled sampling
of soils, (except insofar as any such provisions may conflict with other
requirements of the contract).
vii) Tolerances
viii) Inspection
After the borehole has reached its final stipulated positions, after the
samples have been taken out, as required by the Engineer, and the
borehole has been completely cleaned of all loose matter and otherwise
made ready to receive the reinforcement and thereafter the concrete, the
contractor shall so inform the Engineer.
The Engineer shall inspect the soil samples and test results thereon,
check the elevation of the bottom of the borehole and the amount and
direction, if any, by which the top of the casing is out of position, or out-
of-plumb having satisfied himself on these and on any other points which
he may consider relevant shall sign permission authorizing the
Contractor to proceed with the placing of the reinforcement. The
Contractor shall under no circumstances proceed with the placing of
reinforcement or with the subsequent concreting without having first
obtained the authority signed separately for each and every borehole by
the Engineer.
The reinforcement for each pile shall be assembled and securely tied by
means of binding wire and by welded reinforcement rings of twenty five
(25) mm diameter bar as shown on the drawings, in such a manner as to
form a rigid cage.
407-13
i) Materials
The Contractor shall submit the detailed proposed additive for approval,
which shall be approved after laboratory trial mix results. The dosing of
retarders shall ensure initial setting time of not less than five (5) hours
corresponding to the ambient temperature at which the concreting is
proposed to be carried out.
The Contractor shall not proceed with the concreting of the pile until the
Engineer gives specific permit to do so after satisfying himself of the:
Prior to the concreting a pile, sample of slurry shall be taken from the
base of the borehole using an approved sampling device and its specific
gravity shall be determined.
The tremie shall be of not less than two hundred and fifty (250) mm
diameter made of water-tight construction. The means of supporting the
tremie shall be such as to permit the free movement of the discharge end
in the concrete in the pile. The tremie pipe shall be fitted with travelling
plug, which shall be placed at the top of the pipe before charging the
tremie pipe with concrete as barrier between the concrete and water or
bentonite slurry, so as to prevent water or bentonite slurry entering the
tube and mixing with the concrete. The tremie shall be carefully lowered
into the borehole so that the end of the tube shall rest at about one
hundred and fifty (150) mm above the bottom of the borehole, with
reinforcement in the borehole, and the hopper end of the tremie tube
shall be filled with concrete as aforesaid. It shall be slightly raised so that
when the concrete reaches the bottom it flows out of the lower end of the
tube, and fills the bottom of the borehole. Thereafter, the rate of
withdrawal of the tremie shall be gradual so as to ensure the end of the
tremie pipe is always one and half (1.5) meters below the top of the
concrete in the borehole. An allowance shall be made for the top five
hundred (500) mm of concrete in borehole during concreting being
unsatisfactory. When the next batch is placed in the hopper the tremie
shall be slightly raised but not out of the concrete at the bottom, until the
batch discharges to the bottom of the upper. This operation shall be
controlled by calculating the volume of concrete required to fill one linear
meter of pile and then by measuring the rate of withdrawal of the tube
corresponding to the volume of the batch in the hopper. The flow shall
then the retarded by lowering the tube. The depth of the concrete in
borehole shall be measured at intervals to keep a constant check that
the tremie pipe bottom is immersed in concrete.
If the bottom of the tremie pipe ceases to be immersed in the body of the
concrete in the pile and the seal is broken, concreting shall cease
immediately and such remedial measures as the Engineer may accept or
direct shall be carried out. The Contractor shall take precautions to ensure
that the concrete is free of voids and shall prevent the entry of water and/or
collapse of soil into concrete. If any soil or other deleterious or extraneous
materials fall into any pile excavation prior to or during concreting, it shall be
removed immediately.
Concreting shall continue until the concrete has reached an elevation
five hundred (500) mm higher than the designated pile cut off level
shown on the drawings, or as otherwise directed by the Engineer.
407-15
The concrete shall be placed in one continuous operation from tip of cut-off
elevation and shall be carried out in such a manner as to avoid segregation.
The method of placing the concrete and the consistency (slump) shall
conform to the requirements of Item 401 or to the satisfaction of the
Engineer.
No shell or pipe shall be filled with concrete until all adjacent shells, pipes or
piles within a radius of three (3) M or five (5) times the pile diameter,
whichever is greater, have been driven to the required resistance.
After a shell or pipe has been filled with concrete, no pile shall be driven
within seven (7) meters thereof until at least seven (7) days have elapsed.
If such entry or collapse should occur, the temporary casing shall be re-
driven before the concrete has set and all defective concrete shall be
removed or the construction of the pile shall be abandoned, in which case
the provision of the clause herein which refers to "Defective Piles" shall
apply.
The withdrawal of the temporary casing shall be carried out before the
adjacent concrete has taken its initial set.
The method and timing of withdrawal must be such as to ensure that the
space between the pile and the surrounding ground shall be filled with
concrete.
For precast concrete piles, the splicing shall be done according to one of the
following methods unless otherwise specified.
407-16
size as that used in the pile shall be welded to the projecting
steel and the necessary formwork shall be placed, care being
taken to prevent leakage along the pile. The concrete shall be of
the same quality as that used in the pile. Just prior to placing
concrete, the top of the pile shall be wetted thoroughly and
covered with a thin coating of neat cement, or other suitable
bonding material to the satisfaction of the Engineer. The forms
shall remain in place not less than seven (7) days. The pile shall
not be driven until the 28-days design strength is reached.
For steel piles shells and pipe, the splicing shall be as under:
If the ordered length of the steel pile, pipe, or shell is insufficient to obtain
the specified bearing value, an extension of same cross-section shall be
spliced to it. Unless otherwise shown on the Drawings, splices shall be
made by butt-welding the entire cross-section to form an integral pile using
the electric arc method. The sections connected shall be properly aligned so
that the axis of the pile will be straight. Piles bent or otherwise injured shall
be rejected.
Concrete piles shall, when approved by the Engineer, be cut off at such a
level that at least five (5) cm of undamaged pile can be embedded in the
structure above. If a pile is damaged below this level, the Contractor shall
repair the pile to the satisfaction of the Engineer. The longitudinal
reinforcement of the piles shall be embedded in the structure above to a
length equal to at least (40) times the diameter of the main reinforcing bars.
The distance from the side of any pile to the nearest edge of the footing
shall not be less than twenty (20) cm.
When the cut-off elevation for a precast concrete pile, steel shell, pipe or for
a cast-in-place concrete pile is below the elevation of the bottom of the pile
cap, the pile may be built up from the butt of the pile to the elevation of the
bottom of the cap by means of a reinforced concrete construction according
to Item 401, if approved by the Engineer.
Cut-offs of structural steel piles shall be made at right angles to the axis of
the pile. The cuts shall be made in clean, straight lines and any irregularity
due to cutting or burning shall be leveled off with deposits of weld metal
prior to placing bearing caps.
407-17
Any pile delivered with defects such as damaged during driving or cast
insitu, placed out of its proper location, incapable or partially capable of
permanently carrying the load which it is intended to carry, driven below the
elevation fixed by the Drawing or by the Engineer, due to the immature
setting of the concrete in the pile or due to caving/collapse of the borehole
fully or partially, or due to any cause of which Engineer shall be sole judge
to determine shall be corrected at the contractor's expense by one of the
following methods approved by the Engineer:-
When a new pile is driven or cast to replace a rejected one, the Contractor,
at his expense, shall enlarge the footing as deemed necessary by the
Engineer.
Test piles which are shown on the Drawings or ordered by the Engineer
shall conform to the requirements for piling as specified and shall be so
located that they may be cut-off and become a part of the completed
structure.
Test piles to be load tested in accordance with Item 407.3.9 shall be driven
in locations determined by the Engineer. These piles shall not be utilized in
the structure unless otherwise directed.
Test piles driven by the Contractor for his own use in determining the
lengths of piles to be furnished may be so located and they may be cut-off
and become a part of the completed structure provided that such test piles
conform to the requirement for piling in these specifications.
407-18
Any pile, which after serving its purpose as a test pile is found unsatisfactory
for utilization in the structure, shall be removed if so ordered by the
Engineer, or if approved by the Engineer it shall be cut-off below the ground
line and footings, but such approval does not in any way relieve the
Contractor of his responsibilities.
Test piles shall generally be driven with the same equipment that is to be
used for driving foundation piles. When required, the ground shall be
excavated to the elevation of the bottom of the footing before the test pile is
driven.
When diesel hammers are to be used for driving end bearing piles, or
friction piles where the bearing capacity shall be checked by pile driving
formulas, the Contractor shall in advance carry out test piling or load tests to
determine the energy developed by the hammer. The Contractor may elect
one of the following methods for the calibration:
Calibration of diesel hammers may not be required if the hammer has been
previously calibrated under soil conditions and for the same size and type of
pile, provided that the calibration data is accepted by the Engineer.
Load tests shall be made by methods approved by the Engineer. The Contractor
shall submit to the Engineer detailed plans of the loading system and apparatus
he intends to use at least three (3) weeks in advance. The apparatus shall be so
constructed as to allow the various increments of the load to be placed gradually
without causing vibration to the test piles. Tension anchor piles if used, shall be
of a design and driven to a depth satisfactory to the Engineer. Steel shells or
piles whose walls are not of adequate strength to withstand the test loading when
empty, shall have the required reinforcement and concrete placed before loading.
The load test shall not be started until the concrete has attained a minimum
compressive strength of ninety five (95) percent of the design twenty eight (28)
days compressive strength. If he so elects, the Contractor may use high early
strength cement in the concrete of the load test pile and the tension piles.
407-19
Suitable approved apparatus for determining accurately the load on the pile
and the settlement of the pile under each increment of load shall be supplied
by the Contractor. The apparatus shall have a working capacity of three
times the design load for the pile being tested. Reference points for
measurement of pile settlement shall be sufficiently away from the test pile
to preclude all possibility of disturbance.
The first load to be applied to the test pile shall be 50%, of the pile design
load and the first increment shall be up to the pile design load by applying
additional loads in three equal increments. A minimum period of 2 hours
shall intervene between the application of each increment, except that no
increment shall be added until a settlement of less than one tenth (0.1) mm
is observed for a 15-minute interval under the previously applied increment.
If there is a question as to whether the test pile will support the test load, the
load increments shall be reduced by fifty (50) percent, at the direction of the
Engineer, in order that a more closely controlled failure curve may be
plotted. The full test load shall remain on the test pile not less than forty
eight (48) hours. The full test load shall then be removed and the permanent
settlement read.
When directed by the Engineer load tests shall then be continued beyond
the double design load in 10-ton increments to failure or a maximum of three
(3) times the design load.
The pile may be considered to have failed when the total permanent
settlement exceeds (6) mm.
When each pile has been cast, the empty bores remaining shall not be
back-filled unless required by the construction procedures and activities
following the completion of piling work.
The Contractor shall keep records of the piles driven or installed. A copy of
the record shall be given to the Engineer within two (2) days after each pile
is driven. The record form to be used shall be approved by the Engineer.
The pile records shall give full information on the following:
407-20
Date of casting (for concrete Soil samples taken from pile boring
piles) and driving. operation and soil test results.
Final set for last 20 blows for every Lengths and diameter of temporary
10 piles and when the Engineer so casing and permanent lining and
requires the penetration along the the elevation of the tip of temporary
whole driven depth shall be casing and of permanent lining.
recorded.
407-21
On completion of the piling for each structure, the Contractor shall deliver to
the Engineer a drawing recording the exact location and the final depth (tip
elevation) of all piles.
The contractor shall carry out confirmatory boring at bridge site at locations
indicated by the Engineer.
Boring shall be carried out with ASTM D 1586 Penetration Test and Split
barrel sampling of soil. Additionally, when undisturbed sampling is required,
the procedure shall conform to ASTM D 1587, Thin Walled sampling of soil.
Diameter of boreholes shall be twenty (20) centimeters cased through out its
length and shall be down to the designated elevation. In-situ standard
penetration test shall be carried out at one and half (1.5) meters interval
from designated top elevation to the bottom of the hole. Undisturbed
samples shall be taken from substratum. If clay is encountered, undisturbed
samples will be taken at interval of three (3) meters.
At least two borings are required at each bridge site. The boring shall extend
to a depth of at least three (3) meters below the pile tip elevation as
indicated in the drawings.
407.4.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number of linear meters of piles,
completed and accepted, measured from the pile tip elevation to the bottom
of pile caps, footings or bottom of concrete superstructure in the case of
pile bents. In case the bottom of pile caps or footing or bottom of pile bent is
above N.S.L and method of fabrication is such that the work above N.S.L is
done as that of column, the same shall be measured as concrete and steel
for column. No allowance shall be made for cut-offs or the required length of
concrete or reinforcement steel placed into the concrete structure as called
for on the drawings. Any additional pile lengths that may be necessary to
suit the Contractor's method of operation or for any other reason shall not be
included in the measurements.
• For cast-in-situ piles, helical and vertical steel will be measured in Tons.
Pile casing where ever provided will be measured in linear meters.
Measurement shall be made for permanently placed pile casing as
shown on drawings. If the Contractor likes to use temporary casing for
the convenience of preparing of boreholes, the same shall not be
measured whether left at site or withdrawn after completing the
boreholes.
• Test piles when ordered by the Engineer, whether or not utilized as
service piles in the structure shall not be included in the above
measurements. Accepted test piles will be measured separately as the
number of linear meters.
407-22
• Pile shoes when called for on the Drawings or by the Engineer shall be
measured by the number accepted in place.
• Splicing of piles if not shown on the drawings will not be allowed except
that the length of reinforcement is to exceed 12 meter in which case the
splicing will not be measured or paid directly but the cost thereof shall
be considered as included in the unit price for piling.
407.4.2 Payment
• For cost-in-situ piles, rate per linear meter will include all items except
for helical and vertical reinforcement, which will be paid as per steel
reinforcement item 404.
• For pre cast piles, the cast of steel shall be included in the rate per
linear mater.
Pile casing will be paid at the contract unit price per linear meter for pile
casing.
Load tests shall be paid for at the contract unit price for pile load Tests,
either one and half (1.5) times or two (2) times the design load. The unit
price for test loading to three (3) times the design load shall include the total
load test with all load increments as described in Item 407.3.9.
Payment for tubular steel piles left in place shall include the cost of the
concrete core of the specified class of concrete and the steel reinforcement
of the said concrete core.
The quantity to be paid for confirmatory boring shall be the number of linear
meters of the boring completed and accepted.
407-23
408.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of furnishing, driving, cutting off and removal, if
required, of sheet piles in accordance with the Drawings, or as designated
by the Engineer. Sheet piles for cofferdams in connection with foundations
for structures shall be included in the unit price for Item 107-Structural
Excavation. Sheet piling shall be a separate pay item only when stated in
the Bill of Quantities.
Steel Sheet piles shall be of the type and weight indicated on the Drawings.
The steel shall conform to AASHTO M 223 or ASTM A 572. Permanent
steel sheet piles shall be coated with red lead paint conforming to AASHTO
M 72 as instructed by the Engineer.
408.2.4 Bracing
For temporary sheet piling like cofferdams for excavations, the Contractor
shall be solely responsible for the design and construction of the bracing.
The Drawings shall have the approval of the Engineer, but such approval
does not in any way relieve the Contractor of his responsibility.
408-1
408.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
408.3.1 Installation
Timber and concrete sheet piles shall be sharpened at their lowest ends.
All sheet piles shall be driven to the elevation shown on the Drawings or as
directed by the Engineer. Where it is impossible to drive to the elevation
shown on the Drawings due to sub-surface conditions, the piles may be
stopped at a higher elevation with the written permission of the Engineer.
However, before granting such permission the Engineer shall investigate to
ascertain that the Contractor has adequate equipment for the required
driving and that the piles can not be driven to the elevation shown with the
proper use of this equipment.
408.3.2 Removal
Temporary sheet piling shall be removed or cut off at the stream bed or the
original ground when directed by the Engineer.
In case when the Engineer orders sheet piling to be left in place for erosion
protection, the Contractor and the Engineer shall agree on an equitable
price.
408.4.1 Measurement
When stated as a separate pay item in the Bill of Quantities, sheet piling will
be measured by the square meters of sheet piling or as a Lump Sum as
shown on the Drawings or directed in writing by the Engineer, complete in
place and accepted. Measurement of piling, which has been delivered
according to Drawings and cannot be driven to the directed elevation
because of subsurface conditions shall be measured to the driven elevation.
408.4.2 Payment
Payment of Timber Sheet Piles, Concrete Sheet Piles and Steel Sheet Piles
as determined under measurement shall be made at the contract unit price
per square meter or as a Lump Sum for the pay items listed below and
shown in the Bill of Quantities. Such prices and payment shall be
considered full compensation for all materials, labour, equipment, tools
paint, bolts, Wales and incidentals necessary to complete the item. All
necessary bracings, whether shown on the drawings or not, shall be
included in the contract price.
408-2
The under mentioned pay items and prices shall not apply to the equitable
rate for sheet piling left in place for erosion protection according to Item
408.3.2.
409.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of performing all operations in connection with the
construction of a well to be used as a foundation for a pier or abutment. The
work shall be comprised of five separate main operations: 1) the casting of
well kerb in proper position. 2) the erection of well steening by stages 3) the
sinking of the erected kerb and well steening to the required elevation. 4)
the proper plugging of the well, and 5) the construction of the transom slab
all in accordance with specifications, and the Drawings or as directed by the
Engineer.
Reinforcing steel shall conform to the requirements under item 404 Steel
Reinforcement.
409.2.4 Brickwork
Brick work shall conform to the requirements as specified under Item 410-
Brick Masonry of these specifications.
Fill sand shall consist of natural sand free from deleterious materials subject
to the approval of the Engineer and as specified and shown on the
Drawings.
The number of units, the sizes, etc., of all equipment shall be adequate to
ensure completion of the work within the time specified in the Contract.
409-1
No equipment shall be removed from the Site without the written approval of
the Engineer.
(a) Notice of Rolling and Fabrication The contractor shall give ample
advance notice to the Engineer of the beginning of the work at the mill and
shop, so that inspection may be provided. No material shall be rolled or
fabricated before the Engineer has been notified where the orders have
been placed.
(b) Facilities for Inspection The Contractor shall furnish all facilities for the
Inspection of materials and workmanship in the mill and shop, and inspector
shall be allowed free access to the necessary parts of the premises.
(c) Inspection of Fabricated Work at Site The Engineer may waive shop
inspection and make complete inspection of all fabricated work upon its
delivery at the Site of structure. All structural steel works shall conform to
the applicable ASTM requirements as shown under item 413. In case these
requirements are not met, the material thus fabricated shall be rejected.
(d) Handling Members The field assembling of the component parts of the
structure shall be done by the use of twisting, bending or otherwise
deforming the metal. No members slightly bent or twisted shall be put in
place until their defects are corrected and any members seriously damaged
in handling will be rejected.
(e) Finish of Structural Steel Work The workmanship and finish shall be first
class and equal to the best practice in modern bridge shops. Shearing and
clipping shall be done neatly and accurately and all portion of the work
exposed to view shall be neatly finished.
(a) Casting Well Kerbs The cutting edge of the well kerb will be structural
steel pre-fabricated and supplied in segments convenient for Site assembly
by bolting together as per lines and dimensions shown on the Drawings.
The segments of the cutting edge shall be interchangeable. The fitting
together shall be checked at the site of fabrication work by the assembly of
at least two complete cutting edges, formed of segments chosen at random
before these are accepted for dispatch to the site of work. None of the steel
work is to be painted and no surface preparation is called for other than the
removal of the rust and loose adhering mill scale.
Reinforcing steel work in the cutting edge will be properly bolted to the steel
work and placed and assembled as shown on the Drawings.
409-2
Structural concrete for the cutting edge will be of the required strength and
shall be finished to the form and dimensions shown on the Drawings.
(b) Well Steening Well steening shall be made either of brick work in (1:3)
cement mortar or Portland cement concrete of the required strength and of
the form and dimensions as shown on the Drawings.
Reinforcing steel work will continue from the cutting edge into the well
steening with spacers made of structural steel work consisting of mild steel
plates of the size and dimension as shown on the Drawings.
(c) Well Sinking: Well sinking includes all operations required to sink the
well in position and to the required elevation.
(1) Positioning: Each well kerb shall be correctly positioned in place and
approved by the Engineer before commencement of further work.
(2) Support: Well kerb shall be adequately supported to prevent shift or tilt
during the initial operation and on excavation and sinking whether the well
has been started on made up ground or in water in excavation.
(3) Excavation of Sinking: The soil from inside the well shall be removed by
mechanical grabbing or by other devices as approved by the Engineer. The
accuracy of the sinking will be the responsibility of the Contractor.
(4) Dewatering: The Contractor will be required to pump out the water from
inside the wells in such a way as shall be approved by the Engineer; but
notwithstanding any dewatering aid that the Contractor may use to assist in
the operation of sinking the wells, the safety of plant and labour will remain
the responsibility of the Contractor.
(5) Limits of Tilt and Shift: The limit of departure from true vertical position
of any well shall not exceed one unit measured horizontally in a vertical
distance of sixty units.
The maximum horizontal displacement of any well away from its correct
position shall not exceed twenty (20) cm.
(6) Correcting Tilt etc: It will be entirely the responsibility of the Contractor to
keep the tilt and shift within the specified tolerances. If the above limits are
exceeded, the Contractor will be required to adopt measures to overcome
the adverse affects of such shifts and tilts. In any case maximum pressure
at the base of foundations after accounting for all shifts and tilts shall remain
within the specified limits. The measures taken shall be allowed only after its
approval has been received from the Engineer.
(7) Kentledge: The use of rails and other heavy weights is permissible in well
sinking and in correcting error of tilt and horizontal displacement. But the
Contractor must take care not to damage the well in the process; and in any
case he must obtain the approval of the Engineer for his proposed method.
409-3
(8) Limits of Well Sinking: Each and every well shall be sunk to the level
indicated on the Drawings. But in no case shall the Contractor stop well
sinking unless he has first obtained the approval of the Engineer.
(d) Plugging of Well: When the well has reached the final elevation to which
it is to sink and has been approved by the Engineer, the bottom of the well
will be plugged by the depositing concrete of the required strength.
(1) Concrete Under Water: The concrete deposited under water shall have
ten (10) percent excess cement. To prevent segregation it shall be
carefully placed in the final position by means of a dump bucket or other
approved method and shall not be disturbed after being deposited. The
concrete shall be placed under the supervision of the Engineer.
(e) Sand Filling: When the well bottom has been plugged, the well hole will
be filled with sand as specified and shown on Drawings. The sand shall be
free from deleterious materials.
(f) Transom Slab: When the well bottom has been plugged, the well top will
be provided with a transom slab made of structural concrete of required
strength, and reinforcing steel work, all according to the lines, dimensions
and form shown on the Drawings.
The Contractor will also be required to obtain three samples of the natural
soil at the elevation at which the well kerb has been stopped and another
sample three(3) meters below that elevation before he is allowed to plug the
well.
409.5.1 Measurement
a) General
For the various items of work constructed under this Item, measurement
shall be made as narrated under the respective items. The quantity to be
paid for shall be the original plan quantity measured as provided for
respective items, except where changes have been made by the Engineer
and order has been given in writing.
409-4
b) Structural Steel
The quantity of structural steel entering into and becoming a part of the
completed structure, and accepted by the Engineer shall be the computed
weight in metric tons of this material entering into the completed structure of
item of work.
The weights of the rolled shapes, bars, plates and pipe railing shall be
computed on the basis of nominal weight as given in the manufacturer's
hand books, using the dimensions shown on the drawings. The weight shall
be computed on the basis of dimensions and ordered overall lengths for all
structural shapes. No deductions from the computed weight of rolled steel
shall be made for caps, clips, sheared edges, punching borings, drillings,
milling or planing and no allowance shall be made for the weight of weld
metal or for overrun in weight.
c) Reinforcing Steel
For well kerb, steening and transom slab reinforcing steel shall be
measured and paid for according to the requirements of Item 404.
d) Structural Concrete
For well kerb, steening, plugging of well and transom slab construction,
concrete shall be measured and paid for according to the requirements
under Item 401. The unit rate includes the cost of ten (10) percent extra
cement to be used where required.
e) Brick Work
In (1:3) cement mortar for steening shall be measured and paid for
according to the requirements of Item 410.
f) Well Sinking
For any item of work carried out under this head, measurement shall be
made per linear meter of twin or single well of specified external diameter,
sunk below the bed level shown on the Drawings. The unit of measurement
shall be one linear meter. The unit rate for sinking twin or single well shall
include excavation, pumping, supports, bracings, kentledge, tilt correction
soil samples, all according to the requirements given in Item 409.3.3 and
409.4.
g) Fill Sand
The well hole shall be measured as the volume of well hole required to be
filled. The unit of measurement shall be in cubic meters.
409-5
409.5.2 Payment
Payment will be made in accordance with the unit price in the Bill of
Quantities for the various items in accordance with the specifications and
shall constitute full compensation for furnishing all material, equipment, and
labour and for performing all operations necessary to complete the work.
Provision delivery of materials to Site, handling and storage and all
incidentals shall be included in unit prices for various items.
409 d Brickwork CM
409-6
ITEM 410 BRICK MASONRY
410.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of furnishing all materials, equipment and labour
required for constructing brickwork as shown on the drawings and in
accordance with these specifications.
Portland cement shall conform to the requirements set forth under item
401.2.1.
410.2.2 Sand
Sand for mortar used in brickwork shall conform to the requirement for the
fine aggregate specified in item 401.2.2 except that the grading shall be
according to AASHTO M 45.
410.2.3 Water
The water used in the preparation of mortar shall be free from objectionable
quantities of silt, organic matter, salts or other impurities. No water shall be
used without the approval in writing of the Engineer.
410.2.4 Mortar
The mortar for all brickwork shall consist of one (1) part of Portland cement
to three (3) parts of sand by volume and of sufficient water to produce the
proper consistency for the intended use.
410.2.5 Bricks
The size of the bricks shall be standard size (9"x4 1/2"x3")22.86 cm x 11.43
cm x 7.62 cm. They shall be well-burnt without being vitrified. They shall be
of uniform colour, regular in shape and size with sharp and square corners
and parallel faces. They must be homogeneous in texture and emit a clear
ringing sound when struck. They shall be free from flaws and cracks. They
shall not absorb more than 1/6th of their weight of water after being soaked
for one hour, and shall show no signs of efflorescence on drying.
Compressive strength shall not be less than 140.62 kg/sq.cm (2000 psi).
410-1
410.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
Methods and equipment used for mixing mortar shall be such that each
ingredient entering into the mortar shall be subject to the approval of the
Engineer. If a mixer is used, it shall be of approved design and the mixing
time after all the ingredients are in the mixer, except the full amount of
water, shall be not less than two minutes.
Mortar shall be mixed only in sufficient quantities for immediate use. All
mortar not used within thirty(30) minutes after addition of the water to the
mix shall be wasted. Retempering of mortar will not be allowed. Mixing
troughs and pans shall be thoroughly cleaned and washed at the end of
each day's work.
Brick work shall not be placed during heavy or prolonged rain to wash the
mortar from the bricks. Mortar already spread, diluted by rain shall be
removed and replaced before restoring the work.
All bricks shall be skillfully laid with level courses, uniform joints, square
corners, plumb verticals and true surface, except where otherwise shown on
the Drawings.
All walls and abutments shall be provided with weep holes. Unless
otherwise shown on the Drawings or directed by the Engineer, the weep
holes shall be placed at the lowest points where free outlets can be
obtained and shall be spaced not more than two (2) meters center to center.
410.3.3 Curing
All brickwork shall be cured for at least seven (7) days after laying. The
curing method shall be to the satisfaction of the Engineer.
410-2
410.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
410.4.1 Measurement
410.4.2 Payment
The quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price listed below and shown in the Bill of Quantities, which prices and
payment shall be full compensation for furnishing all materials, labour,
equipment and incidentals for performing all the work involved under this
item:
410 Brickwork CM
410-3
ITEM 411 RANDUM AND DRESSED UNCOURSED STONE MASONRY
411.1 DESCRIPTION
The item shall consist of Random and Dressed uncoursed Stone Masonry
with or without mortar. Dimensions of such masonry may vary as per
drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
411.2.1 Stone
Random or dressed stone shall be of approved quality, sound and durable,
free from segregation's, seams, cracks and other structural defects or
imperfection tending to reduce its resistance to weather. It shall be free from
rounded or weathered surfaces.
411.2.2 Mortar
Mortar for laying stone and pointing shall be composed of one part of
Portland cement and four parts of sand unless otherwise shown on the
drawings. Portland cement shall meet the requirements of AASHTO M-85
and sand shall meet the requirements of AASHTO M-45. Water used in
preparation of mortar shall conform to the requirement set forth under item
401.2.7.
Individual stones shall have a thickness of not less than twenty (20) cms
and a width of at least one and a half (1.1/2) times the thickness and length
of atleast one and a half (1.1/2) times their width.
For "A-Class" Masonry, Stones shall be dressed to exact sizes and shapes
and cut to lay on beds with top and bottom truly parallel. Hallow beds shall
not be permitted. Beds of face stone shall be fine finished for a depth of not
less than thirty (30) centimeters. Vertical joints of face stone shall be fine
finished and full to the square for a depth of not less than twenty five (25)
centimeters.
Exposed surfaces of face stone shall be according to the plans, with edges
pitched to true lines and exact batter, chisel drafts four (4) centimeters wide
shall be cut at all exterior corners.
411-1
Stones for B-Class Stone Masonry shall be roughly squared on joints, beds
and faces. Selected stones, roughly squared pitch to line shall be used at all
angles and ends of wall.
411.3.3 Stretchers
Stretcher shall have a width of bed not less than one and a half (1.1/2) times
their thickness, and length of bed not less than twice nor more than three
and half (3.1/2) times their thickness but in no case less than ninety
centimeters. Stone masonry in cement mortar shall be cured for at least
seven (7) days.
411.3.4 Headers
Header, placed in each course, shall have width not less than one and a
half (1.1/2) times their thickness. In walls having thickness of 1.2 meters or
less, the headers shall extend entirely through the wall. In walls of greater
thickness, the length of headers shall be not less than two and a half (2.1/2)
times their thickness when the course is forty five (45) centimeters or less in
height, and not less than 1.2 meters in courses of greater height. Header
shall bond with the core or backing not less than thirty (30) centimeters.
Header shall hold in the heart of the wall spaced not further a part than 2.5
meters center to center. There shall be atleast one header to every two
stretchers.
411.3.5 Cores and Backing
Core and backing shall consist either of roughly bedded and jointed headers
and stretchers, as specified above or concrete as may be specified. When
stone is used for cores of backing, at least one-half (1.1/2) of the stone shall
be of the same size and character as the face stone and with parallel ends.
No course shall be less than twenty (20) centimeters thick. Concrete used
for cores and backing shall conform to the requirements specified in
Item 401. The headers and stretchers in walls, having a thickness of one
meter or less shall have a width or length equal to the full thickness of the
wall. No backing will be allowed.
411.4.1 Measurement
The quantity of stone masonry to be paid for shall be the number of cubic
meters measured in the completed work and the limiting dimensions shall
not exceed than those shown on the drawings or fixed in writing by the
Engineer.
411-2
Class C or lean concrete shall be measured separately as per dimensions
shown on the drawings or as directed by the Engineer. No separate
measurement shall be made for stuck pointing which is deemed to be
included in stone masonry with mortar, however roll pointing shall be
measured separately in square meter.
411.4.2 Payment
411-3
ITEM 412 DRESSED COURSED STONE MASONRY
412.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of Dressed coursed stone masonry with mortar.
Dimensions of such masonry may vary as per drawings or as directed by
the Engineer.
The individual stones shall be large and well proportioned. They shall not be
less than twenty (20) nor more than fifty (50) cms in thickness. The
thickness of courses, if varied, shall diminish regularly from bottom to top of
wall. The size of ring stones in arches shall be as shown on the plans.
412.2.2 Mortar
Mortar shall conform to the requirement set forth under Item 411.2.2.
For the purpose of this specification the surface finishes of stone are
defined as follows:-
Smooth-finished: Having a surface in which the variations from the pitch line
do not exceed 0.15 cm.
Rough-finished: Having a surface in which the variations from the pitch line
do not exceed 1.25 cm.
Scrabbled: Having a surface in which the variations from the pitch line do
not exceed two (2) cm.
Stones shall be dressed to exact sizes and shapes before being laid and
shall be cut to lie on their natural beds with top and bottom truly parallel.
Hollow beds will not be permitted. The bottom bed shall be the full size of
the stone and no stone shall have an overhanging top. In rock-face
construction the face side of any stone shall not present an undercut
contour adjacent to its bottom axis giving a top-heavy, unstable appearance
when laid.
412-1
Beds of face stone shall be fine-finished for a depth of not less than thirty
(30) cm.
Vertical joints of face stone shall be fine-finished and full to the square for a
depth of not less than fifteen (15) cm.
Exposed surfaces of the face stone shall be given the surface finish
indicated on the plans, with edges pitched to true lines and exact batter,
Chisel drafts four (4) cm wide shall be cut at all exterior corners. Face stone
forming the starling or nosing of piers shall be rough-finished unless
otherwise specified.
Holes for stone hooks shall not be permitted to show in exposed surfaces.
412.3.3 Stretchers
Stretchers shall have a width of bed of not less than one and half (1.1/2)
times their thickness. They shall have a length of bed not less than twice nor
more than three and half (3.1/2) times their thickness, and not less than
ninety (90) cm.
412.3.4 Headers
Headers shall be placed in each course and shall have a width of not less
than one and half (1.1/2) times their thickness. In walls having a thickness of
1.2 meters or less, the headers shall extend entirely through the wall. In
walls of greater thickness, the length of headers shall be not less than two
and half (2.1/2) times their thickness when the course is forty five (45) cm.
or less in height, and not less than 1.2 meters in courses of greater height.
Headers shall bond with the core or backing not less than thirty (30) cm.
Headers shall hold in the heart of the wall the same size shown in the face
and shall be spaced not further apart than 2.5 meters center to center.
There shall be at least one header to every two stretchers.
Cores and backing shall consist either of roughly bedded and jointed
headers and stretchers, as specified above, or concrete, as may be
specified.
When stone is used for cores of backing, at least one-half of the stone shall
be of the same size and character as the face stone, and with parallel ends.
No course shall be less than twenty (20) cm. thick.
Concrete used for cores and backing shall conform to the requirements
specified in Item 401.
The headers and stretchers in walls having a thickness of one meter or less
shall have a width or length equal to the full thickness of the wall. No
backing will be allowed.
412-2
412.3.6 Mixing Mortar
(a) General
Stone shall not be dropped upon, or slid over the wall, nor will hammering,
rolling, or turning of stones on the wall be allowed. They shall be carefully
set without jarring the stone already laid and they shall be handled with a
Lewis or other appliance that will not cause disfigurement.
Each stone shall be cleaned and thoroughly saturated with water before
being set and the bed, which is to receive it, shall be cleaned and well
moistened. All stones shall be well bedded in freshly made mortar and
settled in place with a suitable wooden maul before the setting of the mortar.
Whenever possible, the face joints which can not be so pointed shall be
prepared for pointing by raking them out to a depth of five (5) cm. before the
mortar has set. The face surfaces of stones shall not be smeared with the
mortar forced out of the joints or that used in pointing. No pinning up of
stones with spawls will be permitted in beds.
Joints and beds shall be not less than one (1) cm. nor more than one and
quarter (1.1/4) cm. in thickness and the thickness of the joint or bed shall be
uniform throughout.
The stone in any one course shall be placed so as to form bonds of not less
than thirty (30) cm. with the stones of adjoining courses. Headers shall be
placed over stretchers and, in general, the headers of each course shall
equally divide the spaces between the headers of adjoining courses, but no
headers shall be placed over a joint and no joint shall be made over a
header.
412-3
(c) Stone Backing and Cores
Stone backing shall be laid in the same manner as specified above for face
stone, with headers interlocking with face headers when the thickness of the
wall will permit. Backing shall be laid to break joints with the face stone.
Stone cores shall be laid in full mortar beds so as to bond not less than
thirty (30) cm. with face and backing stone and with each other. Bed joints in
cores and backing shall not exceed 4.5 cm. and vertical joints shall not
exceed ten (10) cm. in thickness.
Stone cores and backing shall be carried up to the approximate level of the
face course before the succeeding course is started.
412.3.9 Resetting
In case any stone is moved or the joint broken, the stone shall be taken up,
the mortar thoroughly cleaned from bed and joints, and the stone reset in
fresh mortar.
Where required, coping stone, stone in the wings of abutments, and stone in
piers shall be secured with wrought-iron cramps or dowels as indicated on
the plans.
Dowel holes shall be drilled through each stone before the stone is placed
and, after it is in place, such dowel holes shall be extended by drilling into
the underlying course not less than fifteen (15) cm.
Cramps and dowels shall be set in lead, care being taken to completely fill
the surrounding spaces with the molten metal.
412-4
412.3.11 Copings
Stones for copings of wall, pier, and abutment bridge seats shall be carefully
selected and fully dimensioned stones. On piers, not more than two stones
shall be used to make up the entire width of coping. The copings of
abutment bridge seats shall be of sufficient width to extend at least ten (10)
cm. under the back-wall. Each step forming the coping of wingwall shall be
formed by a single stone, which shall overlap the stone forming the step
immediately below it at least thirty (30) cm.
Tops of copings shall be given a bevel cut at least five (5) cm. wide, and
beds, bevel cuts, and tops shall be fine-finished. The vertical joints shall be
smooth-finished and the coping shall be laid with joints not more than
0.6 cm in thickness. The undersides of projecting copings, preferably, shall
have a drip bead.
The number of courses and the depth of voussoirs shall be as shown on the
plans. Voussoirs shall be placed in the order indicated, shall be full size
throughout, dressed true to template, and shall have bond not less than the
thickness of the stone. Beds and joints shall be fine-finished and mortar
joints shall not exceed two (2) cm. in thickness. Exposed surfaces of the
intrados and arch ring shall be given the surface finish indicated on the
plans.
412.3.13 Pointing
Pointing shall not be done in freezing weather nor when the stone contains
frost.
Joints not pointed at the time the stone is laid shall be thoroughly wet with
clean water and filled with mortar after proper raking. The mortar shall be
well driven into the joints and finished with an approved pointing tool. The
wall shall be kept wet while pointing is being done and in hot or dry weather
the pointed masonry shall be protected from the sun and kept wet for a
period of at least 3 days after completion.
After the pointing is completed and the mortar set, the wall shall be
thoroughly cleaned and left in a neat and workmanlike condition.
412-5
412.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
412.4.1 Measurement
412.4.2 Payment
The quantities determined as provided above shall be paid for at the
contract unit price respectively for each of the particular pay items listed
below and shown in the B.O.Q., which price and payment shall be full
compensation for labour, materials, tools, equipment and incidentals to
complete the item as described above. Dowels and cramps shall be
considered as subsidiary item.
412-6
ITEM 413 STEEL STRUCTURES
413.1 DESCRIPTION
413.1.1 General
This work shall consist of steel structures and the steel structure portions of
composite structures, constructed in conformity with the lines, grades and
dimensions shown on the drawings or as established by the Engineer.
The work will include all labour, materials and equipment required to furnish,
fabricate, erect and paint structural metals called for in these Specifications
or as shown on the plans. Structural metals will include rivet, welding,
special and alloy steels, metallic electrodes, steel forging, and castings, and
iron castings. This work will also include any incidental metal construction
not otherwise provided for, all in accordance with these specifications,
Drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
413.1.2 Drawings
The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer working Drawings for steel
structures for approval prior to use in construction. Such working Drawings
shall be submitted sufficiently in advance of the start of the related work to
allow time for review by the Engineer and correction by the Contractor of the
Drawings without delaying the work. Such time shall be proportional to the
complexity of the work, but in no case shall such time be less than six (6)
weeks.
The working Drawings shall show details of any permitted options proposed
in the work, details for connections not dimensioned on the plans, the
direction of rolling the plates where specific orientation is required, the
sequence of shop and field assembly and erection, welding sequences and
procedures, the location of all butt welded splices on a layout Drawing of the
entire structure, the location of any temporary supports that are to be used
and the vertical alignment of the girder at each stage of the erection.
Substantiating camber calculations shall be submitted with the working
Drawings.
413.1.3 Inspection
Structural steel will be inspected at the fabrication site. The Contractor shall
notify the Engineer when materials have been delivered to the fabrication
site and shall give the Engineer at least ten (10) days notice before
commencing the fabrication of any structural steel.
413-1
The Contractor shall furnish to the Engineer a copy of all mill orders,
certified mill test reports and a Certificate of Compliance for all structural
steel to be used in the work other than steel which is to be used under the
provisions in Item 413.2.6, "Unidentified Stock Material". Certified mill test
reports for steels with specific impact values shall include, in addition to
other test results, the results of Charpy V-notch impact tests. When fine
grain steel is specified, the test report shall include the grain size. Copies of
mill orders shall be furnished at the time, orders are placed with the
manufacturer. Certified mill test reports and Certificates of Compliance shall
be furnished prior to start of fabrication of material covered by these reports.
The Certificates of Compliance shall be signed by the manufacturer and
shall certify to the Engineer the specifications to which the material has
been manufactured and tested, and that the material is in conformance with
said specifications and test requirements.
Material to be used shall be made available to the Engineer so that the each
piece can be examined. The Engineer shall have free access at all times to
any portion of the fabrication site where said material is stored or where
work on said material is being performed.
413.1.4 Shipping, Handling and Storing Materials
Members weighing more than two and one half (2.5) metric tons shall have
the weight marked thereon.
In handling and shipping of the steel work, every care shall be taken to
avoid bending, scraping, or overstressing the pieces. All pieces bent or
otherwise injured will be rejected.
413.1.5 Falsework
Falsework used for the erection of structural steel shall conform to the
provisions in Item 402, "Falsework and Centering for Bridges", except that
dead loads shall consist of the weight of the structural steel and any other
portions of the structures which are supported by the falsework.
413-2
Falsework and forms supporting the concrete work on steel structures shall
be constructed so that any loads applied to girder webs shall be applied
within fifteen (15) cms. of a flange or stiffener and shall be distributed in a
manner that will not produce local distortion of the web. Temporary struts
and ties shall be provided as necessary to resist lateral loads applied to the
girder flanges and to prevent appreciable relative vertical movement
between the edge of deck form and the adjacent steel girders.
Unless otherwise noted on the plans, structural steel girders have been
designed for continuity in supporting girder dead load. The Contractor may
at his option erect the girders in such a manner that the girder continuity for
dead load is or is not as assumed in design. Furnishing and erecting the
girders shall be subject to the requirements in this Item.
If erection procedures are to be used which will provide the designed girder
continuity for dead load, members with field joints shall be pre-assembled in
a no-load condition in a horizontal or an upright positions.
If erection procedures are to be used which will result in steel girders not
attaining the continuity for dead load assumed in design, the Contractor
shall furnish to the Engineer for review a statement of steel erection
procedures with calculations, in sufficient detail to substantiate that girder
capacity and geometry will be correct.
If erection procedures are to be used which will result in steel girders not
attaining the continuity for dead load assumed in design, the structure shall,
after erection, have a load carrying capacity at least equal to the designed
structure shown on the plans. The Contractor may increase the cross-
sectional area or change the steel grades to provide the specified load
carrying capacity subject to approval by the Engineer. Any additional steel
or higher strength steels required to accommodate the method of erection
selected shall be considered to be made for the convenience of the
Contractor and no additional payment will be made therefor.
413.2.1 Description
413-3
Structural steel designed on the plans as high strength low alloy structural
steel shall conform to the following:-
Coiled steel plate shall not be used for the fabrication of flanges, eyebars
and hanger plates nor for flanges and eyebars.
All structural steel precut prior to arrival at the fabrication site shall be cut so
that the plate orientation complies with the requirements of Item 413.3.3,
"Orientation of Plates".
413-4
All structural steel plate used for the fabrication of tension flanges, eyebars
and hanger plates and for splice plates of tension flanges and eyebars shall
meet the longitudinal Charpy V-notch impact value requirements specified
herein. Sampling procedures shall conform to the provisions in ASTM
Designation; A 673. The H (Heat) frequency of testing shall be used for
structural steels conforming to ASTM Designations: A 36, A 441, A 572 and
A 588. The P (Piece) frequency of testing shall be used for structural steel
conforming to ASTM Designation: A 514. Charpy V-notch impact values
shall be determined in accordance with ASTM Designation: E 23.
A 36 .................................................... 15 at 40 deg. F.
(2.07 at 4.45 deg. C)
A 588*
2" and under in thickness ........................ 15 at 40 deg. F.
(50.8mm & under in thickness)................ (2.07 at 4.45 deg. C)
A 588*
Over 2" to 4" in thickness ........................ 20 at 40 deg. F.
(Over 50.8mm to 101.6mm in thickness) ..... (2.77 at 4.45 deg. C)
A 514
2.1/2 & under in thickness ....................... 25 at 0 deg. F.
(63.5mm & under in thickness)................ (3.46 at-17.8 deg. C)
A 514
Over 2.1/2" to 4" in thickness .................. 35 at 0 deg. F.
(Over 63.5mm to 101.6mm in thickness) .... (4.84 at-17.8 deg.C)
*If the yield point of the material exceeds 65,000 psi (4569.5 Kg/Sq.cm), the
temperature for the CVN impact value for acceptability shall be reduced to
15 deg. F. (-9.45 deg. C) for each increment of 10,000 psi (703 Kg/Sq.cm)
above 65,000 psi (4569.5 Kg/Sq.cm).
413-5
Tensile Strength Elongation Reduction of Area
(Min.)
Unless otherwise specified or shown on the plans, all structural steel plates,
shapes and bars shall conform to ASTM Designation: A 36.
At the option of the Contractor, girder flange plates shown on the plans may
be increased in thickness, and may be increased in length provided that the
change does not involve a decrease in detailed thickness of any portion of
said plates. For continuous girders, increases in length of girder flange
plates, which involve changes in locations of butt welds between different
thickness of flange plates, shall be approved in writing by the Engineer prior
to fabrication.
When stud type shear connectors longer than twenty (20) cms. are to be
used, they may consist of two (2) or more shorter studs of the type shown
on the plans connected together with full penetration welds.
Rolled shapes may be substituted for the welded sections, and welded
sections may be substituted for the rolled shapes shown on the plans,
provided that the shapes and sections to be substituted comply with the
following provisions:
a) The depth, width and average thickness shall be at least equal to those
for the shape or section shown on the plans.
b) For welded sections, the flanges shall be welded to the web with
continuous fillet welds on each side of the web. All welding shall conform
to the provisions in Item 413.2.7, "Welding".
413.2.3 Castings
Steel, gray iron, and malleable iron castings shall be provided with adequate
continuous fillets cast in place in all re-entrant angles. The radius of
curvature of the exposed surface of a fillet shall define the size of the fillet.
The size of fillets shall not be less than one-half (1/2) of the thickness of the
thinnest adjoined member nor less than one and one quarter (1.25) cms.
The dimensions of the finished casting shall not be less than the specified.
Castings shall not be more than seven and half (7.5) percent overweight.
Large castings shall be suspended and hammered over their entire area. No
cracks, flaws or other defects shall appear after such hammering.
413-6
413.2.4 Bearing Pads
Unless otherwise directed by the Engineer, the materials for metal bearing
shall conform to the following requirements:
The deformation of the sheet packing under a load of three hundred and fifty
(350) Kg/sq.cm shall be not more than fifteen (15) percent. When tested
between planed steel plates under a load of fifty five (55) Kg/sq.cm, the
sheet packing shall show a static coefficient of friction less than 0.4 after
1.00-1.25 cm. movements.
413-7
When unidentified stock material is proposed for use the Engineer may, at
his discretion, select random test specimens from each piece. The number
of such test specimens shall be entirely at the discretion of the Engineer.
Test specimens shall be cut and machined in accordance with ASTM
requirements. Test specimens from unidentified stock material, including
those required for retest, shall be furnished, machined and got tested by the
Contractor from approved laboratory at his expense.
Fabrication shall not be commenced until the materials involved have been
approved by the Engineer.
Not more than fourteen (14) metric tons of unidentified stock material may
be used on one contract.
413.2.7 Welding
Galvanizing will not be required for stainless steel, mono metal and similar
corrosion resistant parts.
413-8
413.2.9 Cleaning
All steel works shall be blast cleaned after fabrication in accordance with the
Drawings and to the satisfaction of the Engineer. Steel work which is to be
in contact with concrete shall be, after fabrication, wire brushed and cleaned
to remove all loose rust, dirt and grease.
413.2.10 Painting
The shop or prime paint coat for metal structures including edges, nuts,
bolts, etc. shall be a factory mixed red lead Ready-Mixed Paint, AASHTO
M-72.
Red lead pigment in the dry form or as a paste in oil shall conform to ASTM
D 83. The ninety seven (97) % grade shall be specified for dry pigment.
The first field coat shall be a red lead paint as specified for the shop coat,
tinted light brown as required with lamp black in an amount not to exceed 30
gms. per litre of linseed oil.
Steel shall be painted with one shop or prime coat and with not less than
two field coats. The colour shall be as specified or determined by the
Engineer. Coats shall be different in colour to permit detection of incomplete
application.
e) Weather Conditions
Paint shall not be applied when the steel is damp, the air is misty, or when
in the opinion of the Engineer, conditions are otherwise unsatisfactory for
the work.
413-9
f) Application
Painting shall be done in a neat manner and may be applied with hand
brushes or by spraying (without the addition of a thinner). Aluminum paint
shall preferably be applied by spraying. By either method the coating
applied shall be smoothly and uniformly spread so that no excess paint will
collect at any point.
g) Inaccessible Surfaces
All surfaces which will be inaccessible after fabrication or erection, with the
exception of contact surfaces shall prior to assembly receive the full
protective treatment specified for the component of the structure including
any additional priming coat and finishing coats, which for accessible
surfaces would be applied subsequent to erection.
The cleaning and painting of all structural steel parts shall be subject to
detailed inspection and approval of the Engineer. Contractor shall be
responsible for all defects or faults and the correction thereof at his own
expense during fabrication, erection or subsequently discovered before or
during the Period of Maintenance.
413.3.1 General
The Contractor shall submit as soon as possible to the Engineer for his prior
approval, full details of their proposed fabrication and erection procedures
together with details and calculations of any temporary works which the
Contractor proposes to install for the purposes of erection of the structural
steel work. Workmanship and finish shall be equal to the best general
practice in modern bridge shops.
Steel plates for flanges, eyebars, hangar plates, and splice plates for
flanges and eyebars shall be cut and fabricated so that the primary direction
of rolling is parallel to the direction of the main tensile or compressive stress
in the member.
413-10
413.3.4 Cutting with Torch
Surface of bearing and base plates and other metal bearing surfaces that
are to come into contact with each other or with ground concrete surfaces or
with asbestos sheet packing shall be flat to within three tenths (0.3) cm. and
to within one and six tenths (1.6) mm tolerance overall. Surface of bearing
and base plates and other metal bearing surfaces that are to come in
contact with preformed fabric pads, elastomeric bearing pads or Portland
cement mortar shall be flat to within three (3) mm tolerance in thirty (30) cm
and to within five (5) mm tolerance overall.
Steel slabs where not in contact with other metal bearing surfaces may be
hot-straightened in lieu of machining at the option of the Contractor,
provided the above tolerances are met.
a) They shall be so taken from the stock plates that the direction of bending
will be at right angles to the direction of rolling.
b) The radius of bend, measured from the concave face of the metal shall
be as specified in the Manual of Steel Construction published by the
AISC or equivalent.
c) Before bending, the corners of the plate shall be rounded to a radius one
and five tenths (1.5) mm throughout that portion of the plate at which the
bending is to occur. If a shorter radius is essential, the plates shall be
bent hot.
Floor beams, stringers and girders having end connection angles shall be
built to exact length back to back of connection angles. If end connections
are faced, the finished thickness of the angle shall not be less than that
shown on the detailed Drawings.
413-11
413.3.9 Finished Members
Finished members shall be true to line and free from twists, bends and open
joints.
Screw threads shall make close fits in the nuts and shall be American
Standard Form, except that for pin ends of diameters greater than 3.81 cm
(1.1/2 inches) they shall be made with six (6) threads to 2.54 cms (1 inch).
Bolt holes shall be either punched full size, drilled full size, sub-punched and
reamed, or sub-drilled and reamed.
413-12
The finished holes shall be cylindrical, perpendicular to the plane of the
connection and shall not be more than one and half (1.5) mm larger than the
nominal diameter of the bolt. Holes shall be clean cut, without torn or ragged
edges. All burns, fins, sharp edges and hole irregularities which would
prevent solid seating of the parts shall be removed.
All holes punched full size, sub-punched, or sub-drilled shall be located with
sufficient accuracy so that after assembling (before any reaming is done) a
cylindrical pin three (3.0) mm smaller in diameter than the nominal size of
the punched, sub-punched, or sub-drilled hole may be passed through the
hole without drifting in at least seventy five (75) percent of the holes for each
connection. All holes shall pass a pin four and a half (4.5) mm smaller in
diameter than the nominal size of the hole.
a) Punching
Holes sub-punched for reaming shall be sub-punched decimal six five (0.65)
cm less in diameter than that of the finished hole.
b) Drilling
Drilling full size shall be done with the parts assembled on to a steel
template with hardened bushings or may be performed with gang drill
equipment if approved by the Engineer. The Engineer may require a proof
assembly to check the fit of major field connections.
Where bolt holes are sub-drilled for reaming, they shall be sub-drilled
decimal six five (0.65) cm less in diameter than that of the finished hole.
Drilling through templates shall be performed only after the templates have
been accurately placed and firmly clamped or bolted.
If members are drilled while assembled, the parts shall be held securely
together while drilling is being done.
Stock drilling of plate parts with precision gang drills will be permitted if all
parts are firmly clamed during drilling and if the drill bits remain
perpendicular to the work during drilling operations.
413-13
c) Reaming
Reaming shall be done after the pieces forming a built-up member are
assembled and are firmly bolted together so that the surfaces are in close
contact or after templates are securely located over the member. The pieces
shall be taken apart before bolting, if necessary, and shavings removed. If it
is necessary to take the members apart for shipping or handling, the pieces
reamed together shall be so marked in order that they may be reassembled
in the same position. Reamed parts shall not be interchanged.
Holes through assembled material that are to be reamed shall not consist of
both sub-punched or sub-drilled holes and holes punched or drilled full size.
Pins shall be accurately turned to the dimensions shown on the plans and
shall be straight, smooth, and free from flaws. The final surface shall be
produced by a finished cut.
Pins and rollers shall be forged and heat-treated in accordance with the
designation shown on the plans.
If pins are larger than twenty three (23) cms. in diameter, a hole not less
than four decimal seven five (4.75) cms. in diameter shall be bored full
length along the axis after the forging has been allowed to cool to a
temperature below the critical range under suitable conditions to prevent
injury by too rapid cooling, and before being annealed.
Holes for pins shall be bored true to the specified diameter, smooth and
straight, at right angels to the axis of the member and parallel with each
other unless otherwise required. The final surface shall be produced by a
finishing cut.
Machined surfaces for pins and holes shall be coated with a rust inhibitor
that can be easily removed.
The diameter of the holes for pins shall not exceed that of the pins by more
than half (0.5) mm for pins thirteen (13) cm. or less in diameter, or decimal
eight (0.8) mm. for larger pins.
413-14
Holes for pins in built-up members shall be bored after assembly of the
member, or may be bored prior to assembly, provided procedures approved
in advance by the Engineer are followed which result in such holes being
positioned to the same degree of accuracy as would be obtained if the holes
were bored after assembly.
Anchor bolts shall be set in round holes drilled or cast in the masonry. The
size and length of bolts shall be as indicated on the Plans.
When anchor bolt holes are drilled, a template shall be used to locate the
bolts accurately and permit reinforcing steel bars to be shifted clear of holes
before pouring concrete to prevent cutting these bars during drilling. The
drilling shall be done prior to the erection of structural steel.
Bolts set in holes drilled or cast in the masonry shall have the portion below
the bridge seat swedged, and the drilled or cast holes shall have a diameter
at least one 1 inch (25 mm) in excess of the diameter of the bolt.
Anchor bolts for steel stringers for all bridges (weathering steel and/or
painted steel) shall be A-36 galvanized steel and shall not be painted. The
nuts and washers used on anchor bolts shall also be galvanized and shall
not be painted.
Holes cast in the masonry for swedged bolts shall be formed with removable
round sleeves sealed at their lower ends, and they shall be completely
removed after the hole is cast. During cold weather, effective methods shall
be used to prevent the freezing of water in anchor bolt holes.
After anchor bolts are finally and correctly positioned, the holes around them
shall be completely filled. No grouting of anchor bolts will be permitted until
all structural steel is set in its final position. After the masonry plates or
shoes are set, the space between the bolts and the round holes through
fixed plates or shoes shall also be filled with the same material. Slotted
holes in expansion devices shall remain unfilled to allow free movement.
Mortar used for grouting anchor bolts shall be composed in accordance with
one of the following:
413-15
a) One part Portland Cement and one part mortar sand by dry loose
volume.
b) Non-shrink grout shall be used when specified. The grout shall have a
minimum compressive strength of 350 Kg/Sq.cm (5000 psi) in seven
days when tested in accordance with AASHTO T 106 except that the
cube moulds shall remain intact with a top firmly attached throughout the
curing period. The non-shrink grout shall have a minimum expansion of
0.0 percent after seven days when tested in accordance with AASHTO
T 160.
When air temperature is below four (4) degree C, the Contractor shall
provide adequate cold weather protection to maintain a minimum air
temperature of four (4) degree C around surface of mortar for a period of
three days.
If anchor bolts are mortared in place during cold weather, the bolts and
surrounding masonry shall be kept at a minimum temperature of four (4)
degree C for a period of three days.
When mortar filling is used for bolts inserted in holes drilled or cast in the
masonry, the holes shall first be checked for depth by inserting and
withdrawing the bolts. They shall then be partially filled with mortar into
which the bolts shall be forced by uniform pressure or light blows from a
hammer (flogging and running will not be permitted) so that excess mortar is
pushed out at the top of the hole. The excess mortar shall be removed and
finished off flush with the top surfaces of the masonry, masonry plate or
shoe as the case may be.
Bolts shall be set to project approximately half (0.5) inch (13 mm) above the
nut and shall be threaded to approximately half (0.5) inch (13 mm) below the
nut in its final position.
Nuts shall be drawn up tight except over the slotted holes of expansion
devices in which case they shall be positioned half (0.5) inch (13 mm) clear
of the moveable parts. All anchor bolt threads shall be burred with a sharp
pointed tool at the top of the nut. When nuts are set half (0.5) inch (13 mm)
clear of moveable parts, the bolt thread shall also be burred immediately
under the nut to prevent it becoming tight against the moveable parts.
Rockers or expansion plates with slotted holes shall be set with the proper
tilt or offset as determined by the temperature prevailing at the time and so
that they will be in their midway position at twenty (20) degree C or as
indicated on the Drawings.
a) General
The Contractor shall submit as soon as possible to the Engineer for his prior
approval full details of their proposed erection procedure together with
details and calculations of any temporary works which the Contractor
proposes to install for the purposes of the erection of the structural steel
work.
413-16
b) Storage at Site and Handling
The structural steelwork after arrival on Site shall be laid out in the area
allocated by the Contractor. It shall be unloaded by crane, or other
appliance, and carefully stacked on timbers and subsequently handled for
erection in such a manner that no distortion or damage is done to the
various members. No steelwork shall be stored directly on the ground.
c) Erection Generally
The works on site shall comply with the requirements stated in these
specifications and the Contractor shall be responsible for providing all
materials, skilled and unskilled labour, plant, equipment, supervision and all
other things necessary for the erection of the steelwork on the Site as
specified in the Contract Documents and shown on the Drawings.
The Contractor shall ensure that suitable plant and equipment of adequate
capacity is used on the Site.
d) Supervision
During erection the work shall be securely bolted or otherwise fastened and
where necessary temporarily braced, so as to make adequate provision for
all erection stresses and conditions, including those due to the erection
equipment and its operation.
f) Temporary Connections
The Contractor shall provide and shall be deemed to have included in his
rates and prices for providing a suitable range of steel erection packs, shims
and wedges to be used as necessary to ensure the accurate adjustment of
line and level of the steelwork erected on Site and for the temporary works
referred to in the previous sub-item.
413-17
h) Setting Out
i) Work on Site
1) The steelwork after erection and fixing complete shall comply with the
following maximum permissible dimensional tolerances:
iii) Departure from the true alignment of any plate girder relative to the
associated setting out geometry shown on the Drawing ... five (5)
mm.
iv) Departure from the true vertical centre line or any girder
throughout its length of height .... five (5) mm.
v) Departure from the specified level of the top of any beam .... five
(5) mm.
j) Site Connections
The Contractor shall make all site connections in accordance with the
details shown on the Contractor's detailed fabrication drawings, which shall
comply with the requirements of these Specifications.
Any additional holes required in the steelwork (which must first be approved
by the Engineer) shall be drilled on the Site. Burning holes in the steelwork
will not be permitted.
k) Contact Surfaces
All steel to steel contact surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned and painted
with two coats of primer as described in clause No 413.2.10 in this
Specification. The surfaces shall be brought together while the second
coating is still tacky.
413-18
l) Site Welding
Site welding will only be permitted where shown on the Drawings and with
prior consent of the Engineer.
m) Inspection of Site Works
All parts of the steel-work will be subject to inspection by the Engineer. The
Contractor shall afford all facilities and assistance for inspection during the
progress of the works.
The Contractor shall whenever possible, give the Engineer at least twenty
four hours notice of when materials or parts of the steelwork will be ready for
inspection.
o) Inspection
2) All parts of the Works done on the Site will be subject to inspection by
the Engineer. The Contractor shall afford all facilities and assistance for
inspection as aforesaid during the progress of the Site Works and until
the completion of the contract.
413-19
3) Materials or workmanship or parts rejected on inspection as aforesaid
shall be remedied or replaced by the Contractor without extra charge and
without affecting the time for completion of the whole or any part of the
Works.
413.4.1 Measurement
The pay item shall include fabrication, erection and protective coating
(painting). The measurement shall be the total weight of the finished
member comprising plates, rolled sections, shear connectors, stiffeners,
cleats, packs, splice plates and all incidentals, necessary to complete the
item, without allowance for tolerance for rolling margin and other permissible
deviations from standard weights, and excluding the weights of welds, fillets,
bolts, nuts, washers and protective coatings. No deductions shall be made
for notches, holes and the like each less than 0.01 square meter measured
in area.
d) Testing.
413-21
DRAINAGE
AND
EROSION WORKS
DRAINAGE AND EROSION WORKS
The Contractor shall so schedule the construction of drainage works that the
discharge of runoff from rain or other sources, both during and after construction,
is properly provided for.
These requirements shall be met without additional payment and all costs thereof
shall be included in the bid prices for any items under the contract.
Drainage structures shown on the Drawings and their estimated total quantities
are not to be taken as final. The Engineer, who will inform the Contractor of them
in writing, will decide the final quantities.
500-1
ITEM 501 REINFORCED CONCRETE PIPE CULVERTS
501 DESCRIPTION
The work shall include the furnishing and laying of the pipe, and the
construction of such joints and connection to other pipes, catch basins, or
other structures as may be required to complete the work as shown on the
Drawings or as required by the Engineer.
The work shall also include the removal and disposal of existing culverts
and structures except such portions as may be required or permitted by the
Engineer to be left in place.
The Engineer reserves the right to inspect and test the pipe after its delivery
to the work. Injurious defects revealed subsequent to acceptance of pipe
and prior to its installation in the work shall be cause for rejection.
The Contractor shall not order and deliver the pipes for any work until the
Engineer has approved a list of sizes and lengths.
501.2 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS
The pipes shall meet the requirements of the AASHTO M-170, class II and
IV as called for in the Bill of Quantities.
Cement, sand and water shall conform to the requirements specified in item
401-Concrete, except that the grading of sand shall meet the requirements
of AASHTO M-45.
Rubber ring gaskets for rigid pipe, if required, shall conform to the
requirements of AASHTO M-198.
501-1
501.3.1 Dimensions and Strength Test Requirements
Shell thickness, the quantity of circular reinforcement and the strength per
linear meter for the various sizes of pipe shall conform to the minimum
requirements listed in related Table as per AASHTO M-170 latest addition.
501.3.2 Reinforcement
501.3.3 Joints
The ends of reinforced concrete culvert pipes shall be the ogee or spigot
and socket types and of such design that when laid the joints shall form a
continuous conduit with a smooth and uniform interior surface.
501.3.4 Tolerances
Variations in internal diameter and wall thickness shall not exceed the limit
specified in relevant “Table for Allowable Tolerances” for reinforced
concrete pipes in these Specifications.
501.3.5 Absorption
The water absorption of the concrete pipe shall not exceed eight (8) per
cent of the dry weight as determined in AASHTO designation T-33.
501.3.6 Curing
501-2
i) Steam Curing
Pipes shall be placed in a curing chamber, free from outside draughts, and
cured in a moist atmosphere, maintained at a temperature between thirty
eight (38) and fifty four (54) degree C by the injection of steam for a period
of not less than twenty four (24) hours or, when necessary, for such
additional time as may be needed to enable the pipe to meet the strength
requirements. When a curing chamber is not available, pipes may be
placed in an enclosure of canvas or other closely woven material and
subjected to saturated steam at the temperature and for the time specified
above. The enclosure shall be so erected as to allow full circulation of
steam around the entire pipe. The interior surfaces of the curing room or
canvas jackets and the surfaces of the pipes shall be entirely moist at all
times.
The sides and top of each pipe may be covered with heavy Hessian or other
suitable material, saturated with water before applying and kept saturated
with water at a temperature of not less than twenty one (21) degree C for
seventy two (72) hours, or such additional time as may be necessary to
meet the strength requirements. The ends of the pipes shall be so
enclosed as to prevent the free circulation of air through or around the pipe.
If the temperature of the water is less than twenty one (21) degree C, the
curing period shall be increased as may be necessary to meet the strength
requirements. The ends of the pipes shall be so enclosed as to prevent the
free circulation of air through or around the pipe.
All pipes shall be substantially free from fractures, large or deep cracks,
honeycombing, open texture, spells and surface roughness. The planes of
the ends of the pipe shall be perpendicular to the longitudinal axis.
501.3.8 Inspection
The quality of all materials, the process of manufacture and the finished
pipes shall be subject to inspection, test and approval at the place of
manufacture. The Contractor shall make the necessary arrangements with
the manufacturer to set aside in a separate area all pipes for which he
desires approval.
501-3
i) Test Specimens
Pipes for the purpose of tests shall be furnished free of cost by the
Contractor and will be selected at random by the Engineer. The number of
sections required for test will not be more than two (2) percent except that at
least one of every size will be selected. Pipes for tests shall conform to
these specifications.
If the manufacturer has equipment for conducting the crushing strength test,
the Contractor shall make the necessary arrangements to have the required
tests conducted in the presence of the Inspector designated by the
Engineer. If the testing facilities are not available at the point of
manufacture, the Contractor shall make the necessary arrangements for
furnishing & testing, at no cost to the Employer, the pipe sections selected
by the Inspector to a laboratory approved by the Engineer.
iii) Re-test
501.3.9 Rejection
iv) Spalls deeper than one half the depth of the joint or extending
more than ten (10) cm around the circumference. If spalls not
deeper than one half of the joint or extending not more than ten
(10) cm around the circumference exist in more than ten (10) per
cent of the pipes, however, the defective pipes shall be rejected.
501-4
v) Misplaced reinforcement already exposed or verified by
checking with an approved concrete reinforcement cover meter.
501.4.1 Excavation
Where in the opinion of the Engineer, the natural foundation soil is such as
to require stabilization, such material shall be replaced by a layer of suitable
material. Where an unsuitable material (peat, mulch, etc.) is encountered at
or below invert elevation during excavation, the necessary subsurface
exploration and analysis shall be made and corrective treatment shall be as
directed by the Engineer.
The pipe shall be laid carefully, bell up-grade, ends fully and closely jointed,
and true to the elevations and grades given. Proper facilities shall be
provided for lowering the sections when they are to be placed in a trench.
Each section shall be securely attached to the adjoining sections by the
method specified for the type of joint used. All joints, unless otherwise
specified, shall be filled with stiff mortar composed of one part Portland
cement and two parts sand. The mortar shall be placed so as to form a
durable, watertight joint around the whole circumference of the pipe. After
each section of pipe is laid and before the succeeding section is laid the
lower portion of the bell shall be plastered thoroughly on the inside with
mortar to such depth as to bring the inner surface of the abutting pipe flush
and even. After the section is laid, the remainder of the joint shall be filled
with mortar and sufficient additional mortar shall be used to form a bead
around the outside of the joint. The inside of the joint shall then be wiped
and finished smooth. After the initial set, the mortar on the outside shall be
protected from the air and sun with a cover of thoroughly wetted earth or
burlap. Any pipe, which is not true in alignment or which shows any undue
settlement after being laid, or is damaged, shall be taken up and relaid or
replaced without extra payment. All joints, including any connections, shall
be capable of transferring the required shear across the point.
501-5
501.4.3 Backfilling
After the pipe has been installed and the mortar joints sufficiently set,
granular material (sand) and / or selected material from roadway excavation
or borrow shall be placed alongside the pipes in layers not exceeding twenty
(20) cms in depth and compacted to minimum ninety (90) percent of the
maximum dry density determined as per AASHTO T-191 Method, so that on
each side of the pipe there shall be thoroughly compacted material at least
as wide as the external diameter of the pipe except insofar as undisturbed
material obtrudes upon this width. Each layer shall be moistened, if dry, and
then compacted by tamping with mechanical hammers or by hand tamping
with heavy iron tampers to the densities as specified under item 108.3.1 -
Formation of Embankment with Common Material. This method of filling and
compacting shall be continued until the embankment has reached an
elevation of twenty (20) cms above the top of the pipe. When construction
calls for placing a high embankment over the pipes, special instructions
regarding the method of back filling shall be given by the Engineer.
501.5 Headwalls
Where indicated on the Drawings, the ends of the pipe culverts shall be
protected by concrete or masonry headwalls constructed as shown on the
Drawings. When headwalls are constructed, the ends of the pipe shall be
neatly cutoff flush with the outside face of the headwalls.
501.6.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number of linear meters of pipe
placed, completed and accepted.
Payment shall be made separately under Item 502 for furnishing and
installing granular material or concrete in the bed of the culvert as shown on
the Drawings.
501.6.2 Payment
The quantities, as measured above, shall be paid for at the contract unit
price respectively, for each of the particular pay items listed below in the
BOQ. Payment shall be full compensation for furnishing and placing all
materials including mortar for joints, for excavating trenches and backfilling,
and for all other costs necessary or usual to the proper completion of the
work prescribed in this item. Headwalls, wing-walls and aprons together with
the bedding for the concrete pipe culvert, will be measured and paid for
separately.
501-6
Pay Item Description Unit of
No. Measurement
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
AASHTO M 170, Class II Reinforced
Concrete pipe.
501-7
ITEM 502 BEDDING OR ENCASEMENT OF CONCRETE PIPE
CULVERTS
502.1 DESCRIPTION
Granular material shall be sand or selected sandy soil all of which passes a
3/8 inch (9.5 mm) sieve and not more than fifteen (15) percent passes No.
200 sieve.
502.2.2 Concrete
The bedding material as specified in Items 502.2.1 and 502.2.2 shall be laid
to the dimensions shown on the drawings for the types specified or directed
by the Engineer; the top surface of which shall be accurately shaped by
template to fit the surface of the concrete pipe culvert for at least twenty (20)
percent of its outside diameter.
502.4.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for shall be the number of cubic meters of granular
material, or concrete Class B, placed and accepted.
502-1
502.4.2 Payment
Quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at the contract unit
price, for each of the particular pay items listed below, which prices and
payment shall be full compensation for furnishing and placing all materials,
labour, equipment, tools and incidental required for completion of the work
prescribed in this item.
502-2
ITEM 503 UNDERDRAIN
503.1 DESCRIPTION
This pipe shall conform to the requirements of AASHTO M 176 for the
specified diameters.
D15 (Sub-base)
------------------------------------- shall be less than 5
D85 (Surrounding Earth)
Trenches shall be excavated to the width, line and grade as shown in the
Drawings; Unless shown otherwise on the Drawings, the depth shall vary
from 0.7 to 1.4 meters below the bottom of a gutter or ditch when underdrain
is situated under a gutter or ditch, and to depths required for proper
drainage, as determined by the Engineer. A bed of granular backfill, ten
(10) cm thick, shall be spread, and compacted in the bottom of the trench
throughout its entire length.
The pipe shall be embedded firmly in the bedding material, bells upgrade,
ends fully entered in the adjacent bells and spot mortared to provide for
centering of the pipe, but the joint shall not be closed to allow infiltration of
water.
503-1
Perforated pipe shall be laid with the perforated length of the pipe on its
underside.
After the pipe has been placed and approved by the Engineer, granular
backfill as specified in Item 503.2.3 shall be placed around the drain for a
thickness of at least thirty (30) cm and care shall be taken that no pipe is
displaced. The upper portion of the trench shall then be filled with approved
fine soil selected from structural, common or borrow excavation. All filling
material shall be thoroughly compacted, to the satisfaction of the Engineer.
503.4.1 Measurement
503.4.2 Payment
503-2
ITEM 504 HEADWALLS, WING-WALLS, PARAPETS, APPROACH
SLABS, APRONS AND SIPHON INLETS/OUTLETS
504.1 DESCRIPTION
504.2.1 Formwork
504.2.3 Concrete
504.2.4 Brickwork
504.3.1 Excavation
504-1
504.3.2 Granular Backfill
504.3.3 Formwork
Formwork shall be supplied and fixed in the positions required for the
concrete to be cast as shown on the Drawings and shall be erected and
removed as directed by the Engineer.
Steel reinforcement shall be furnished, bent and fixed where shown on the
Drawings. Furnishing, bending and fixing shall be in accordance with Item
404.
504.3.5 Concrete
504.3.6 Brickwork
504.4.1 Measurement
The formwork in place and accepted shall not be measured for payment and
shall be deemed to have been paid under other items.
Steel reinforcement in place and accepted shall be measured as specified in
Item 404.
504-2
Brickwork in place and accepted shall be measured as specified in
Item 410.
504.4.2 Payment
Excavation and Backfill shall be paid for under different Item of 107 as the
case may be.
The formwork in place and accepted shall not be paid and shall be deemed
to have been paid under other items.
Concrete in place and accepted shall be paid for as specified in Item 401,
as per concrete class specified.
Granular backfill in place and accepted shall be paid for as specified in Item
107.
Stone work in place and accepted shall be paid as specified in item 412.
504-3
ITEM 505 MANHOLES
505.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of the furnishing and erecting pre-cast or cast in situ
concrete manholes of sizes shown in drawings with the necessary frames
and covers constructed in accordance with these specifications and the
specifications for the other work items involved and in conformity with the
dimensions, lines, elevations and design shown in the Drawings.
Metal units shall conform to the dimensions shown on the Drawings and to
the following requirements for the designated materials.
505-1
Galvanizing, where specified for these units, shall conform to the
requirements of AASHTO M 111.
505.2.4 Mortar
Mortar shall be composed of one part Portland cement and two parts of fine
aggregate, by volume unless otherwise specified and sufficient water to
make the mortar of such consistency that it can be handled easily and
spread with a trowel. Aggregate for mortar shall conform to Item 401.2.2.
505.2.5 Concrete
In case of cast in situ concrete manholes, concrete shall be of Class A
unless otherwise shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer,
and shall conform to the requirements prescribed for that particular class of
concrete in Item 401. Forms of approved quality shall be used to give
reasonable fair finish from inside, while rough form work may be allowed for
outside finish. All other specifications shall be followed as per item 401.
505.3.1 Excavation
505.3.2 Backfill
505.3.3 Concrete
Bending and fixing of steel shall conform to the requirements of Item 404.
During erection of the units outside of the manhole shall be finished smooth
and the joints flushed full with mortar.
505-2
505.3.6 Connections
Metal frames shall be set on full mortar beds or otherwise secured as shown
on the Drawings and the frames, covers, and gratings shall be accurately
set true to the line and elevation required to fit the adjoining surface as
approved by the Engineer.
505.3.8 Cleaning
505.4.1 Measurement
505-3
505.4.2 Payment
The quantities measured as provided above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price respectively, for each of the pay items listed below that is shown
in the Bill of Quantities, which prices and payment shall be full
compensation for furnishing and placing all materials, and for all other costs
necessary or usual to the proper completion of the work prescribed in this
item.
Excavation and backfill shall be measured and paid for as specified under
Item 107 or 108, as the case may be.
505-4
ITEM 506 DROP INLETS AND CATCH BASINS
506.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of constructing concrete catch basins, and drop
inlets including the furnishing of metal frames, grates and lids, and the
necessary excavation and backfill in accordance with these specifications
and the specifications for other work items involved and in conformity with
the dimensions, elevations and design shown on the Drawings.
Steel frames, grates and lids shall conform to the requirements of AASHTO
M-105.
506.2.2 Concrete
506.2.3 Masonry
Excavation and backfill shall conform to the requirements of Item 107 or 108
as the case may be.
506-1
506.3.3 Connections
Inlet and outlet tile, sewer pipe and conduit for connections with such
structures shall be of the same size, type and class as the tile, sewer pipe,
and conduit with which connections are made and shall conform to the
pertinent requirements therefor.
Pipe placed in concrete for inlet or outlet connections shall extend from the
inside surface of the walls and beyond the outside surface of the walls a
minimum distance of forty five (45) centimeters distance to allow for
connections with conduits or sewers, and the concrete shall be carefully
constructed around them so as to prevent leakage around their outer
surface.
All frames shall be set on full mortar beds or otherwise secured as shown
on the Drawings. Grates and lids shall be fitted or secured to the frames so
that rocking or chattering will be eliminated.
The frames, grates and lids shall be accurately set so that the complete
installation will be at the correct elevation required to fit the adjoining
surface, the grates and lids shall not be in place while the adjoining concrete
is struck-off and finished.
506.3.5 Cleaning
All catch basins and drop inlets shall be thoroughly cleaned of any
accumulations of silt, debris, or foreign matter of any kind, and shall be kept
clear of such accumulations until the final acceptance of the work.
506.4.1 Measurement
Granular backfill in place and accepted shall be measured and paid for as
specified in Item 107.
507.1 DESCRIPTION
507.2.1 General
507.2.2 Wire
All wire shall be a good commercial quality of steel and size as per
Drawings coated with a prime western speller or equal (AASHTO M 120)
applied at a rate of not less than 0.8 ounces per square foot (0.25 Kg/Sq. M)
of uncoated wire.
Uniformity of coating shall withstand ten (10) one-minute dips by the Preece
Test in accordance with AASHTO T-66. “Uniformity of Coating by the
Preece Test (Copper Sulphate Dip) on Zinc Coated (Galvanized) Iron or
Steel Articles”. Wire mesh shall withstand 220 hours of exposure before
failure by rusting of any part when subjected to a salt spray test in
accordance with ASTM B 117.
The tensile strength of the wire shall be in the range of four thousand
(4,000) to six thousand (6000) kg. / sq. cm. and shall have an elasticity to
permit elongation of the mesh equivalent to a minimum of ten (10) % without
reducing the gauge or tensile strength of the wire.
507-1
The minimum size of the wire used in fabrication of the gabion baskets shall
be as follows:-
Diameter US Steel
mm Wire Gauge
507.2.3 Fabrication
When the gabion length exceeds its width, it shall have securely tied
diaphragms connected at all edges to form individual cells of equal length
and width. Diaphragms shall be of the same material and manufacture as
specified above for the gabions.
All the characteristics, values and figures given in the above specifications
are subject to the tolerance of plus or minus five (5) percent.
507.2.4 Rock Fill
Fill for gabions shall consist of hard, durable rock pieces that will not
deteriorate when submerged in water or exposed to severe weather
conditions. Rock pieces shall be generally uniformly graded in sizes
ranging from ten (10) cm to twenty (20) cm. Filled gabions shall have a
minimum density of one thousand three hundred sixty (1,360) kg per cubic
meter. Void spaces shall be evenly distributed and shall not exceed a
maximum of thirty (30) percent.
The rock shall meet the requirements of AASHTO M 63 except that the
Sodium Sulphate Soundness Loss shall not exceed nine (9) % after five (5)
cycles.
507-2
507.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
Before the rock fill is placed the gabions shall be stretched in such manner
as will permit proper shape, alignment and compaction of fill.
Rock fill for exposed faces of gabions walls shall be carefully selected for
uniformity or size, and the pieces shall be hand placed to provide a neat
appearance as approved by the Engineer.
507.4.1 Measurement
i) Wire Mesh
The galvanized steel wire mesh furnished placed and accepted shall be the
theoretical number of kilograms calculated from the weight per square meter
of mesh certified by the manufacturer and approved by the Engineer. The
area of mesh to be measured shall be the net area of the Gabion in position.
507.4.2 Payment
507-3
ITEM 508 BRICK PAVING
508.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of one or more layers of bricks laid over thin layer of
spread sand and the joints filled with sand with suitable bonding, over
prepared shoulder or embankment slopes.
508.2.1 Bricks
508.2.2 Sand
Sand used in this work for bed or joints shall be medium to fine sand.
508.3.1 Shoulder
These shall be cut and dressed to dense slopes according to specified line
and grade as per Item 108, or as directed by the Engineer before
commencement of this item.
508.3.3 Stacking of Bricks
The bricks shall be delivered at site in stacks of ten courses high and two
bricks thick for the convenience of proper inspection.
A thin layer of sand, at least 1” (25 mm) in thickness, shall be spread over
dressed shoulder or slope to facilitate neat dressing of bricks. The bricks
shall be laid closely packed in parallel rows transverse to the center line
and/or as directed by the Engineer at site. The bricks shall be laid on edge,
in one (1) or two (2) courses as called for in the plans. If more than one (1)
course is to be laid the joints in the successive courses will be staggered.
Each course shall be properly rolled and joints filled with sand or approved
local soil before laying the next course.
508-1
508.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
508.4.1 Measurement
Brick paving when laid and finished to the required thickness and grade line
shall be measured by in superficial area. The unit of measurement will be
square meter.
508.4.2 Payment
508-2
ITEM 509 RIPRAP AND REINFORCED CONCRETE SLOPE
PROTECTION
509.1 DESCRIPTION
This work consists of furnishing and placing a protective covering of erosion
resistant material as riprap or reinforced concrete slope protection on the
locations shown on the plans for slopes or pier foundation protection. The
work shall be done in accordance with the specifications and conformity with
the lines, grades, thickness and typical cross-sections shown on the plans.
The areas to receive riprap or slope protection of any kind shall be dressed
smooth to the slopes or shapes called for on the plans and shall be free
from stumps, organic matter, or waste material. A filter blanket should be
provided where it is anticipated that there may be migration of fines through
the riprap. Toe trench and/or filter blanket is to be constructed, as directed
by the Engineer.
All materials, regardless of type or kind, shall be placed as per lines and
levels called for on the Drawings.
509.2.1 Stones
Stone for riprap shall consist of field stone or rough unhewn quarry stone as
nearly rectangular in section as is practical, except that riprap of Class A
shall consist of round natural stones. The stones shall be sound, tough,
durable, dense, resistant to the action of air and water, and suitable in all
respects for the purpose intended. Samples of the stone to be used shall
be submitted to and approved by the Engineer before any stone is placed.
The minimum apparent specific gravity shall be two and half (2.5) and water
absorption shall not exceed six (6) percent for stones to be used in riprap.
The stone shall not have an abrasion loss greater than forty five (45)
percent when subjected to five hundred (500) revolutions in a Loss Angeles
Abrasion test.
Stones for riprap shall be one of the following classes as shown on the
Drawings or determined by the Engineer:
509-1
Sound pieces of broken concrete obtained from the removal of bridges
culverts, and other structures may be substituted for stone upon approval by
the Engineer.
Where: D15 and D85 are the particle diameters corresponding to fifteen
(15) percent and eighty five (85) percent respectively, passing (by weight) in
a grain size analysis.
Steel reinforcement shall be furnished, bent and fixed where shown on the
drawings. Furnishing, bending and fixing shall be in accordance with
Item 404.
509.2.6 Concrete
509.2.7 Water
Water for concrete and mortar of ratio 1:3 shall conform to Item 401.2.7.
509.3.1 Excavation
The bed for the riprap shall be excavated to the required depths and
compacted, trimmed and shaped to the entire satisfaction of the Engineer or
as shown on the plans.
509-2
The riprap shall be set in a toe trench as shown on the Drawings. The toe
trench shall be filled with stone of the same class as the one specified for
the riprap, unless otherwise specified. All toe trenches and excavations shall
be approved by the Engineer with firm sub-grade or base prior to placement
of stones. Stones shall be placed so as to provide minimum of voids.
Larger stones shall be placed in the toe trench and on the outside surface of
the slope.
509.3.2 Placing
Stones placed below water line shall be distributed so that the minimum
thickness of the riprap is not less than that specified.
Stones above the water line shall be placed by hand. They shall be laid
with close, broken joints and shall be firmly bedded into the slope and
against the adjoining stones. The stones shall be laid perpendicular to the
slope with ends in contact. The riprap shall be thoroughly compacted as
construction progresses and the finished surface shall present an even, tight
surface. Interstices between stones shall be chinked with spalls firmly
rammed into place.
Class A: 20 cm
Class B: 45 cm
Class C: 60 cm
The surface of riprap placed above the water line shall not vary from the
theoretical surface by more than 8 cm at any point.
Stone for this purpose shall, as for as practicable, be selected of the size
and shape so as to secure fairly large, flat-surfaced stone which will lay up
with a true and even surface and a minimum of voids. The stones shall be
placed first and roughly arranged in close contact, the larger stones being
509-3
placed near the base of the slope. The spaces between the larger stones
shall be filled with stones of suitable size, leaving the surface smooth,
reasonably tight, and conforming to the contour required. In general, the
stone shall be laid with a degree of care that will ensure for plane surfaces a
maximum variation from a true plane of not more than three (3) percent.
Warped and curved surfaces shall have the same general degree of
accuracy as specified above for plane surface.
After the work has been completed as above described, all excess mortar
forced up shall be spread uniformly to completely fill all surface voids. All
surface joints shall then be roughly pointed up either with flush joints or with
shallow, smooth raked joints.
Weep holes shall be provided through the riprap cover as shown on the
plans or as directed by the Engineer.
After furnishing and fixing the steel reinforcement, reinforced concrete slope
protection shall be constructed after light spray of water at the locations
shown on the plans or where directed by the Engineer. Placing and
finishing of concrete shall conform to the requirements specified in Item 401.
509.4.1 Measurement
509-4
The computation of the quantities will be based on the volume within the
theoretical limiting dimensions designated on the Drawings.
These items shall include the furnishing of all material, placing and grouting
stone riprap, mixing and placing concrete including reinforcement.
Excavation, backfilling and slope preparation shall not be measured for
payment but will be considered subsidiary to the items of "Riprap" or "Slope
Protection".
509.4.2 Payment
The quantities, measured as provided above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price, for each of the pay items listed below and shown in the Bill of
Quantities. Payment shall be full compensation for furnishing all materials,
labour, equipment, tools supplies and all other costs related to completion of
the work.
509-5
ITEM 510 DISMANTLING OF STRUCTURES AND OBSTRUCTIONS
510.1 DESCRIPTION
General
Engineer shall specify the extent of dismantling for each structure and the
contractor shall raze, remove and dispose of all remains of all those
dismantled structures and other obstructions any portion of which are on the
right of way, except utilities and those for which other provisions have been
made for removal. All designated useable material shall be removed,
without unnecessary damage, in sections or pieces, which may be readily
transported, and shall be stored by the contractor at specified places with in
the project limits. Unusable perishable material shall be destroyed. Non-
perishable material may be disposed of outside the limits of view from the
project with written permissions of the property owner on whose property
the material is placed. Copies of all agreements with property owners are to
be furnished to the Engineer. Basements or cavities left by structural
removal shall be filled to the level of the surrounding ground and, if within
the prism of construction shall be compacted to the required degree of
compaction designated on the plans for roadway embankment and as
specified in Item 108.3.1.
510-1
510.2.1 Removal of Bridges, Culverts and other Drainage Structures
Unless otherwise directed all pipes shall be carefully removed and every
precaution taken to avoid breaking or damaging the pipe. The contractor
shall be held responsible for the satisfactory removal of such structures in a
usable condition. In case these provisions are violated, due to the
Contractor's negligence, all material to be salvaged which is damaged in
dismantling / removal to impair its future use will be charged to the
contractor at sixty (60) percent of the current quoted price, delivered to the
project, of an equal amount of new material. This amount of money shall be
deducted from any money due or to become due to contractor.
When fences enclosing pasture land or farm land are to be removed, the
Contractor shall notify the property owner sufficiently in advance to permit
the owner reasonable time to construct supplemental fences or make other
arrangements.
510-2
510.2.4 Wells
Existing wells, abandoned or active, which lie within the limits of the Work
as shown on the plans, or which fall within the approved cross sections or
as directed by the Engineer shall be dismantled, backfilled and compacted.
The Contractor shall carefully remove all salvageable material and store it at
a location on site designated by the Engineer. Unless otherwise noted or
directed, all salvageable material shall become the property of the Client.
Wells shall be filled to the level of the surrounding ground and, if within the
prism of construction, shall be compacted to the type of compaction within
the moisture range designated on the plans for roadway embankment and
as specified in Item 107. No dismantling or backfilling of a well shall be done
by the Contractor without the prior approval of the Engineer.
510.3.1 Measurement
510.3.2 Payment
The quantity as measured above shall be paid for at the Contract price per
cubic meter or kilogram. The payment shall constitute full compensation for
dismantling, removal and disposal of material as directed by the Engineer
and for all labour, equipments, tools and incidentals necessary to complete
the work.
511.1 DESCRIPTION
Where shown on the Drawings, this work shall consist of furnishing hand-set
pitching laid dry or grouted to stabilize slopes or as a protection against
water or other erosion to form a flat or cured surface as directed by the
Engineer. All materials regardless of type or kind shall be placed as per the
lines and levels called for on the plans.
511.2.1 Stones
The stones shall comprise good, hard and durable broken boulders or
pieces of rock. These shall be sound, dense, resistant to the action of air
and water and suitable in all respects for the purpose intended. Stones of
class I or II shall be used in pitching, shall conform to the following
specifications. The depth of the stones and their weight shall be as under:-
Class I
Class II
511.2.4 Water
511-1
511.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
511.3.1 Dry Pitching
The bed upon which pitching shall be laid, shall be firm or compacted of
approved granular material of specified thickness and to the required grades
and lines as shown on the plans or as directed and approved by the
Engineer. The stones shall comprise roughly dressed and shaped, set on
their edges with their longest dimension at right angles to the flow of water.
These shall be securely bedded, breaking bond closely packed with any
interstices locked and filled by selected stone spalls hammered in. The
loose pitching specified in plans shall be placed by dumping and spreading
in layers by hand or other methods approved by the Engineer all to secure a
stable mass. The ends of pitched areas shall be protected from
undermining by the use of edge stones at least twice the general size and
weight set on end. In large or slope areas of pitching, key stones shall be
provided at the rate of one per square meter, at least one and a half times
the general size and weight, set on end.
The pitching to the batters of the earth works and diversions of waterways
shall be carried down in trench to such a depth as will ensure a sound
footing for the lowest course. Subsequent to pitching the trench shall be
backfilled to normal ground level with approved, well compacted suitable
material.
Specified stones shall be arranged in such a way that the largest stones are
at the base of the slope. The surfaces of the rock shall be cleaned of
adhering dirt and clay and shall be moistened. Stone in the bottom courses
and to a vertical height and thickness as per plans shall be carefully
arranged by hand to inter lock and so as to yield true and even surface with
minimum voids and conforming to the contour required. Pitching laid in
cement mortars of 1:3 shall be furnished in panels with weep holes, the
joints between panels being approximately two (2) cm in thickness and
extending the full depth of the pitching, the joints shall be filled with sand
bitumen mixture consisting of approximately one part by weight of bitumen
heated as necessary to two parts by weight of a clean sharp sand. The
dimensions of the panels shall be approximately two meters square but the
precise dimensions in any instance and the spacing of the weep holes shall
be as required by the Engineer. In laying the pitching the lines of the panel
joints shall be picked out with a straight fillet laid on the face of the earth
works and the stones set up carefully to the edge of the fillet. Subsequent
to laying the pitching the fillet shall be removed and the joint caulked with
the sand bitumen mixture as above. The exposed surface of the stones
shall project not less than four (4) centimeters and not more than eight (8)
centimeters of the grout surface. The grouted stone pitching shall be cured
by an approved method for a minimum period of four (4) days and after
expiration of the curing period, the exposed surfaces shall be cleared of all
curing mediums.
511-2
511.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
511.4.1 Measurement
511.4.2 Payment
511-3
ITEM 512 DITCH LINING AND WASH CHECKS
512.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of the construction of stone or concrete ditch and/or
wash checks, in accordance with the specifications and in conformity with
the lines, grades and cross-sections shown on the drawings or as directed
by the Engineer.
512.2.1 Concrete
Concrete for ditch lining and wash checks shall be as specified in item 401.
Stone and mortar for grouted stone ditch lining or grouted stone wash
checks, shall be as specified in Item 509 for Riprap and reinforced concrete
slope protection.
512.3.1 Excavation
The sub-grade for the ditch lining or wash checks shall be excavated to a
smooth surface parallel to the proposed finished surface and to a depth
sufficient for the full thickness of the lining or wash checks as shown on the
drawings. Unstable sub-grade material shall be removed and replaced with
suitable materials as approved by the Engineer.
512-1
If shown on the plans, the concrete shall be reinforced with the type of
reinforcement and in the manner indicated. Contraction or construction
joints shall be spaced and formed as indicated in the plans.
The surface shall be finished with a wooden float. Bridges for Workmen
shall be used to avoid walking in the freshly laid concrete.
Immediately after the finishing operations are completed, the concrete shall
be protected and cured in a manner as approved by the Engineer.
The stones shall be placed in rows transversely to the centerline of the ditch
in the manner indicated on the plans. The stones shall be placed with ends
and sides abutting and the joints between stones in each row breaking with
the joints in the preceding row. The larger spaces between stones shall be
filled with spalls. The stones shall be rammed or compacted to give them
firm bearing and stability.
The stones for wash checks shall be laid to form a structure of the
dimensions shown on the plans. The sides and ends of the stones shall be
in contacts much as the sizes and shapes of the stones will permit. Spalls
shall be rammed into the larger spaces between stones to form a solid wall.
Joints between stones in one row shall break with joints between stones in
the adjacent rows.
c. Grout
After the surface has been inspected and approved, the spaces between
stones shall be completely filled with a grout composed of one (1) part of
Portland Cement and three (3) parts of fine aggregate mixed with sufficient
water to produce a plastic mortar. The grout shall be brushed or broomed
into the spaces to ensure proper filling.
The grout shall be cured in the manner as provided for "Grouted Riprap" in
Item 509, "Riprap and Reinforced Concrete Slope Protection."
512-2
512.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
512.4.1 Measurement
a. Ditch Lining
b. Wash Checks
512.4.2 Payment
a. Ditch Lining
The amount of completed and accepted Work as measured, will be paid for
at the unit price(s) bid per square meter as specified in the Bill of Quantities
for "Concrete Ditch Lining" or "Grouted Stone Ditch Lining" which price(s)
shall be full compensation for furnishing, transporting, and placing all
materials, including reinforcement, if required, for all excavation, backfilling
and for all labor, tools, and all other items necessary for the proper
completion of the Work.
b. Wash Checks
The amount of completed and accepted Work as measured will be paid for
at the unit price(s) bid per linear meter as specified in the Bill of Quantities
for "Concrete Wash Checks" and "Grouted Stone Wash Checks," which
price(s) shall be full compensation for all excavation, backfilling, for all
materials, for all labor, equipment, tools and all other items necessary for
the proper completion of the Work.
512-3
ANCILLARY
WORKS
ANCILLARY WORKS
This section shall consist of items of work which are ancillary or incidental to
the other parts of the General Specifications. Such works shall include
general items, precast concrete posts and markers, traffic control devices,
side walks, guard rails, detours, traffic signs, pavement marking, reflectors,
fencing and brick edging etc., in accordance with these specifications and in
conformity with the lines, grades sections dimensions and locations in the
plans or as required by the Engineer.
This section deals with those items of work in which small elements of
construction employ construction items such as concrete, brick work, stone
masonry, steel reinforcement or structural steel. These items of work have
been separately quantified so that contractor can price them by assessing
size of each element and extra effort which is essential in addition to the
specification requirement of the parent item.
Metal guard-rails, traffic road signs and safety devices, pavement markings,
reflectorised pavement studs, and other such fixtures shall meet the
requirements of ISO - 9,000 for which certificates of manufacturers and
supplies shall be produced.
600-1
ITEM 601 CONCRETE KERBS, GUTTERS AND CHANNELS
601.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of kerb, gutter, channel, or combination of kerb and
gutter or channel; constructed of the following materials and in accordance
with the specifications at the location and of the form, dimensions and
designs shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer. The kerb,
gutter, channel or in combination may be constructed by one of the following
methods.
The concrete for cast in place concrete kerbs, gutters and channels shall be
either Class 'A' or class 'C' or as indicated on the Drawings and shall
conform to the requirements of that particular class prescribed under item
401.1.1. “Classes of concrete”. An air entraining agent, if required, shall be
added during mixing an amount to produce five (5) to eight (8) percent air by
volume in the mixed concrete.
Precast concrete kerbing units shall consist of class 'C' concrete conforming
to the requirement of item 401 and to lengths, shape and other details
shown on the Drawings. Kerbing which shows surface irregularities of more
than five (5) mm when checked with three meter straight edge or surface
pits more than fifteen (15) mm in diameter will be rejected.
Forms to hold the concrete shall be built and set in place as described
under item 403-Formwork.
Forms for at least sixty meters of kerb or combination of kerb and gutter or
channels shall be in place and checked for alignment and grade before
concrete is placed. Curved sections shall have forms of either wood or
metal and shall be accurately shaped to radius of curvature shown on the
Drawings. Steel Reinforcement if required shall conform to item 404 "Steel
Reinforcement".
Joint filler shall consist of one part cement and two parts of approved sand
with sufficient quantity of water necessary to obtain the required
consistency. The mortar shall be used within thirty (30) minutes after
preparation.
601-1
601.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
601.3.1 Cast-in-Place
Excavation shall be made to the required depth and the base upon which
the kerb or combination of kerb and gutter is to be set shall be compacted to
a minimum density of ninety (90) percent of the maximum dry density as
determined by AASHTO T-191 Method. All soft and unsuitable material shall
be removed and replaced with suitable material acceptable to the Engineer.
Where directed by the Engineer, a layer of cinders or clean sand and gravel,
or other approved porous material having a minimum compacted thickness,
of fifteen (15) cm shall be placed to form a bed for the kerb or combination
of kerb and gutter.
b) Placing Concrete
Concrete may be placed in the gutter to the full depth required. The top of
the kerb or combination of kerb and gutter shall be floated smooth and the
edges rounded to the radii shown on the Drawings. Before finishing, the
surface of the gutter shall be tested with a three (3) meter straight-edge and
any irregularities of more than five (5) mm in three (3) meters shall be
eliminated. In finishing concrete only mortar normally present in the
concrete shall be permitted for finishing. The use of a separate mortar
finishing coat or the practice of working dry cement into the surface of the
concrete will not be permitted.
c) Joints
The kerb and gutter shall be constructed in uniform sections of not more
than twenty five (25) meters in length except where shorter sections are
required to coincide with the location of weakened planes or contraction
joints of the concrete pavement or for closures but no section shall be less
than two (2) meters long. The sections shall be separated by sheet
templates set perpendicular to the face and top of the kerb and gutter. The
templates shall be approximately five (5) mm in thickness, of the same width
as that of the kerb or kerb and gutter and not less than five (5) cm greater
than the depth of the kerb or kerb and gutter. Templates shall be set
carefully and held firmly during the placing of the concrete and shall be
allowed to remain in place until the concrete has set sufficiently to hold its
shape, but shall be removed while the forms are still in place. When pre-cut
fiber-board packing is used in the expansion joints it may be used in place
of the sheet template referred to above, on the approval of the Engineer. In
this event the fiber board shall be pre-cut to the shape of the kerb so that its
outer edge will be flush with the abutting kerb.
Expansion joints shall be formed in the kerb and gutter at intervals of six (6)
to ten (10) meters in order to coincide with the expansion joints of cement
concrete pavement or as shown on the Drawing.
601-2
d) Dowels at Expansion Joints in Channels
The size and spacing of the dowel bars shall be as indicated on the
Drawings. Each dowel shall be set accurately parallel to the top surface of
the gutter and accurately at right angles to the expansion joint.
e) Contraction Joints
The forms shall be removed within twenty four (24) hours after concrete has
placed except that the form used against the face of the kerb in a
combination of kerb and gutter shall be removed as soon as the concrete
has set sufficiently to hold its shape. Minor defects shall be repaired with
mortar containing one part of portland cement and two parts of the fine
aggregate. Plastering shall not be permitted on the face of a kerb or kerb
and gutter and all rejected kerb or gutter shall be removed and replaced
without additional compensation. All surfaces which will be exposed in the
finished construction of the kerb and gutter shall be finished, while the
concrete is still "green" by wetting a wood block of float and rubbing the
surface until they are smooth.
g) Curing
During seventy two (72) hours following placing of concrete, the kerbs,
channels and gutters shall be protected against premature drying by
covering with suitable cotton or Hessian mats and by frequent sprinkling
with water, with liquid forming compounds or with waterproof paper or by
any other method as mentioned in section 401.3.8-Curing Concrete and
approved by the Engineer.
h) Backfilling
After forms has been removed and concrete has been cured as
specified, the excavation of kerbs, gutters or channels shall be backfilled
601-3
with suitable earth or granular material tamped into place in layers of not
more than fifteen (15) cms each until firm and solid.
601.3.2 Pre-Cast
The precast concrete kerbs shall be set in 1:3 of cement sand mortar to the
line, level and grade as shown on the Drawings or as directed by the
Engineer.
c) Joints
Joints between consecutive kerbs shall be three (3) to five (5) mm wide and
filled with cement mortar to the full section of the kerb.
d) Backfilling
b) Placing
Concrete shall be fed to the machine at a uniform rate. The concrete shall
be of such consistency that after extrusion it will maintain the shape of the
kerb section without support and shall contain the maximum amount of
water that will permit this result. The machine shall be operated under
sufficient uniform restraint to forward motion to produce a well compacted
mass of concrete which requires no further finishing other than light
brushing with a brush filled with water only.
601-4
The top end face of the finished kerb shall be true and straight and the top
surface of the kerb shall be of uniform width, free from bumps or surface pits
larger than fifteen (15) mm in diameter. When a straight-edge three (3)
meters long is laid on the top or face of the kerb, or surface of the gutter, the
surface shall not be more than five (5) mm from the edge of the straight-
edge except at grade changes or curves.
c) Joints
Expansion joints shall be constructed by sawing through the kerb section to
its full depth. The width of the cut shall be such as to admit the joint filler
with a tight fit. Preformed joint filler shall conform to the provisions of Item
601.2 and shall be inserted and mortared in place.
601.4.1 Measurement
601-5
601.4.2 Payment
Measured and accepted quantities shall be paid for at the contract unit price
per linear meter for each of the particular pay item listed below and shown
in the Bill of Quantities which prices and payment shall constitute full
compensation for furnishing and placing all materials for concrete, for
reinforcing steel if required on the Drawings for expansion Joints, material,
form for drainage opening, excavation, backfilling and dumping and disposal
of surplus material and for all labour, equipment, tool and incidentals
necessary to complete the item.
Payment for expansion joint filler material used in transverse expansion and
contraction joints in kerbs and channel shall be understood to be included in
the price tendered per linear meter for the kerbs and channels and shall not
be paid for separately.
Concrete and mortar required for bedding of precast concrete kerbs as
shown on the Drawings shall not be paid for as separated item, but the cost
shall be included in the contract unit price for precast concrete kerb.
601-6
ITEM 602 ASPHALT CONCRETE AND CEMENT CONCRETE
SIDEWALK
602.1 DESCRIPTION
Unless otherwise directed the joint filler shall have a thickness of five (5)
mm and conform to the requirements of Item 601.2.
602.2.4 Forms
Bed course material shall consist of cinders, sand, slag, gravel, crushed
stone or other approved materials of such gradation that all particles will
pass through a 1/2" (12.5 m) sieve.
Asphaltic prime coat material shall conform to the requirements of Item 301
for Cut-back Asphalt.
602-1
602.3 CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS
(a) Excavation
Excavation shall be made to the required depth and to a width that will
permit the installation and bracing of the forms. The foundation shall be
shaped and compacted to minimum ninety (90) percent of the maximum dry
density as determined by AASHTO T-191 Method. The surface shall be
even conforming to the section shown on the drawings. All soft material
shall be removed and replaced with acceptable material.
The bed course material shall be compacted in layers not exceeding ten
(10) cm, to the depth shown on the drawings and to the line and grade of
the finished sidewalk surface.
(c) Priming the Bed Course Material
The prepared bed course material shall receive an application of prime coat
in accordance with the requirements of Item 302 and approved by the
Engineer.
The asphalt concrete shall be placed on the previously primed prepared bed
only when, in the opinion of the Engineer the bed is sufficiently dry and
weather conditions are suitable. The mixture shall be placed on one or more
courses of uniform thickness as shown on the Drawings. Each course shall
be smoothed by raking or screeding and shall be thoroughly compacted by
rolling with a hand operated roller or a type satisfactory to the Engineer.
After compaction, the surfacing shall be of the thickness and section shown
on the Drawings, shall be smooth, even and of a dense and uniform texture.
Forms, if used, shall be removed and the shoulders shaped and compacted
to the required section.
(a) Excavation
Where indicated on the drawings the bed course material shall be placed in
accordance with Item 602.3.1 (b).
602-2
(c) Forms and Expansion Joints
All forms shall be staked securely in position at the correct line and
elevation.
Expansion joint filler shall be set in the position shown on the Drawings
before the placing of the concrete is started. The joint filler shall be placed 5
mm below the top surface of the finished sidewalk.
Before the concrete has set, the surface of the concrete shall be trawled
until it is of uniform smoothness and is true to the lines, elevations, and
surface required.
The surface shall be cut through to a depth of one (1) cm with a trowel at
intervals of one (1) meter or where required, in straight lines perpendicular
to the edge of the sidewalk. The surface shall then be brushed. The edges
of the sidewalk and the transverse cuts shall be shaped with a suitable tool
so formed as to round the edges to a one and half (1.5) centimeters radius.
Precast concrete units shall be fair faced cast to the sizes and dimensions
as indicated on the drawings.
The concrete used for pre-cast unit shall conform to the specifications laid
down in item 401-Concrete. The Contractor shall be required to submit a
sample of pre-cast unit for the approval of the Engineer. All pre-cast units
shall strictly conform to the approved sample.
602-3
602.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
602.4.1 Measurement
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of square meters of asphalt
concrete or cement concrete sidewalk complete in place and accepted,
measured in the place of the sidewalk surface.
602.4.2 Payment
The quantity as determined above, shall be paid for at the contract unit price
per square meter for the pay items listed below and shown in the Bill of
Quantities, which price and payment shall constitute full compensation for
furnishing and placing all materials, for asphaltic concrete, Portland cement
concrete, expansion joint material, for excavating and compacting the
foundation bed, for furnishing and placing for forms, and for all labour,
equipment, tools and incidentals necessary to complete the item.
602-4
ITEM 603 BRICK EDGING
603.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of brick installed on vertical edge between the
pavement structure and shoulders in such a manner that the brick is laid on
compacted shoulders and top of brick is flushed with the slope of road
pavement.
603.2.1 Bricks
603.4.1 Measurement
Brick edging when laid and finished to the required grade and line shall be
measured per linear meter installed and approved by the Engineer.
603.4.2 Payment
The quantity as measured above shall be paid per linear meter for
excavation of trench, installation of bricks, compacted backfill of cavities and
dressing of berms including material, watering, tamping, labour, equipment,
tools and incidentals necessary to complete the item.
603-1
ITEM 604 METAL BEAM GUARD-RAIL
604.1 DESCRIPTION
This item shall consist of metal beam Guard rail constructed in accordance
with these specifications at the locations and in conformity with the
dimensions, and design shown on the Drawings or as ordered by the
Engineer.
The mechanical properties of the base metals for beams shall conform to
the following requirements:
The end or buffer sections shall be formed from open hearth, electric
furnace or basic oxygen steel. The section shall be of the same or superior
class and type used for the beam to which it is attached.
604-1
604.2.4 Guard Rail Posts
Posts shall be of either steel or concrete as specified. Only one type of post
shall be used for any one continuous Guard rail, except at junctions
between bridges and approach embankments.
a) Steel posts shall be galvanized and of the section and length specified or
as shown on the Drawings. They shall conform to the requirements of
AASHTO M 183 for the grade specified.
Wooden spacer blocks between the Guard rail and the posts shall conform
to AASHTO M-133 and M-168 and be constructed to the section and length
specified or as shown on the Drawings.
All posts shall be set vertically in the position shown on the Drawings and
where embedded in a concrete foundation block shall remain undisturbed
for a minimum of forty eight (48) hours. The space around the post or post
foundation blocks shall be backfilled to the ground line, with selected earth
containing no rocks, in layers of not exceeding ten (10) cm and each layer
shall be moistened and thoroughly compacted. Where steel posts are driven
into the ground no buckled post or deformed head shall be accepted.
All metal work shall be fabricated in the shop and no cutting or welding shall
be done in the field unless otherwise ordered by the Engineer. Rail
elements shall be lapped so that the exposed ends will not face
approaching traffic. Terminal sections shall be installed in accordance with
the manufacturer's recommendation.
604-2
604.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
604.4.1 Measurement
The Guard rail shall be measured by the linear meter from center to center
of end posts for each completed section fastened in place and accepted.
Guard rail end pieces shall be measured by the number completed in place
and accepted.
Post for Guard rail shall be measured by the number erected in place and
accepted.
604.4.2 Payment
604-3
ITEM 605 CONCRETE BEAM GUARD RAIL
605.1 DESCRIPTION
Bolts, nuts, washers, sleeves and other fittings shall conform to ASTM
Designation A 325 (AASHTO M 614) and shall be zinc coated in
accordance with the requirement of ASTM Designation A 153 (AASHTO
M 232).
605.3.1 Formwork
Formwork shall be supplied and fixed in the position required for the
concrete to be cast as shown on the Drawings, or as required by
the Engineer, and shall be supplied, erected and removed as specified
in Item 403.
605-1
605.3.2 Steel Reinforcement
Steel reinforcement shall be furnished, bent and fixed where shown on the
Drawings, or where required by the Engineer, and its furnishing, bending
and fixing shall be in accordance with Item 404.
605.3.3 Concrete
605.4.1 Measurement
Guard rail end pieces shall be measured by the length in meter completed
in place and accepted.
Posts for guard rail and guard rail end pieces shall be measured by the
number erected in place and accepted.
605.4.2 Payment
605-2
ITEM 606 BRIDGE RAILING
606.1 DESCRIPTION
This work, consists of the supply and erection of concrete railing for bridges
and other structures in accordance with these specifications and to the
details shown on the Drawings.
Where metal beam Guard rails form part of the Bridge Railing, the Guard
rail beam and connections shall conform to the requirements of item 604
and shall be paid for under that item.
606.2.1 Formwork
606.2.3 Concrete
606.3.1 Formwork
Formwork shall be supplied and fixed in the position required for the
concrete to be cast as shown on the Drawings, or as directed by the
Engineer, and shall be supplied, erected and removed as specified in
Item 403.
Steel reinforcement shall be furnished, bent and fixed where shown on the
drawings or where directed by the Engineer and its furnishing, bending, and
fixing shall be in accordance with the Item 404.
606-1
606.3.3 Concrete
606.4.1 Measurement
606.4.2 Payment
Payment shall be made for the materials utilized, or the rates quoted by
contractor and measured as provided above, for following items.
607.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall comprise furnishing and installing traffic signs, permanent
safety devices and post assemblies in accordance with these specifications
and to the details shown on the Drawings. All sign faces and lettering shall
be in accordance with NHA/NTRC sign standards or as shown on plans.
Prior to manufacture and fabrication of the signs the contractor shall submit
to the Engineer for approval detailed drawings showing letter sizes, traffic
symbols and sign layout. The permanent safety devices shall consist of road
posts and hazard markers and will be provided as per specifications,
drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
The blanks shall be free from laminations, blisters, open seams, pits, holes,
or other defects that may affect their appearance or use. The thickness shall
be uniform and the blank commercially flat. Perform shearing, cutting and
punching before preparing the blanks for application of reflective material.
607-1
The manufacturer of the sheeting being offered shall furnish the process
inks, clears and thinners produced by the sheeting manufacturer
recommended for and compatible with the sheeting to meet the
performance requirements of this specification and shall further be
responsible for technical assistance in the use of these inks or alternatively
sheeting can be used on sheeting.
Table I
Reflectance
Limit (Y) Munsell
**
Color X Y X Y X Y X Y Min. Max. Paper
White .303 .287 .368 .353 .340 .380 .274 .316 27.0 5PB 7/1
Yellow .498 .412 .557 .442 .479 .520 .438 .472 15.0 40.0 1.25Y 6/12
Red .613 .297 .708 .292 .636 .364 .558 .352 2.5 11.0 7.5R 3/12
Blue .144 .030 .244 .202 .190 .247 .066 .208 1.0 10.0 5.8PB 1.32/6.8
Orange .550 .360 .630 .370 .581 .418 .516 .394 14.0 30.0 2.5YR 5.5/14
Brown .430 .340 .430 .390 .550 .450 .610 .390 3.0 9.0 5YR 3/6
Green .030 .380 .166 .346 .286 .4288 .201 .776 3.0 8.0 10G 3/8
* The four pairs of chromaticity coordinates determine the acceptable color
in terms of the CIE 1931 standard colormeteric system measured with
standard illumination Source C
607-2
b) Coefficient of Retroreflection. The coefficients of retroreflection shall
conform to the minimum requirements of Table II.
Table II
Observation Entrance
Angle (o) Angle (o) White Red Yellow Green Blue Brown Orange
The sheeting manufacturer shall provide a test report from British Standards
Institution (BSI) or any internationally recognised laboratory stating that the
sheeting meets the requirements according to BSI 873 Part 6. or FP 92 of
FHWA.
The brightness of the reflective sheeting totally wet by rain, shall be at least
ninety (90) % of the above values.
607-3
c) Performance Requirements And Obligation. The sign manufacturer
shall submit a certificate from the sheeting manufacturer stating that the
sheeting used for finished retroreflective signs meets all requirements
listed herein.
Table III
Minimum Minimum
Coefficient Coefficient
Sheeting of Retroreflection of Retroreflection
Color (7 Years) (10 Years)
a) The entire seven years the sign manufacturer and sheeting manufacturer
will replace the sheeting required to restore the sign surface to its
original effectiveness.
607-4
b) In addition, during the first five years sign manufacturer and sheeting
manufacturer will cover the cost of restoring the sign surface to its
original effectiveness at no cost to the NHA for materials and labor.
In lieu of wide flange steel posts the Contractor may use tubular steel posts
of minimum internal and external diameters of sixty three (63) mm and
seventy five (75) mm respectively conforming to the specifications of
ASTM A 501.
All posts shall be thoroughly cleaned, free from grease, scale and rust, and
shall be given one coat of rust inhibitive priming paint and two coats of grey
paint. Length of the posts shall be such that their top flushes with the top of
the sign penal, where as bottom of sign panel is at least hundred and eighty
(180) centimeters above shoulder level.
607.2.4 Plates
a) Plates shall be non-porous, smooth, flat, rigid, weather proof and shall
not rust or deteriorate otherwise.
It shall be so cut that there are no sharp edges and that the corners are
rounded off to a radius of thirty seven and half (37.5) mm. Any trade mark or
other printing shall be carefully removed with liquid thinner.
b) The High Intensity Grade sheeting for the background should cover the
whole area of the sign plate.
607-5
607.2.5 Nuts and Bolts
All Nuts and bolts and metal washers shall be of heavily galvanized quality
ten (10) mm dia (G.I.) or aluminium alloy. The bolt heads to be such that
they do not protrude out too much nor show very much on the front face of
the plate. The heads should be flush with the plate face and covered with
sheeting galvanised according to ASTM A 153.
All rubber washers shall have thick walls and shall not get dry and brittle
when exposed to weather at the site after they are in position during the life
of the sign.
These can be of heavy plastic or of aluminium well fitted so that they cannot
be removed; any good adhesive can be used.
607.2.8 General
a) Very large signs need not be made of one piece; in that case extended
Aluminium panels shall be used or the various pieces of sheet shall be
joined by angle-irons in anticorodal materials, and, if necessary, with
connecting cross pieces in order to ensure the solidity of the joint and
with slanting struts embedded in the concrete as directed by the
Engineer.
b) All the nuts and bolts and metal washers must be heavily galvanized, or
may be of stainless steel of high quality.
c) Relevant holes to receive ten (10) mm bolts shall be drilled into the pipes
and the plates and not punched. These to be drilled through the plates
before the application of scotchlite.
d) After the plates are fixed with nuts and bolts, the nuts shall be TACK
WELDED to the bolts against pilferage.
The road posts and hazard markers used as permanent safety devices shall
conform fully with the requirements of the statutory instruments, current
British standards and chapter four (4) of the Traffic signs manual. The safety
devices shall consist of delineators and detours of verge master, flex
607-6
master, edge master, passing place post, and chevroflex etc. and will be
manufactured from highly durable tough plastic material with standing
vehicular impact. These shall be of High Intensity Grade reflective sheeting
for maximum visibility by both day and night and consequently be resistant
to impact, damage and vandalism.
Holes shall be excavated to the required depth of the bottom of the concrete
foundation as shown on the Drawing.
The posts shall be erected vertically in position inside the formwork of the
foundation block prior to the placing of the concrete and shall be adequately
supported by bracing to prevent movement of the post during the setting
process of the concrete. The posts shall be located at the positions shown
on the Drawings.
The exposed portion of the fastening hardware on the face of the sign shall
be painted with enamels matching the background colour.
All newly erected traffic road signs shall be covered with burlap or other
material until their uncovering is ordered by the Engineer.
607.3.4 Categories of Signs
a) Warning Signs
607-7
b) Regulatory Signs
Constructed with single post and sign of circular shape, as shown in the
drawings, category 2.
c) Informatory Signs
These signs shall be rectangular in shape and constructed with one, two or
three numbers of posts or as shown on the drawings. Dimensions may vary
according to the requirements, however total area of sign shall be as under:-
d) Additional panel
a) Design
All sign faces shall be of the type, colour, design and size as shown in the
plans. Size and spacing of letters shall be as under:-
607-8
1. The Urdu writing shall be in "Persian" character.
2. The Urdu and English writing shall be about the same in length,
width and spacing.
b) Shop Drawings
The contractor shall submit to the Engineer for approval, three (3) copies of
drawings for all special sign faces and all sign faces bearing messages,
showing the design and/or arrangement and spacing of both the Urdu and
English sign messages. Official town names and their spelling shall be as
provided by the Engineer. Size and style of lettering shall be as shown on
the plans or as otherwise approved by the Engineer.
607-9
607.3.7 Storage of Signs
Signs delivered for use on a project shall be stored off ground and under
cover in a manner approved by the Engineer. Any signs damaged,
discolored or defaced during transportation, storage or erection shall be
rejected .
607.4.1 Measurement
The quantities of traffic road signs and safety devices to be paid for shall be
measured in number of each category of sign supplied and installed at site
as directed by the Engineer.
607.4.2 Payment
607-10
ITEM 608 PAVEMENT MARKING
608.1 DESCRIPTION
The paint shall be applied in conformance to the size, shape and location of
the markings as shown in the Drawings.
Composition
Solvents 45+4%
The volatile material shall be of such character that has a minimum solvent
action of asphalt, and such that the resins and non-volatile components will
be entirely dissolved in the volatile material, and will not precipitate from the
solution on standing. The non-volatile material shall be of such quality that it
will not darken or become yellow when a thin section is exposed to the
sunlight.
No. 12 0
No. 20 30
No. 30 50
No. 50 80
No. 80 100
Glass beads shall conform with AASHTO Designation M-247. At least ninety
(90) percent glass beads shall be transparent, reasonable spherical and
free from flaws.
The proportion of ballotini to paint shall be not less than five hundred (500)
grams per litre of paint.
608-2
608.2.2 Photometric Requirements for Reflective Road Paint
Other reflective road paints may be considered for use by the Engineer
provided they have minimum brightness values at two tenth (0.2) degree
and half (0.5) degree divergence expressed as candle power per meter per
square meter of surface coating, as follows:
Colour.
White Yellow
The painting of lane markers and traffic strips shall include the cleaning of
the pavement surfaces, the application, protection and drying of the paint
coatings, the protection of pedestrians, vehicular or other traffic on the
pavements, the protection of all parts of the road, structures or
appurtenances against disfigurement by spatters, splashes or smirches of
paint or of paint materials, and the supplying of all tools, labour and traffic
paint necessary for the entire work.
The paint shall not be applied during rain, wet weather, when the air is
misty, or when, in the opinion of the Engineer, conditions are otherwise
unfavourable for the work. Paint shall not be applied upon damp pavement
surfaces, or upon pavements which have absorbed heat sufficient to cause
the paint to blister and produce a porous paint film.
Traffic paint shall be applied to the pavement at a rate of one (1) litre to two
and half (2.5) square meters or less. Contractor shall provide adequate
arrangements that applied paint is not disfigured by moving traffic, till its
complete drying and sticking to road surface.
608-3
608.3 HOT-APPLIED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD PAINTS
608.3.1.1 Aggregate
The aggregate shall consist of light coloured silica sand, calcite, quartz,
calcined flint, or other material approved by the Engineer.
a) White material.
b) Yellow materials.
Sufficient suitable yellow pigment shall be substituted for all or part of the
titanium dioxide to comply with the other requirements of this specification.
c) All materials.
d) Binder.
The binder shall consist of synthetic hydrocarbon resin, or, with the approval
of the Engineer, gun or wood resin, plasticized with mineral oil.
e) Composition of mixture.
The proportions of the constituents of the mixed material as found on
analysis shall comply with the requirements of table 1.
608-4
TABLE 1, PROPORTIONS OF CONSTITUENTS OF MIXTURE
Constituent
Percentage by mass of total mixture
Minimum Maximum
Binder (resin and oil) 18 22
Pigment 6* -
Pigment and extender 18 22
Ballotini 20+ -
Aggregate
Pigment 78 82
Extender and ballotini
608.3.2.1 Sampling
For the purpose of carrying out the testing, it is essential that adequate and
representative samples be taken in the manner prescribed in specification
BS 3262 at following stages.
a) At the manufacturer’s plant.
608-5
608.3.3.2 Testing
• Softening point.
a) White material.
b) Yellow material.
• Heat Stability
a) White Material.
b) Yellow material.
• Flow resistance.
In testing the flow resistance, a cone made and tested in accordance with
appendix F, shall not slump by more than 25%.
608-6
• Skid resistance.
608.3.3.1 Manufacturing
608.3.3.2 Packing
608.3.3.3 Storing
608.3.4 Certification
The Contractor shall furnish a certificate from manufacturer that the material
he proposes to use has the required properties, stating the maximum and
minimum proportions and grading of the constituents, the acid value of the
binder, the setting time, the maximum safe heating temperature, the
temperature range of the apparatus and the proposed method of laying.
a) Preparation of site.
The thermoplastic paint shall only be applied to surfaces, which are clean
and dry. Immediately before the application of paint, the surface shall be
cleaned with mechanical broom, compressed air or other approved means
to remove surplus asphalt, oils, mud, dust and other loose or adhered
material. The material shall not be applied if the road surface is at a
temperature of less than 5o C.
608-7
b) Preparation of material on site.
c) Laying.
Carriageway centre lines, lane lines and edge lines shall be laid to a regular
alignment by self propelled machine. Other markings may be laid by hand,
hand propelled machine or self propelled machine as approved by the
Engineer. The surface produced shall be uniform in texture and thickness
and appreciably free from blisters and streaks.
1.7 mm 100
600 µ 80 - 100
425 µ 45 - 100
300 µ 10 - 45
212 µ 0 - 25
75 µ 0-5
608-8
Not less than 90%, by mass of the ballotini, shall be of transparent glass,
spherical in shape and not more then ten (10) percent shall be ovate in
shape or have other flaws. The ballotini shall be made of soda glass.
e) Thickness
Unless otherwise approved by the Engineer, the material shall be laid to the
following thicknesses.
a) Sprayed lines other than yellow. Not less than 1.5 mm.
b) Sprayed yellow edge lines not less than 0.8 mm.
In no case shall the contractor proceed with the work until the equipment,
method of application and rate of application conforming the required
thickness (as established by a test section) have been approved by the
Engineer.
The preformed markings shall consist of white or yellow films with pigments
selected to conform to standard highway colours. Ceramic and glass beads
shall be incorporated to provide immediate and continuing retroreflection.
Ceramic skid particles shall be bonded to a top urethane layer to provide a
skid resistant surface.
608-9
The retroreflective pavement marking film shall consist of mixture of high-
quality pigmented polymeric materials, with a reflective layer of ceramic and
glass beads, and a layer of skid resistant ceramic particles bonded to the
top urethane wear surface. The film shall have a pre-coated pressure
sensitive adhesive. The edges of the preformed tape shall be clear cut and
true.
608.4.2 Colour:
The daytime colour of the white film shall provide a minimum initial
Luminance factor, Y, of 80, and shall conform to the following chromaticity
requirements: X = 0.290, Y = 0.315; X = 0.491, Y = 0.435; X = 0.512, Y =
0.486; X = 0536, Y = 0.463.
608.4.3 Reflectance.
The white and yellow films shall have the following initial minimum
reflectance values as measured in accordance with the testing procedures
of ASTM D 4061. The photometric quantity to be measured shall be specific
luminance (SL), and shall be expressed as millicandals per square foot per
foot-candle (mcd. ft-2). fc -1 ). The metric equivalent shall be expressed as
millicandals per square meter per lux (mcd. m -2). lx-1)
White Yellow
Entrance Angle 86.5o 86.5o
Observation Angle 1.0o 1.0o
Specific Luminance 300 175
SL [(mcd. ft-2). Fc-1 ]
The surface of the retroreflective films shall provide an initial minimum skid
resistance values of 55 BPN as measured by the British Portable Skid
Tester in accordance with ASTM E 303.
608.4.5 Patchability
The pavement marking film shall be capable of use for patching worn areas
of the same type of film in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
608-10
608.4.6.1 Taber Abraser Simulation Test
Using a Taber Abraser with an H-18 wheel and a 125 gram load, the
sample shall be inspected at 200 cycles, under a microscope, to observed
the extent and type of bead failure. No more than 15% of the beads shall be
lost due to popout and the predominant mode of failure shall be “wear
down” on the beads.
608.4.7 Beads
The size, quality and refractive index of the ceramic and glass beads shall
be such that the performance requirements for the marking shall be met.
The bead adhesion shall be such that beads are not easily removed when
the material surface is scratched.
The film shall be ceramic and glass bead retention qualities such that when
a 2 in x 6 in. (5.08 cm x 15.24 cm) sample is bent over a 1/2 in. (1.27 cm)
diameter-mandrel, with the 2 in. dimension perpendicular to the mandrel
axis, microscopic examination of the area on the mandrel shall show no
more than 10% of the beads with entrapment by the binder of less than
40%.
608.4.9 Thickness
608.4.11 Installation
608-11
• Traffic Islands - vertical edges and bull noses, etc.
• Traffic Dividers - black and white chevrons.
• Concrete wall and faces - on high speed intersections and traffic
merging.
608.5.1 Measurement
608.5.2 Payment
608-12
609.1 DESCRIPTION
The `Flush Surface' reflector shall be the short base type having a
maximum base area of 18 cm x 14 cm or as shown on the Drawings.
The pad shall be highly resilient and durable rubber reinforced with canvas
and shall have an anticipated life of at least five (5) years. The pad shall be
so designed as to produce a self whipping action of the reflector when
depressed.
The reflectors shall be made of impact and abrasion resisting glass and
shall be hermetically sealed into a copper socket.
The `Raised Profile' reflectors shall consist of an acrylic plastic shell filled
with an adherent epoxy compound molded from methyl methacylate into the
shape of a shallow frustum of a pyramid having base dimension of
approximately 10 cm x 10 cm and thickness not more than two (2) cm or as
shown on the drawings.
The shell shall contain one or two prismatic reflector each inclined at an
angle of thirty (30) degree to the horizontal and having an area not less than
twenty (20) square cm or as indicated on the plans.
The reflectors shall attain the following standards for their photometric and
physical qualities:
609-1
i) Photometric Requirements
The reflectors shall have the following minimum Specific Intensity values
(S.I) expressed as candle power per foot candle of illumination at the
reflector on a plane perpendicular to the incident light.
COLOUR
Crystal Yellow Red
Divergence Angle 0.20 0.20 0.20
The reflector for testing shall be located with the center of the reflecting face
at a distance of one and half (1.5) m from a uniformly bright light source
having an effective diameter of half (0.5) centimeter.
The width of the photocell shall be 1.27 cms and shall be shielded from
stray light. The distance from the centers of the light source and photocell
shall be 0.53 cms.
Failure of more than four (4) % of the reflecting faces shall be cause for
rejection of the lot.
The reflectors shall support a vertical load of 1000 kg when tested in the
following manner.
609-2
609.2.2 Adhesive
Package A Kg/Litre
Package B Kg/Litre
Cement mortar shall consist of one (1) part Portland cement to three (3)
parts of fine aggregates.
The stud shall be installed into the pavement in accordance with the
manufacturer's instructions but shall also comply with the following
requirements:
609-3
The bottom of the cavity shall be leveled with asphalt concrete prior to
placing the stud base, which shall be pounded into position with Pounder
Foot attached to a pneumatic drill.
The depth of the cavity shall be such that when the stud base and reflectors
have been installed the elevation of the floor of the lens socket shall not be
greater than two (2) mm or less than one (1) mm above the pavement
surface.
The stud shall be grouted into position with asphalt concrete containing fine
aggregate only or with a cement mortar as described in Item 609.2.3 above
when the studs are installed into a cement concrete pavement.
609.4.1 Measurement
609.4.2 Payment
609-4
ITEM 610 PRECAST CONCRETE POSTS AND MARKERS
610.1 DESCRIPTION
The work shall consist of furnishing and placing precast concrete Kilometer,
Ten Kilometer, Guide Posts and Right of Way Markers, complete including
painting and lettering in accordance with the Drawings and specifications or
as directed by the Engineer.
610.2.1 Concrete
(b) Placing
The precast concrete posts and markers shall be set in two (2) cm of
cement mortar to the level and grade as shown on the Drawings or as
directed by the Engineer.
(c) Back-filling
After the placing of precast concrete posts and markers in the excavated
areas and subsequent setting in with cement mortar, the same will be
refilled to the required elevation with suitable earth or granular material,
which shall be tamped in layers of not more than fifteen (15) centimeters
each until firm and solid.
610-1
610.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
610.4.1 Measurement
The quantity of each element to be paid for shall be the number of post and
marker furnished and installed in place as per drawing or as directed by the
Engineer.
610.4.2 Payment
The accepted quantities of posts and markers shall be paid for at the
contract unit price per unit of measurement for the pay items listed below
and shown in Bill of Quantities which price shall be compensation for
furnishing, excavation, placing, erection, painting, lettering and for all costs
including labour, tools, and incidentals necessary to complete the work
prescribed in these items:
610-2
ITEM 611 FENCING
611.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of constructing post and barbed wire fence or chain
link fence in accordance with the details and at the locations shown on the
Drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
Barbed wire shall conform to the requirements of ASTM A 121, Class I. The
barbed wire shall consist of two (2) strands of twelve and half (12.5) gauge
wire, twisted with two (2) points, fourteen (14) gauge barbs spaced 10 cm
apart.
Chain link fabric shall be fabricated from ten (10) gauge galvanized wire
conforming to AASHTO M 181 and shall be of the type shown in the
Drawings. Before ordering the chain link fabric the Contractor shall submit a
sample of the material to the Engineer for his approval.
Steel reinforcement for the concrete posts shall be deformed steel bars
conforming to the provisions of Item 404.
611-1
611.2.6 Hardware
The posts shall be erected vertically in position, inside the formwork of the
foundation block prior to the placing of the concrete and shall be adequately
supported by bracing to prevent movement of the post during the setting
process of the concrete. The posts shall be erected to the height and
location shown on the Drawings or as directed by the Engineer.
The chain link fabric shall be set to line and elevation and pulled tight
between each post before spot welding or other method of fixing is carried
out.
Where splicing of the fabric is necessary or at joints the lapping of the chain
link fabric shall be a minimum of ten (10) cm and shall occur only at the
concrete post. No horizontal splicing will be permitted.
The fabric shall be fixed to the concrete post as shown on the Drawings.
611.4.1 Measurement
The quantity to be paid for shall be the number of linear meters of fencing
erected in place and accepted, measured between the centres of the end
posts.
611.4.2 Payment
611-2
ITEM 612 FURNISHING AND PLANTING TREES, SHRUBS AND
GROUND COVER
612.1 DESCRIPTION
Under this work, the contractor shall furnish and plant trees, shrubs, vines,
ground covers and other plants in addition to preparing and finishing
planting beds and shall perform maintenance and planting operations in a
workmanlike manner according to the provisions of these specifications and
to accepted horticultural practice.
Trees, Shrubs, Vines, ground covers and other plants will herein be referred
to collectively as "Plants" or "Plant Material".
The kinds, sizes and quantities of plants to be furnished and planted and the
locations at which they are to be planted shall be as called for on the
Drawings or as designated by the Engineer.
612.2.1 General
All plant material shall comply with the local laws with respect to inspection
for plant diseases and infestation, and such inspection certificates as are
required by law shall be filed with the Engineer's representative. All plants
shall be first-class representative of their normal species or varieties and
shall have average or normal well-developed branch or cane systems
together with vigorous root systems. Plant cut back from larger sizes to
meet specified sizes will not be acceptable. Plants shall be free from
disfiguring knots, sun sealed, abrasions of bark, wind or freezing injury or
other disfigurements. Plants shall show the appearance of normal health
and vigour and shall bear evidence of proper top and root pruning. Unless
otherwise indicated on the Drawings all plants shall be nursery grown.
612.2.2 Trees
Trees shall have straight trunks, well-branched with symmetrical top and
intact leader. They shall have no cuts of limbs over two (2) centimeter in
diameter which have not completely healed over. Each tree shall possess
the characteristics for its variety and growth typical of such trees in the
region.
612.2.3 Shrubs
Each shrub shall possess the characteristics of the variety and growth
typical of such shrubs in the region.
612-1
612.2.4 Vines, Ground Cover and Other Plants
Vines, ground cover and other plants, such as perennials, which are
furnished in pots or other containers and which have been acclimatised to
outside conditions will be provided they are equal to field grown stock.
All plants shall be dug, handled, prepared and packed for transportation to
site with care and skill in accordance with recognized standard practice for
the kind of plant concerned and in compliance with the following provisions
from 612.3.1 to 612.3.4.
612.3.1 General
The root systems of all plants shall not be permitted to dry out any time and
they shall not be exposed to artificial heat or to freezing temperatures.
During transportation, all plants shall be packed adequately to insure
protection from the sun, wind and climatic or seasonal injuries. Tarpaulins
or other covers shall be placed over plants when they are transported by
trucks or in open freight cars for considerable distances. All bare-root plants
shall have their root systems protected by wet shingle, tow, moss or other
suitable material. All earthballs shall be firm and intact and none shall be
"made" balls. All balled and hessian covered plants shall at all times be
handled by the ball, and not by the plant.
612.3.2 Trees
All evergreen trees shall be balled and hessian covered, except that small
trees will be acceptable in suitable containers. The ball shall be firm and the
hessian shall be sound at the time of delivering and placing the tree on the
project.
Deciduous trees supplied in bare-root condition, shall have had their root
systems puddled in a clay solution of sufficient density as to adhere to all
parts of the root system. Deciduous trees may be supplied earth placed and
hessian covered or in containers if the contractor so desires.
The head of each tree shall be carefully tied to prevent fracture of branches.
612-2
612.3.3 Shrubs
Vines, ground covers perennials and other similar plant material supplied in
pots, tins and other suitable containers will be referred to collectively as pot
grown plants. The root systems must be well protected and the plant
supplied in accordance with the specification of quality and protection set
forth above. Pot grown plants shall be well developed and sufficient roots to
hold the earth together intact after removal from the containers and at the
same time not be root bound.
Legible labels shall be attached to each plant, which is delivered to the site
as a separate unit, and to each box, bundle, bale or container containing
one or more plants. The labels shall give the approved horticultural name,
size, age or other detailed data required to identify the plant as conforming
to specification and, when not attached to separate plants, the label shall
show the quantities of each specified plant contained in the box, bundle,
bale or container.
All plants intended for use on the project shall be subject to inspection by
the Engineer's Representative at any place and at any time. The Contractor
shall inform the Engineer at the earliest practicable date as to the sources of
plant materials to be furnished on the project, and shall give the Engineer at
least 48 hours notice prior to delivery of plant material at the site of the
planting operation.
After arrival at the site of the work and prior to the time of planting, each
plant will be inspected by the Engineer’s Representative for conformance to
the Specification and Drawings, and such plants as do not conform thereto
will be marked or otherwise identified as "rejected". All rejected plant
material shall be removed from the project and shall be replaced by the
Contractor with plant material conforming to all specified requirements, all at
the Contractor's expense.
612-3
612.6 SUBSTITUTION OF PLANTS
After being dug and prior to planting on the project, all plant material shall
be properly protected against injury at all times. Plants which are not
planted or which are not to be planted within one day after arrival on the
project shall be given special protection as follows:
All plants shall be protected from excessive heat or cold and shall be stored
in a well ventilated and shaded place, protected from wind and sun.
Plant locations and outlines of planting areas shall be marked out and
staked by the Contractor. The planting layouts will be subject to the
approval of the Engineer prior to commencement of the planting operations.
612-4
i) General
Topsoil shall be kept separate from subsoil and shall be rendered loose and
friable. Alkaline soil, gravel, stones or other materials or matter encountered
in the excavations and which are detrimental to plant growth shall be
separated from the soil and disposed of at locations approved by the
Engineer.
ii) Trees
Pits for trees shall be at least forty five (45) cm greater in dimension than
the diameter of earth ball, or the spread root system of bare-root trees.
Depths of pits for trees shall be not less than eighty (80) cm deep and as
much deeper as may be necessary to provide a depth of at least twenty
(20) cm below the bottom of earth ball or root system of the tree when
placed at the proper level.
iii) Shrubs
Pits for shrubs shall be at least thirty (30) cm greater in dimension than the
diameter of earth ball or the spread root system of bare-root shrubs. Depths
of pits for shrubs shall be not less than thirty (30) cm and as much deeper
as may be necessary to provide a depth of at least fifteen (15) cm below the
bottom of the earth ball or root system of the shrub when placed at the
proper level.
Pits, pockets or trenches for vines, ground covers and similar types of plant
materials shall be of such dimensions as will provide space for the spread
root systems of the plants. In general, the pits, pockets or trenches shall be
wider and deeper than the actual space required, as above provided, by
such amount as the Engineer may determine as being necessary to provide
a space of not less than fifteen (15) cm around and beneath the root
systems, in which space good quality topsoil and plant nutrient shall be in
place at the time of planting.
612.8.3 Planting
612-5
Earth-balled and hessian-covered plants shall have all cloth, ropes, etc.
removed from the top of the earth balls, but no cloth shall be pulled out form
under the balls. Prepared topsoil shall be carefully tamped around and
under the base of each ball to fill all voids.
Bare-root plants shall have their roots spread out in a natural position and
the prepared top soil shall be carefully placed under and among them to fill
all voids. Any roots, which are broken or frayed shall be cleanly cut off from
the plant.
Subsoil, and topsoil in excess of the amounts required for filling and
backfilling work on the planting areas shall be disposed of by the contractor
in a manner satisfactory to the Engineer.
All deciduous trees over two (2) meter in height shall be staked or guyed at
time of planting. The stake shall be placed in the plant excavation and
driven securely into the ground prior to planting operations. The tree shall
be placed not to exceed ten (10) cm from the stake and fastened tightly to
the stake at a point approximately two thirds the height of the tree by means
of two and half (2.5) mm wire. At the point of contact with the tree, the wire
shall be covered with a length of rubber hose adequate to protect the bark
from chafing and injury. The tie wire shall cross between the tree and stake
and be securely fixed at the specified height.
Deciduous trees over two and half (2.1/2) M high, but less than 4 M high,
shall be staked in a similar manner. In all cases, the stakes shall be cut off
to present a uniformly pleasing appearance as directed by the Engineer.
612-6
Trees of four (4) M or greater height shall be guyed with guy cables, each
consisting of two (2) strands of two and half (2.5) mm or heavier wire
extending from approximately two thirds the height of the tree to a stake or
deadman anchored securely in the ground at a distance from the trunk of
about three-quarters the height of fastening. The tree shall be protected by
rubber hose or similar means. Evergreen trees or other hessian covered
shrubs over half (1/2) M in height shall also be guyed with three (3) cables
in a similar manner.
An area having a diameter of not less than Ninety(90)cm and lying around
each planted tree and shrub and an area having a diameter of not less than
30 cm and lying around each planted vine or ground cover shall be
loosened and brought to friable condition for a depth of not less than 8 cm.
Where plant materials are planted in groups in which the plants are so
closely spaced as to justify treatment of the area as a unit, the entire area
so occupied and extending 60 cm beyond the outer ends of the branches or
canes shall be cultivated as above provided.
Prior to any planting operations, the planting areas shall be brought to the
lines, grades and cross-sections indicated on the Drawings or as directed
by the Engineer. If the areas are to have mulching material placed thereon,
as indicated on the Drawings, grades shall be adjusted and established to
provide space for the mulch. At the edges of walks, pavements and
driveways the finished surface shall be approximately three (3) cm below
the surfaces thereof. At edges of lawn areas, the finished surface shall be
approximately five (5) cm above the normal height of grass. The edges of
adjoining lawn shall be neatly trimmed with a sharp edging tool.
The cultivating work shall include the removal of weeds, the breaking up or
removing of clods, the removal of objectionable stones, litter and debris, as
well as the removal and disposal of excess soil. Disposal of these materials
shall be in a manner satisfactory to the Engineer.
612.8.6 Mulching
612-7
612.8.7 Fertilizers and Soil Conditioners
Fertilizers and soil conditioners shall be mixed with topsoil used in the
planting operations and used elsewhere as directed by the Engineer. Mixing
of these materials with soil, mulch and other materials shall be thorough and
complete. They shall be incorporated in the work as directed by the
Engineer.
10 percent Nitrogen
15 percent Phosphoric Acid
10 percent Potash
or similar approved composition
The Contractor may add with the approval of the Engineer any additional
plant nutrients, which he considers the constitution of the soil to warrant.
Until such time as all work to be done in the Contract is completed by the
Contractor and has been finally accepted by the Engineer, the Contractor
shall maintain all plant materials and all planting areas efficiently.
Maintenance shall consist of keeping plants in a healthy, growing condition
by watering, pruning, spraying and other necessary operations.
Maintenance shall also include the keeping of planting areas free from
weeds, grass, litter and debris, as well as keeping the area smooth, neat
and attractive.
All plant and material shall be protected from stray animals or theft or
damage by any element during the specified period of maintenance at the
expense of the contractor.
Until such time as all work to be done under the Contract is completed by
the Contractor and during a specified maintenance period after acceptance
of the planting, the life and satisfactory condition of all plants furnished by
the Contractor shall be guaranteed by the Contractor.
During this period, all plants, which, in the opinion of the Engineer are in an
unhealthy or badly impaired condition, shall be replaced with satisfactory
material. After the conclusion of the planting operation and prior to the
612-8
completion of all normal work to determine the condition of the plantings,
all plants then not in a healthy growing condition will be noted for
replacement and shall be promptly removed by the Contractor. As soon as
seasonal conditions permit, all plants to be replaced shall be replaced by
the Contractor with the same kinds and sizes and in the same manner as
originally specified and at no extra cost to the Employer.
612.9.1 Measurement
The quantity to be paid for at the applicable price tendered for a given type
of plant material shall be the number of plants of that type furnished in place
as specified and finally accepted by the Engineer.
No separate payment will be made for the furnishing of fertilizers, mulching
materials and soil conditioners.
612.9.2 Payment
Payment for the furnishing and planting of trees, shrubs, vines, ground
cover and other plant materials will be made at the price tendered for each
for "furnishing and planting" the various types of plants, as set forth in this
specification and on the Drawings.
The price tendered for each for the specified and listed pay items tendered
shall be understood to cover and include payment for all labour, materials,
planting, maintenance, replacement work, transportation and placing of
fertilizers, mulching materials and soil conditioners, and the performance of
all other items of work necessary to complete the work in accordance with
the specification, and for which separate payment is not specifically
provided.
612-9
ITEM 613 SPRIGGING AND SODDING
613.1 DESCRIPTION
These works shall consist of furnishing top soil and planting sprigs or laying
grass sods in accordance with the specifications, at the location shown on
the drawings, or as required by the Engineer.
Top soil furnished by the Contractor shall consist of a natural friable surface
soil without admixture of undesirable subsoil, refuse, or foreign materials. It
shall be reasonably free from roots, hard clay, coarse gravel, stones larger
than 5 cm in diameter, noxious woods, tall grass, bush sticks, stubble, or
other litter, and shall have been cultivated from a healthy growth of crops,
grasses, trees or other vegetation that is free draining and non-toxic.
613.2.2 Sprigs
The sod shall consist of a healthy, dense and well rooted growth of living
grass.
a) Source of Material
The Contractor shall notify the Engineer at least 5 days before he intends to
start top soil stripping operations. After inspection and approval by the
Engineer and prior to stripping any top soil, the Contractor shall remove
noxious weeds and tall grass, bush roots and stones larger than 5 cm in
diameter.
613-1
b) Placing Top Soil
The top soil shall be evenly spread on the designated areas to the line and
slope if shown on the drawings and compacted to a depth of not less than
10 cm. Spreading shall not be done when the ground topsoil is excessively
wet, or otherwise in a condition detrimental to the work. The roadway
surfaces shall be kept clean during hauling and spreading operations.
After spreading has been completed, large clods, stones, roots, stumps and
other loose lying material shall be raked up and removed. Any erosion,
irregularities of grade or other incidental damage to the surface of top soil
prior to the planting of springs or laying of grass sods shall be required to
the Engineer’s satisfaction.
613.3.2 Sprigging
a) Harvesting Sprigs
The Contractor shall obtain the Engineer’s approval of his source of springs
and shall notify the Engineer at least 5 days before the sprigs are to be
harvested.
Sprigs that have dried out or are otherwise damaged during harvesting or
delivery shall be rejected.
b) Planting Sprigs
Spriggings shall not be done during windy weather, or when the ground is
dry, excessively wet, or otherwise un-tillable. If the soil is not moist when the
sprigs are being set, water shall be applied until the soil is moist and in a
workable condition. One or more of the following methods shall be used,
whichever is shown on the drawings:
613.3.3 Sodding
The Surface of the top soil on the area to be sodded shall be loosened and
brought to a reasonably fine texture to a depth of approximately 2.5 cm.
613-2
The earth bed upon which the sod is to be placed shall be moistened to the
loosened depth, if not naturally sufficiently moist, and the sod shall be
placed thereon within 24 hours after having been cut.
As the sod is being laid, it shall be lightly tamped with suitable wooden
tampers, sufficiently to set or press the sod into the underlying soil.
At points where it is anticipated that water may flow over a sodded area, the
upper edges of the sod strips (e.g., top of embankment) shall be turned into
the soil to be below the adjacent area, and a layer of earth shall be placed
over this juncture, and thoroughly compacted.
At the limits of sods areas, the end strips shall be turned in and treated as
described above.
On all slopes steeper than one meter vertical to four meters horizontal the
sod shall be pegged with stakes, 20-30 cm in length, spaced as needed by
the nature of the soil and steepness of slope. Stakes shall be driven into the
sod at right angles to the slope until flush with bottom of the grass blades.
d) Top Dressing
After the staking has been completed, the surface shall be cleared of loose
sod, excess soil, or other foreign material, whereupon a thin layer of top soil
shall be scattered over the sod as a top dressing and the areas shall then
be thoroughly moistened by sprinkling with water.
613.4.1 Measurement
The work of sprigging, sodding and top soiling shall each be measured by
the square meter, which has been planted or placed in accordance with
these specifications and accepted.
The top soil to be measured for payment shall be that quantity which
exceeds the amount in Item 103 for “Stripping”.
613-3
613.4.2 Payment
The quantity measured as prescribed above shall be paid for at the contract
unit price for the pay items, Listed below and shown in the Bill of Quantities,
which payment shall be full compensation for furnishing all materials, water,
labor, equipment, tools, transport and all costs necessary to complete the
work as prescribed in the above items.
613-4
MISCELLANEOUS
Engineer shall specify the quality, type and number of survey equipment, in
Special Provision. Engineer shall also specify the number and designation
of survey staff to be provided under this item.
701.3.1 Measurement
The quantities to be paid for under this item of work shall be at the contract
unit price.
701.3.2 Payment
Payment shall constitute full compensation for all costs of furnishing survey
teams and necessary labour, materials, equipment and its maintenance and
incidentals, for the proper completion of the work as directed by the
Engineer in the Special Provision. If the survey instruments are provided
against a normal B.O.Q. item then these will remain the property of
contractor at the end of the project. however if survey instruments are
supplied against Provisional Sum item, then these will become client’s
property at the end of the projects.
701-1
ITEM 702 PROVIDE, EQUIP AND MAINTAIN OFFICE FACILITY
AND RESIDENCE FOR THE ENGINEER (BASE CAMP
FACILITY) AND CLIENTS REPRESENTATIVE.
702.1 DESCRIPTION
The contractor shall provide and properly maintain, for the duration of the
work, office and residential facilities for the Engineer, his staff and Client's
representative. The site shall be located as shown on the plans or as
directed by the Engineer. Preferably, location of this office facility shall be at
a central location of the project site near to contractor's office and laboratory
and shall remain at the exclusive use of Engineer and his staff and Clients
representative. The office facility shall be constructed, equipped and
furnished as shown in the Special Provision and drawings.
The Contractor shall provide necessary Janitorial Services and supply for
the above official accommodation such as cleaning, window washing etc.
Air-conditioning, heating and ventilation shall also be provided as per
special provisions. Contractor shall provide security services for base camp
round the clock to the satisfaction of the Engineer. Maintenance or
replacements of worn out or broken equipment or furniture shall be done by
the contractor against item of maintenance.
All charges for installation and maintenance of utilities such as water, gas
and electricity shall be borne by the contractor.
If the operations of the Contractor are such that additions to the Engineer's
staff are required, the contractor shall provide additional facilities and
equipment as directed by the Engineer. The cost of the same shall be the
responsibility of the Contractor and shall be considered subsidiary to all
other pay items listed in the Bill of Quantities, and paid on proportional
basis.
702.3 BUILDING SITE ACQUISITION AND OWNER-SHIP
The Client will secure and obtain the land required for the Engineer's office
and his representative and will make said land available to the Contractor
for construction purposes after signing of the contract.
After completion of the contract, buildings, fixtures and furniture shall be the
property of the Employer.
In order to cater for the offices and residential accommodations, for project
of small duration, contractor shall provide temporary office accommodation
as provided in the Special Provisions.
702-1
702.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
702.4.1 Measurement
702.4.2 Payment
The quantity to be paid for under this item of work shall be at the contract
price quoted in the Bill of Quantities which price and payment shall
constitute full compensation for all costs of furnishing labour, materials,
equipment and incidentals for the proper completion of the work prescribed
in the specifications, drawings and Special Provisions. In case if furnishing
are provided against a normal B.O.Q. item then it will become the property
of contractor at the end of the project. However if furnishings are supplied
against a Provisional Sum item, then these will become the property of the
Client.
702-2
ITEM 703 PROVIDE, EQUIP AND MAINTAIN LABORATORY FOR
THE PROJECT
703.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall include the construction of Laboratory complete and ready
for use, with all necessary furnishing of equipments, utilities, installations
and access/service roads, all to the satisfaction of the Engineer as shown
on the drawings and Special Provision.
Lab. Equipment, fixtures & furniture shall remain the property of the
contractor after completion of the project, however laboratory building, shall
be handed over to the client which shall be constructed on the land made
available by the client as per item 702.3.
703-1
703.4 WEATHER RECORDING EQUIPMENT
The contractor shall furnish and maintain in good working order for the
duration of the contract, instruments and their necessary appurtenances to
be used by the Engineer in recording weather data. These instruments
shall be installed at a place as directed by the Engineer. The instruments
will be of the latest model subject to approval of the Engineer including:
703.4.1 Measurement
703.4.2 Payment
The quantities under this item of work shall be paid at the contract price
indicated in the Bill of Quantities which price and payment shall constitute
full compensation for all costs of furnishing labour, materials, equipment and
incidentals for the proper completion of the work indicated in these
specifications and specified on the drawings and Special Provision.
703-2
ITEM 704 MAINTENANCE OF WORKS FOR ONE YEAR AFTER
COMPLETION, DEFECT LIABILITY PERIOD (PERIOD OF
MAINTENANCE)
704.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of execution of all such work of repair, amendment,
reconstruction, rectification and making good defects, imperfections,
shrinkage or other faults as may be required of the Contractor in writing by
the Engineer during the Period of Maintenance, or within fourteen(14)days
after its expiration, as a result of an inspection made by or on behalf of the
Employer. Period of Maintenance as defined herein is one year beginning
the day following the receipt by the Contractor of the Certificate of
Completion issued by the Employer.
704.2 MATERIALS
All repair/remedial work shall be carried out by the Contractor at his own
expense if the necessity thereof shall, in the opinion of the Engineer, be due
to the use of materials or workmanship not in accordance with the Contract,
or the neglect or failure on the part of the Contractor to comply with any
obligation, expressed or implied, on the Contractor's part under the contract.
704.4.1 Measurement
Any maintenance work which become necessary due to use of bad quality
material or bad workmanship or which is required to repair normal wear and
tear shall not be measured for payment.
However any special work during maintenance period if carried out at the
written instruction of the Engineer the same shall be measured and paid
under applicable item of work of the BOQ.
704.4.2 Payment
The payment for this item for the first year shall be deemed to have been
included in rates for different items of work and no payment on account of
maintenance shall be made under this item.
704-1
ITEM 705 TEMPORARY ROAD WORKS FOR TRAFFIC DIVERSION
705.1 DESCRIPTION
The Contractor is allowed to carry out rehabilitation work on half carriage
way and direct the traffic on the other half. However if he opts to divert the
traffic on temporary road for ease in construction, he shall provide, maintain
and remove on completion of the works for which they are required, all
Temporary Road Works such as, detours, sleeper tracks over unstable
ground and bridges over streams and shall make them safe and suitable in
every respect for maintaining two way diverted traffic. Such temporary
diversion structures shall be constructed to the satisfaction of the Engineer.
705.2 MATERIALS
Before constructing Temporary Road works, the Contractor shall make all
necessary arrangements, including payment if required, with the public
authorities or land owners concerned, for the use of the land and he shall
also obtain the approval of the Engineer. Such approval will not, however,
relieve the Contractor of his contractual obligations. Upon completion of the
Works, the Contractor shall clean up and restore the land to the satisfaction
of the Engineer or the landowner concerned, which shall be very near to
original condition, unless otherwise allowed in writing.
705-1
705.4 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT
705.4.1 Measurement
705.4.2 Payment
Payment for provision of temporary road diversion for bridges shall be made
under applicable items of works of the B.O.Q., whereas payment for
maintenance of temporary road diversion for bridges shall be made under
this item as measured under item 705.4.1(b).
705b Maintenance of
temporary road. Lump-sum
705-2
ITEM 706 CONTROL AND PROTECTION OF TRAFFIC
706.1 DESCRIPTION
706.1.1 General
The Contractor shall keep open to traffic half a portion of any existing road
during the performance of the rehabilitation work on the other half provided
that when such a maintenance of traffic is not possible for any reason the
contractor will construct a temporary road as provided under item 705.
The Contractor shall take necessary care at all times to ensure the
convenience and safety of residents along and adjacent to the Highway.
Any failure of the Contractor in the performance of these works will entitle
the Engineer to carry out such work as he deems to be necessary and to
charge the Contractor with the full cost thereof, which sum will be deducted
from any money due or which may become due to the Contractor under the
Contract.
The Contractor shall so conduct his operations as to offer the least possible
obstruction, in-convenience and delay to traffic and shall be responsible for
the adequate control of the traffic using the width, of single lane above
specified.
706-1
706.1.4 Project Information Signs
The contractor shall within the mobilization period, erect project information
signs at all main roads crossing the project area and at the beginning and
end of the contract. The size of the project information signs and the
message thereon shall be determined by the Engineer.
706.2 MATERIALS
Materials of road posts, hazard markers, warning tapes, traffic signs,
flashing amber lights, signals, barricades, diversion cones, big cones,
bollards, detours (Chevron) etc; shall conform to current BS or ASTM
standards or as approved by the Engineer.
Traffic signs, signals, barricades, warning tapes road posts and hazard
markers, cones, bollards etc. shall be so placed as to be easily and
opportunely visible to oncoming traffic to ensure drivers will know
immediately what instructions they are to follow.
706.4.1 Measurement
This item shall be measured in number of months during which the traffic is
properly maintained by the contractor by providing all signs, signals,
illumination, barricades etc. round the clock and necessary manpower /
flagmen as per requirement of the Engineer.
706.4.2 Payment
706-2
ITEM 707 REMOVAL / RELOCATION OF UTILITIES
707.1 DESCRIPTION
This work shall consist of carrying out relocation of various types of services
falling within the Right of Way. The quantum of work shall be established by
the design consultant and elaborated in the Special Provisions or as
directed by the Engineer.
707.2 MATERIAL REQUIREMENTS
All materials, if required for the relocation of services shall conform to the
Specifications of the relative department whose utilities are being shifted.
The quantity of each item for which utilities have been relocated shall be
measured in the unit as approved by the Engineer or as designated in the
Special Provisions.
707.4.2 Payment
This payment shall constitute full compensation for any design work,
coordination with relative department, furnishing of materials and installing
or relocation as per requirement of the relative department, which shall also
include all labour, equipment, tool and incidental necessary to complete the
item
707-1
RECOMMENDED
MAJOR
CONSTRUCTION
EQUIPMENT
RECOMMENDED MAJOR CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT
2 Dumper (10 T)
107 Structural Excavation 1 Excavator (0.3 CM) Plate Compactor Plate Compactor.
and Backfill 2 Plate Compactor
108 Formation of 1 Grader (140-165 HP) Grader (140 HP) 1 Heavy Duty
Embankment. 2 Combination / sheep- Combination / Tractor with Blade
foot or pneumatic sheepfoot or (80 H.P.)
Roller (8-12T) pneumatic Roller 2 Static Roller
3 Water Tanker (8-12T) (8-12T)
(Bowser Type) Water Tanker 3 Water Tanker
(Bowser Type) (Tow-Type).
M-1
RECOMMENDED MAJOR CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT
CONSTRUCTION MACHINERY FOR
ITEM DESCRIPTION MAJOR PROJECTS REHABILITATIO MAINTENANCE
NO. N/MEDIUM SIZE PROJECTS.
PROJECTS.
114 Dressing and 1 Tractor with 1 Tractor with
Compaction of Berms. -- Blade Blade (50 H.P.)
(50-80 HP) 2 Water Tanker
2 Water Tanker (Tow Type)
(Tow Type) 3 Static Roller
3 Static Roller (10-12T)
(10-12T)
201 Granular Sub-Base. 1 Power Broom /Air 1 Heavy Duty 1 Tractor / Trolley
Compressor Tractor with with Blade (50
2 Grader With Scarifier Blade. H.P.)
(140 H.P.) 2 Water Tanker 2 Water tanker
3 Water Bowser. (Tow type) (Tow Type)
4 Combination Roller 3 Static Roller 3 Static Roller
(10-12T) (10-12T) (10-12T)
202 & Base Course 1 Power Broom / Air 1 Grader 1 Heavy Duty
211 compressor. (140 H.P.) with Tractor / Trolley
2 Front End Loader Articulated with Blade
(2-3 CM) Blade. (80 H.P.)
3 Pugmill (50-100T/ 2 Water Tanker 2 Water Tanker
Hour) (Tow type) (Tow Type)
4 Dumper (10-15T) 3 Combination 3 Static Roller
5 Base Paver (4M wide) Roller (10-12T)
Combination roller (10-12T)
6 (10-12T)
204 Soil Cement Stabilized 1 Concrete Batching Same Equipment
Sub-base / base. and forced mixing as for major
plant (30 CM/Hour). project.
2 Dumper (10-15T) --
3 Base Paver
(4M wide)
4 Tandem Roller
(10-12T)
212 Bitumen Stabilized 1 Grader with scarifier 1 Heavy Duty
i) Sub-base. (140 H.P.) Tractor with
Bitumen Stabilized 2 Asphalt Distributor Blade. --
ii) Base. 3 Combination roller 2 Combination
(10-12T) Roller (10-12T)
(a) Cold Mix 1 Grader with Scarifier Same Equip-
(140-165 H.P.) ment as for
2 Bitumen Distributor major projects.
(Auto/Tow Type)
3 Tandem Static Roller
(10-12T)
(b) Hot Mix Equipment Equipment
mentioned as per mentioned as
Item 203. per Item 203.
M-2
RECOMMENDED MAJOR CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT
CONSTRUCTION MACHINERY FOR
ITEM DESCRIPTION MAJOR PROJECTS REHABILITATION/ MAINTENANCE
NO. MEDIUM SIZE PROJECTS.
PROJECTS.
213 Recycling of Road 1 Cold Mix
Pavement Structure / -- Recycler.
Soil Stabilization. 2 Grader (140 HP)
Water Tanker
3 (Tow Type) --
Vib. Combination
4 Roller
(10-12T)
203 & Asphaltic Base Course 1 Power Broom / Air- 1 Front End loader 1 Bitumen
305 / Wearing Course Compressor. (1.50-2.50 CM) Aggregate
Plant Mix. 2 Front End Loader Asphalt Plant Mixer (1 CM)
(2-3 CM) 2 (20-40T) 2 Wheel Barrow
3 Asphalt Plant Dumper (10T) (0.5 CM)
(80-120T) 3 Paver 3 Tandem
4 Paver (4 M wide) 4 (4M wide) Vibratory
5 Dumper (10-18T) P.T.R. Roller (8-10T)
6 P.T.R (9 Wheeler 5 (9 Wheeled)18-T. 4 Tractor /
21 T) Tandem Trolley
7 Tandem Vibratory Vibratory Roller. (50 H.P.)
Roller (10-12T) 6 (8-10T)
308 Re-cycling of Asphalt -- 1 Recycling
Concrete Machine.
2 Bitumen Bowser
plus all
equipment for --
Asphaltic
Concrete under
Item 305
115 & Shoulder Treatment. 1 Grader (140 H.P.) 1 Heavy Duty 1 Tractor /
306 2 Dumpers (10T) Tractor / Trolley Trolley with
3 Water Tanker with Blade. Blade
(Tow type) 2 Water Tanker (50 H.P.)
4 Combination Roller (Two type) 2 Water Tanker
(10-12T) 3 Static Roller (Tow type)
(10-12T) 3 Static Roller
(8-10T)
309 Cold Milling -- 1 Cold Milling 1 Cold Milling
Machine Machine (1 M
(1 M wide) wide)
2 Dumpers (10T) 2 Dumpers
3 Water Tanker (10T)
(Tow type) 3 Water Tanker
(Tow type)
302 & Bituminous Prime 1 Power Broom / Air- 1 Manual Operated Manually
303 Coat / Tack Coat. Compressor. Bitumen pressure Operated
2 Engine Operated distributor Bitumen
Bitumen pressure (Tow Type) pressure
distributor (Auto-Type) distributor
(Tow Type)
M-3
RECOMMENDED MAJOR CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT
CONSTRUCTION MACHINERY FOR
ITEM DESCRIPTION MAJOR PROJECTS REHABILITATIO MAINTENANCE
NO. N/MEDIUM SIZE PROJECTS.
PROJECTS.
304 Bituminous Surface 1 Power Broom/Air- 1 Aggregate 1 Tractor/Trolley
Treatment. Compressor. Spreader (50 H.P.)
2 Aggregate Spreader. (3-4 M wide) 2 Bitumen Sprayer
3 Engine Operated 2 Bitumen (manual) static
Bitumen pressure Distributor Tandem Roller
distributor (Auto- Auto or Tow- (18T)
Type) Type.
4 Dump Truck (10T) 3 Dump Truck
5 Rubber Mounted (10T).
Tandem Roller or 4 Static Tandem
P.T.R (9 Wheeled- Roller (8-10T)
18T)
310 Concrete Pavements. Concrete Batching
Plant (30 CM/H).
Concrete Paving
Machine (4 M wide) -- --
Front End Loader
(2-3 CM)
Concrete Transit
mixer (6 CM)
401 Concrete 1 Concrete Batching 1 Concrete 1 Concrete Static
Plant (30 CM/H) Static Mixer (1 Mixer (1/2-1 CM)
2 Front End Loader CM) 2 Tractor/Trolley
(2-3 CM) 2 Tractor Trolley (50 H.P.)
3 Concrete Transit (50 H.P.) 3 Vibrator.
Mixer (6 CM) 3 Crane (20T) 4 Wheel Borrows.
4 Crane (20-45T). 4 Water Tanker
5 Vibrator (40mm- (Tow Type)
50mm) 5 Vibrator
6 Concrete Finisher. (40mm-50mm)
M-4
REFERENCES
The following references were taken into account for the compilation of General
Specifications for National Highways Authority, Ministry of Communication, Government
of Pakistan.
Annex – B
G-19
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF GRANULAR SUBBASE
(ITEM NO. 201)
G-20
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF AGGREGATE BASE COURSE
(ITEM NO. 202)
Sodium
Sulphate AASHTO T-104 3/Source plus 1/5,000 CM As per Item
Soundness 202.2 (d)
G-21
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF ASPHALTIC BASE COURSE
PLANT MIX (ITEM NO. 203)
Specific Gravity. AASHTO T-85 4/Source for each size in Hot For use in
and Absorption bins of Asphalt Plant preparation
of JMF.
Fine Sand Equivalent AASHTO T-176 3/Source plus as required As per Item
Aggregate or based on visual observation. 203.2.1 (c)
Plasticity Index. AASHTO T-89 2/1000 CM As per Item
and T-90. 203.2.1 (d)
G-22
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF ASPHALTIC BASE COURSE
PLANT MIX (ITEM NO. 203)
Notes:
G-23
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF SOIL-CEMENT BASE COURSE
(ITEM NO. 204)
Soil Classification. AASHTO T-27 and 3/Borrow Source plus Soil Class
T-89. 1/1000 CM must be A-3
or A-4.
Note:
a) Screening of Soil through one inch and No. 4.
sieves prior to mixing with cement.
G-24
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF CRACK-RELIEF LAYER
(ITEM NO. 205)
Aggregate Gradation AASHTO T-27 Same as for item 202. As per Item
(Crushed) 205.2.1.
G-25
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF WEARING COURSE
PLANT MIX (ITEM NO. 305)
Specific Gravity AASHTO T-85 4/Source for each size in Hot For use in
and Absorption. bins of Asphalt Plant. preparation
of JMF.
Fine Sand Equivalent AASHTO T-176 3/Source plus as required As per Item
Aggregate or base on visual observation. 305.2.1 (c)
Plasticity Index. AASHTO T-89 & 1/1000 CM As per Item
T-90. 305.2.1 (d)
G-26
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF WEARING COURSE
PLANT MIX (ITEM NO. 305)
Mixture Thickness AASHTO T-230 1/layer @ 100 M interval per As per item
compacted in lane. 305.3.2.
place.
Notes:
G-27
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF CONCRETE
(ITEM NO. 401)
Fine
Aggregate
Gradation AASHTO M-6 2/Source plus 1/1000 CM As per Item
401.2.2
Specific
Gravity AASHTO T-84 4/Source plus 1/1000 CM - do -
Organic
Impurities AASHTO T-21 1/Source plus 1/1000 CM As per Item
401.3.9 and
401.2.2
G-28
SCHEDULE FOR SAMPLING AND TESTING OF CONCRETE
(ITEM NO. 401)
Yield Test for AASHTO T-121 1/Lot or 1000 Bags As per Item
Cement Content 310.3.3
Cement Setting Time AASHTO T-131 1/Lot or 1000 Bags As per Item
401.2.1
G-29
TABLE FOR ALLOWABLE TOLERANCES
(EARTHWORKS, PAVEMENT COURSES AND CONCRETE)
G-30
ALLOWABLE TOLERANCE FROM THEORETICAL WEIGHTS
(REINFORCEMENT)
AS PER AASHTO M-31
*
Diameter of Bars Lot under Individual Bar under
* The term “Lot” means all bars of the same nominal weight per linear meter contained in an
individual shipping release or shipping order.
Note: Reinforcing bars are evaluated on the basis of nominal weights. In no case shall the
overweight of any bar or lot of bars be cause of rejection.
G-31
TABLE FOR ALLOWABLE TOLERANCE
(REINFORCED CONCRETE PIPES OF CLASS - II AND IV)
AS PER AASHTO M-170
G-32
SECTION-I
EARTH WORK AND ALLIED ACTIVITIES
103 - Stripping. o
G-33
SECTION-II
SUBBASE AND BASE.
200 - General. o o o
215 - Geotextiles o
G-34
SECTION-III
SURFACE COURSES AND PAVEMENT.
300 - General. o o o
307 - Bit-Mac. o o
G-35
SECTION-IV
STRUCTURES
401 - Concrete. O o o
403 - Formwork. o o o
407 - Piling. o
SECTION-V
DRAINAGE AND EROSION WORKS.
503 - Underdrain. o o
505 - Manholes. o o o
507 - Gabions o o o
SECTION-VI
ANCILLARY WORKS.
611 - Fencing. o
SECTION-VII
MISCELLANEOUS
Rehabilitatio
Item No Description New Construction Maintenance
n
Due to printing errors in NHA Specifications – 1998, the following page Nos. of “Butter
Papers” are to be replaced before printing of Next Edition as the same have been
incorporated in the “Master Copy” which is retained in the computer. However
corrigendum to General Specifications NHA – 1998 has already been issued to NHA vide
our letter No. III-45-HW/7476 dated 09.02.2000.